gnu: Add cl-opticl.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83
84 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
85 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
86 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
87 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
88 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
89 Documentation License''.
90 @end copying
91
92 @dircategory System administration
93 @direntry
94 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
95 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
96 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
97 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
98 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
99 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
100 @end direntry
101
102 @dircategory Software development
103 @direntry
104 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
105 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
106 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
107 @end direntry
108
109 @titlepage
110 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
111 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
112 @author The GNU Guix Developers
113
114 @page
115 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
116 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
117 @value{UPDATED} @*
118
119 @insertcopying
120 @end titlepage
121
122 @contents
123
124 @c *********************************************************************
125 @node Top
126 @top GNU Guix
127
128 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
129 package management tool written for the GNU system.
130
131 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
132 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
133 @c translation.
134 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
135 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
136 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
137 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
138 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
139 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
140 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
141 Project}.
142
143 @menu
144 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
145 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
146 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
147 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
148 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
149 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
150 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
151 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
152 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
153 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
154 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
155 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
156 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
157 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
158
159 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
160 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
161 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
162 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
163
164 @detailmenu
165 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
166
167 Introduction
168
169 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
170 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
171
172 Installation
173
174 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
175 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
176 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
177 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
178 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
179 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
180
181 Setting Up the Daemon
182
183 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
184 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
185 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
186
187 System Installation
188
189 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
190 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
191 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
192 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
193 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
194 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
195 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
196 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
197 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
198
199 Manual Installation
200
201 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
202 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
203
204 Package Management
205
206 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
207 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
208 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
209 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
210 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
211 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
212 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
213 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
214 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
215 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
216 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
217
218 Substitutes
219
220 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
221 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
222 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
223 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
224 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
225 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
226
227 Development
228
229 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
230 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
231 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
232
233 Programming Interface
234
235 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
236 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
237 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
238 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
239 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
240 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
241 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
242 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
243
244 Defining Packages
245
246 * package Reference:: The package data type.
247 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
248
249 Utilities
250
251 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
252 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
253 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
254 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
255 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
256 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
257 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
258 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
259 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
260 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
261 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
262 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
263 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
264 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
265 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
266
267 Invoking @command{guix build}
268
269 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
270 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
271 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
272 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
273
274 System Configuration
275
276 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
277 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
278 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
279 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
280 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
281 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
282 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
283 * Services:: Specifying system services.
284 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
285 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
286 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
287 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
288 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
289 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
290 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
291 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
292 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
293
294 Services
295
296 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
297 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
298 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
299 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
300 * X Window:: Graphical display.
301 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
302 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
303 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
304 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
305 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
306 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
307 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
308 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
309 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
310 * Web Services:: Web servers.
311 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
312 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
313 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
314 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
315 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
316 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
317 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
318 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
319 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
320 * Game Services:: Game servers.
321 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
322 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
323 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
324 * Hurd Services:: Services specific to a Hurd System.
325 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
326
327 Defining Services
328
329 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
330 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
331 * Service Reference:: API reference.
332 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
333
334 @end detailmenu
335 @end menu
336
337 @c *********************************************************************
338 @node Introduction
339 @chapter Introduction
340
341 @cindex purpose
342 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
343 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
344 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
345 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
346 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
347 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
348 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
349
350 @cindex Guix System
351 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
352 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
353 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
354 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
355 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
356 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
357 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
358 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
359 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
360 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
361
362 @menu
363 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
364 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
365 @end menu
366
367 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
368 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
369
370 @cindex user interfaces
371 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
372 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
373 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
374 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
375 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
376 @cindex build daemon
377 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
378 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
379 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
380
381 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
382 @cindex customization, of packages
383 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
384 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
385 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
386 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
387 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
388 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
389 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
390 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
391
392 @cindex functional package management
393 @cindex isolation
394 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
395 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
396 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
397 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
398 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
399 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
400 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
401 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
402 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
403 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
404 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
405 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
406 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
407 explicit inputs are visible.
408
409 @cindex store
410 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
411 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
412 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
413 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
414 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
415 input yields a different directory name.
416
417 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
418 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
419 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
420
421
422 @node GNU Distribution
423 @section GNU Distribution
424
425 @cindex Guix System
426 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
427 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
428 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
429 users of that software}.}. The
430 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
431 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
432 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
433 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
434 Guix@tie{}System.
435
436 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
437 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
438 list of available packages can be browsed
439 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
440 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
441
442 @example
443 guix package --list-available
444 @end example
445
446 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
447 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
448 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
449 tools that help users exert that freedom.
450
451 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
452
453 @table @code
454
455 @item x86_64-linux
456 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
457
458 @item i686-linux
459 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
460
461 @item armhf-linux
462 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
463 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
464 and Linux-Libre kernel.
465
466 @item aarch64-linux
467 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
468
469 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
470 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
471 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
472 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
473 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
474 architecture then the code is still available.
475
476 @end table
477
478 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
479 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
480 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
481 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
482 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
483 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
484 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
485
486 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
487 @code{mips64el-linux}.
488
489 @noindent
490 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
491 @pxref{Porting}.
492
493 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
494 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
495
496
497 @c *********************************************************************
498 @node Installation
499 @chapter Installation
500
501 @cindex installing Guix
502
503 @quotation Note
504 We recommend the use of this
505 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
506 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
507 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
508 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
509 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
510 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
511 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
512 as the root user.
513 @end quotation
514
515 @cindex foreign distro
516 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
517 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
518 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
519 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
520 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
521
522 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
523 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
524
525 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
526 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
527 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
528 ready to use it.
529
530 @menu
531 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
532 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
533 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
534 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
535 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
536 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
537 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
538 @end menu
539
540 @node Binary Installation
541 @section Binary Installation
542
543 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
544 @cindex installer script
545 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
546 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
547 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
548 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
549 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
550
551 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
552 @quotation Note
553 We recommend the use of this
554 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
555 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
556 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
557 user. As root, you can thus run this:
558
559 @example
560 cd /tmp
561 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
562 chmod +x guix-install.sh
563 ./guix-install.sh
564 @end example
565 @end quotation
566
567 Installing goes along these lines:
568
569 @enumerate
570 @item
571 @cindex downloading Guix binary
572 Download the binary tarball from
573 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
574 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
575 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
576 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
577
578 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
579 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
580 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
581
582 @example
583 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
584 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
585 @end example
586
587 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
588 then run this command to import it:
589
590 @example
591 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
592 -qO - | gpg --import -
593 @end example
594
595 @noindent
596 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
597
598 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
599 signature!'' is normal.
600
601 @c end authentication part
602
603 @item
604 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
605 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
606
607 @example
608 # cd /tmp
609 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
610 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
611 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
612 @end example
613
614 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
615 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
616 step).
617
618 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
619 would overwrite its own essential files.
620
621 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
622 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
623 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
624 versions are fine).
625 They stem from the fact that all the
626 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
627 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
628 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
629 reproducible.
630
631 @item
632 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
633 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
634
635 @example
636 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
637 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
638 ~root/.config/guix/current
639 @end example
640
641 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
642 environment variables:
643
644 @example
645 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
646 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
647 @end example
648
649 @item
650 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
651 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
652
653 @item
654 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
655
656 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
657 with these commands:
658
659 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
660 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
661 @c files into place.
662 @c
663 @c See this thread for more information:
664 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
665
666 @example
667 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
668 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
669 /etc/systemd/system/
670 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
671 @end example
672
673 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
674
675 @example
676 # initctl reload-configuration
677 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
678 /etc/init/
679 # start guix-daemon
680 @end example
681
682 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
683
684 @example
685 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
686 --build-users-group=guixbuild
687 @end example
688
689 @item
690 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
691 for instance with:
692
693 @example
694 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
695 # cd /usr/local/bin
696 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
697 @end example
698
699 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
700 there:
701
702 @example
703 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
704 # cd /usr/local/share/info
705 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
706 do ln -s $i ; done
707 @end example
708
709 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
710 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
711 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
712 Info search path).
713
714 @item
715 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
716 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
717 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
718
719 @example
720 # guix archive --authorize < \
721 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
722 @end example
723
724 @item
725 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
726 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
727 @end enumerate
728
729 Voilà, the installation is complete!
730
731 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
732 the root profile:
733
734 @example
735 # guix install hello
736 @end example
737
738 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
739 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
740
741 @example
742 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
743 @end example
744
745 @noindent
746 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
747
748 @example
749 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
750 --profile-name=current-guix guix
751 @end example
752
753 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
754
755 @node Requirements
756 @section Requirements
757
758 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
759 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
760 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
761 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
762
763 @cindex official website
764 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
765 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
766
767 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
768
769 @itemize
770 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
771 2.2.x;
772 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
773 0.1.0 or later;
774 @item
775 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
776 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
777 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
778 @item
779 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
780 or later;
781 @item
782 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
783 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
784 2017 or later;
785 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} 3.x;
786 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
787 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
788 @end itemize
789
790 The following dependencies are optional:
791
792 @itemize
793 @item
794 @c Note: We need at least 0.12.0 for 'userauth-gssapi!'.
795 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
796 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
797 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
798 version 0.12.0 or later.
799
800 @item
801 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
802 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
803 with lzlib.
804
805 @item
806 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
807 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
808 @end itemize
809
810 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
811 following packages are also needed:
812
813 @itemize
814 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
815 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
816 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
817 C++11 standard.
818 @end itemize
819
820 @cindex state directory
821 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
822 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
823 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
824 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
825 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
826 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
827 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
828 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
829
830 @node Running the Test Suite
831 @section Running the Test Suite
832
833 @cindex test suite
834 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
835 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
836 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
837 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
838 suite, type:
839
840 @example
841 make check
842 @end example
843
844 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
845 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
846 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
847 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
848 cache.
849
850 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
851 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
852
853 @example
854 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
855 @end example
856
857 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
858 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
859 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
860
861 @example
862 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
863 @end example
864
865 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
866 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
867 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
868 your message.
869
870 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
871 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
872 Guix is already installed, using:
873
874 @example
875 make check-system
876 @end example
877
878 @noindent
879 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
880
881 @example
882 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
883 @end example
884
885 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
886 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
887 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
888 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
889 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
890 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
891
892 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
893 all the details.
894
895 @node Setting Up the Daemon
896 @section Setting Up the Daemon
897
898 @cindex daemon
899 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
900 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
901 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
902 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
903 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
904 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
905 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
906
907 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
908 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
909 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
910
911 @menu
912 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
913 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
914 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
915 @end menu
916
917 @node Build Environment Setup
918 @subsection Build Environment Setup
919
920 @cindex build environment
921 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
922 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
923 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
924 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
925 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
926 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
927 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
928
929 @cindex build users
930 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
931 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
932 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
933 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
934 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
935 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
936 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
937 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
938 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
939 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
940
941 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
942 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
943
944 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
945 @c for why `-G' is needed.
946 @example
947 # groupadd --system guixbuild
948 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
949 do
950 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
951 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
952 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
953 guixbuilder$i;
954 done
955 @end example
956
957 @noindent
958 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
959 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
960 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
961 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
962 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
963 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
964 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
965
966 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
967 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
968 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
969 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
970 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
971 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
972 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
973 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
974
975 @example
976 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
977 @end example
978
979 @cindex chroot
980 @noindent
981 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
982 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
983 environment contains nothing but:
984
985 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
986 @itemize
987 @item
988 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
989 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
990 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
991 can only be created if the host has them.};
992
993 @item
994 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
995 since a separate PID name space is used;
996
997 @item
998 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
999 user @file{nobody};
1000
1001 @item
1002 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1003
1004 @item
1005 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1006 @code{127.0.0.1};
1007
1008 @item
1009 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1010 @end itemize
1011
1012 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1013 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1014 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1015 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1016 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1017 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1018 capture the name of their build tree.
1019
1020 @vindex http_proxy
1021 @vindex https_proxy
1022 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1023 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1024 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1025 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1026
1027 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1028 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1029 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1030 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1031 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1032 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1033 @emph{pure} functions.
1034
1035
1036 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1037 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1038
1039 @cindex offloading
1040 @cindex build hook
1041 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1042 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1043 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1044 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1045 present.}. When that
1046 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1047 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1048 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1049 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1050 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1051 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1052 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1053 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1054
1055 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1056
1057 @lisp
1058 (list (build-machine
1059 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1060 (system "x86_64-linux")
1061 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1062 (user "bob")
1063 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1064
1065 (build-machine
1066 (name "armeight.example.org")
1067 (system "aarch64-linux")
1068 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1069 (user "alice")
1070 (private-key
1071 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1072 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1073 @end lisp
1074
1075 @noindent
1076 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1077 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{aarch64}
1078 architecture.
1079
1080 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1081 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1082 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1083 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1084 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1085 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1086 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1087 detailed below.
1088
1089 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1090 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1091 builds. The important fields are:
1092
1093 @table @code
1094
1095 @item name
1096 The host name of the remote machine.
1097
1098 @item system
1099 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1100
1101 @item user
1102 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1103 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1104 allow non-interactive logins.
1105
1106 @item host-key
1107 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1108 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1109 long string that looks like this:
1110
1111 @example
1112 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1113 @end example
1114
1115 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1116 key can be found in a file such as
1117 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1118
1119 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1120 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1121 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1122 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1123
1124 @example
1125 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1126 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1127 @end example
1128
1129 @end table
1130
1131 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1132
1133 @table @asis
1134
1135 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1136 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1137
1138 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1139 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1140 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1141
1142 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1143 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1144
1145 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1146 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1147 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1148
1149 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1150 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1151
1152 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1153 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1154 to on that machine.
1155
1156 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1157 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1158
1159 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1160 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1161 machines with a higher speed factor.
1162
1163 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1164 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1165 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1166 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1167 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1168
1169 @end table
1170 @end deftp
1171
1172 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1173 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1174
1175 @example
1176 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1177 @end example
1178
1179 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1180 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1181 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1182 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1183 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1184
1185 @example
1186 # guix archive --generate-key
1187 @end example
1188
1189 @noindent
1190 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1191 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1192
1193 @example
1194 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1195 @end example
1196
1197 @noindent
1198 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1199
1200 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1201 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1202 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1203 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1204 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1205
1206 @cindex offload test
1207 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1208 master node:
1209
1210 @example
1211 # guix offload test
1212 @end example
1213
1214 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1215 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1216 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1217 from it, and report any error in the process.
1218
1219 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1220 command line:
1221
1222 @example
1223 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1224 @end example
1225
1226 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1227 regular expression like this:
1228
1229 @example
1230 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1231 @end example
1232
1233 @cindex offload status
1234 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1235 main node:
1236
1237 @example
1238 # guix offload status
1239 @end example
1240
1241
1242 @node SELinux Support
1243 @subsection SELinux Support
1244
1245 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1246 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1247 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1248 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1249 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1250 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1251 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1252 be used on Guix System.
1253
1254 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1255 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1256 To install the policy run this command as root:
1257
1258 @example
1259 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1260 @end example
1261
1262 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1263 mechanism provided by your system.
1264
1265 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1266 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1267 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1268 command:
1269
1270 @example
1271 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1272 @end example
1273
1274 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1275 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1276 operations.
1277
1278 @subsubsection Limitations
1279 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1280
1281 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1282 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1283 the Guix daemon.
1284
1285 @enumerate
1286 @item
1287 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1288 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1289 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1290 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1291
1292 @item
1293 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1294 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1295 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1296 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1297 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1298 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1299 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1300 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1301 reading and following these links.
1302
1303 @item
1304 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1305 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1306 differently from files.
1307
1308 @item
1309 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1310 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1311 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1312 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1313 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1314 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1315 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1316 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1317 allowed for processes in that domain.
1318
1319 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1320 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1321 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1322 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1323 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1324 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1325 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1326 @end enumerate
1327
1328 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1329 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1330
1331 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1332 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1333 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1334 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1335
1336 @example
1337 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1338 @end example
1339
1340 @noindent
1341 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1342
1343 @cindex chroot
1344 @cindex container, build environment
1345 @cindex build environment
1346 @cindex reproducible builds
1347 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1348 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1349 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1350 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1351 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1352 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1353 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1354 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1355 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1356 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1357 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1358
1359 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1360 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1361 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1362 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1363 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1364
1365 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1366 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1367 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1368
1369 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1370 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1371 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1372 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1373 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1374
1375 The following command-line options are supported:
1376
1377 @table @code
1378 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1379 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1380 the Daemon, build users}).
1381
1382 @item --no-substitutes
1383 @cindex substitutes
1384 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1385 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1386 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1387
1388 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1389 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1390 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1391
1392 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1393 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1394 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1395 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1396 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1397
1398 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1399 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1400
1401 @cindex offloading
1402 @item --no-offload
1403 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1404 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1405 builds to remote machines.
1406
1407 @item --cache-failures
1408 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1409
1410 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1411 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1412 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1413 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1414
1415 @item --cores=@var{n}
1416 @itemx -c @var{n}
1417 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1418 as available.
1419
1420 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1421 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1422 guix build}).
1423
1424 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1425 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1426 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1427
1428 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1429 @itemx -M @var{n}
1430 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1431 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1432 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1433 Setup}), or simply fail.
1434
1435 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1436 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1437 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1438
1439 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1440
1441 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1442 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1443
1444 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1445 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1446 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1447
1448 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1449
1450 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1451 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1452
1453 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1454 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1455 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1456 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1457 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1458
1459 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1460 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1461 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1462
1463 @item --debug
1464 Produce debugging output.
1465
1466 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1467 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1468 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1469
1470 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1471 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1472
1473 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1474 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1475 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1476 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1477 needs.
1478
1479 @item --disable-chroot
1480 Disable chroot builds.
1481
1482 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1483 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1484 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1485 account.
1486
1487 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1488 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1489 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1490
1491 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1492 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1493 them with Bzip2 by default.
1494
1495 @item --disable-deduplication
1496 @cindex deduplication
1497 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1498
1499 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1500 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1501 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1502 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1503 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1504 this optimization.
1505
1506 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1507 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1508 derivations.
1509
1510 @cindex GC roots
1511 @cindex garbage collector roots
1512 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1513 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1514 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1515 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1516 roots.
1517
1518 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1519 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1520 corresponding to live outputs.
1521
1522 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1523 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1524 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1525 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1526 space.
1527
1528 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1529 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1530 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1531 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1532 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1533 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1534 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1535 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1536
1537 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1538 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1539 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1540
1541 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1542 on the kernel version number.
1543
1544 @item --lose-logs
1545 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1546 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1547
1548 @item --system=@var{system}
1549 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1550 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1551 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1552
1553 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1554 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1555 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1556 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1557 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1558
1559 @table @code
1560 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1561 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1562 creating it if needed.
1563
1564 @item --listen=localhost
1565 @cindex daemon, remote access
1566 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1567 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1568 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1569 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1570 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1571
1572 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1573 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1574 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1575 @end table
1576
1577 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1578 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1579 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1580 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1581 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1582
1583 @quotation Note
1584 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1585 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1586 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1587 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1588 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1589 @end quotation
1590
1591 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1592 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1593 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1594 @end table
1595
1596
1597 @node Application Setup
1598 @section Application Setup
1599
1600 @cindex foreign distro
1601 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1602 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1603 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1604
1605 @subsection Locales
1606
1607 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1608 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1609 @vindex LOCPATH
1610 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1611 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1612 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1613 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1614 variable:
1615
1616 @example
1617 $ guix install glibc-locales
1618 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1619 @end example
1620
1621 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1622 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1623 917@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1624 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1625
1626 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1627 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1628 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item
1632 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1633 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1634 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1635 incompatible locale data.
1636
1637 @item
1638 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1639 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1640 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1641 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1642 data in the right format.
1643 @end enumerate
1644
1645 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1646 versions may be incompatible.
1647
1648 @subsection Name Service Switch
1649
1650 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1651 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1652 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1653 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1654 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1655 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1656 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1657 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1658 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1659 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1660
1661 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1662 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1663 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1664 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1665 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1666
1667 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1668 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1669 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1670 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1671 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1672 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1673 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1674 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1675 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1676 Reference Manual}).
1677
1678 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1679 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1680 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1681 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1682 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1683 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1684 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1685 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1686 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1687
1688 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1689 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1690 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1691 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1692
1693 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1694 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1695 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1696 themselves.
1697
1698 @subsection X11 Fonts
1699
1700 @cindex fonts
1701 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1702 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1703 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1704 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1705 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1706 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1707 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1708
1709 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1710 @cindex font cache
1711 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1712 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1713 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1714
1715 @example
1716 guix install fontconfig
1717 fc-cache -rv
1718 @end example
1719
1720 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1721 graphical applications, consider installing
1722 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1723 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1724 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1725 for Chinese languages:
1726
1727 @example
1728 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1729 @end example
1730
1731 @cindex @code{xterm}
1732 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1733 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1734 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1735
1736 @example
1737 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1738 @end example
1739
1740 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1741 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1742
1743 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1744 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1745 @example
1746 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1747 @end example
1748
1749 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1750 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1751 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1752
1753
1754 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1755
1756 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1757 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1758 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1759
1760 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1761 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1762 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1763 information.
1764
1765 @subsection Emacs Packages
1766
1767 @cindex @code{emacs}
1768 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1769 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1770 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1771 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1772 set when installing Emacs itself.
1773
1774 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1775 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1776 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1777 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1778 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1779 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1780
1781
1782 @node Upgrading Guix
1783 @section Upgrading Guix
1784
1785 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1786
1787 To upgrade Guix, run:
1788
1789 @example
1790 guix pull
1791 @end example
1792
1793 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1794
1795 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1796 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1797 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1798
1799 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1800
1801 @example
1802 sudo -i guix pull
1803 @end example
1804
1805 @noindent
1806 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1807 tool):
1808
1809 @example
1810 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1811 @end example
1812
1813 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1814 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1815
1816 @c TODO What else?
1817
1818 @c *********************************************************************
1819 @node System Installation
1820 @chapter System Installation
1821
1822 @cindex installing Guix System
1823 @cindex Guix System, installation
1824 This section explains how to install Guix System
1825 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1826 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1827 @pxref{Installation}.
1828
1829 @ifinfo
1830 @quotation Note
1831 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1832 @c installation image.
1833 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1834 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1835 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1836 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1837
1838 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1839 available.
1840 @end quotation
1841 @end ifinfo
1842
1843 @menu
1844 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1845 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1846 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1847 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1848 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1849 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1850 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1851 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1852 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1853 @end menu
1854
1855 @node Limitations
1856 @section Limitations
1857
1858 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1859 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1860 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1861
1862 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1863 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1864
1865 @itemize
1866 @item
1867 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1868
1869 @item
1870 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1871 may be missing.
1872
1873 @item
1874 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1875 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1876 missing.
1877 @end itemize
1878
1879 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1880 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1881 info.
1882
1883
1884 @node Hardware Considerations
1885 @section Hardware Considerations
1886
1887 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1888 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1889 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1890 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1891 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1892 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1893 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1894 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1895 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1896
1897 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1898 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1899 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1900 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1901 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1902 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1903 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1904 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1905 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1906
1907 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1908 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1909 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1910 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1911 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1912 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1913
1914 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1915 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1916 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1917
1918
1919 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1920 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1921
1922 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1923 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1924 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
1925 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
1926
1927 @table @code
1928 @item x86_64-linux
1929 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1930
1931 @item i686-linux
1932 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1933 @end table
1934
1935 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1936 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1937 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1938
1939 @example
1940 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
1941 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
1942 @end example
1943
1944 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1945 then run this command to import it:
1946
1947 @example
1948 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
1949 -qO - | gpg --import -
1950 @end example
1951
1952 @noindent
1953 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1954
1955 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
1956 signature!'' is normal.
1957
1958 @c end duplication
1959
1960 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1961 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1962
1963 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1964
1965 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1966
1967 @enumerate
1968 @item
1969 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1970
1971 @example
1972 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
1973 @end example
1974
1975 @item
1976 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1977 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1978 copy the image with:
1979
1980 @example
1981 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
1982 sync
1983 @end example
1984
1985 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1986 @end enumerate
1987
1988 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1989
1990 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1991
1992 @enumerate
1993 @item
1994 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1995
1996 @example
1997 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
1998 @end example
1999
2000 @item
2001 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2002 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2003 copy the image with:
2004
2005 @example
2006 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2007 @end example
2008
2009 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2010 @end enumerate
2011
2012 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2013
2014 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2015 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2016 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2017 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2018 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2019
2020 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2021 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2022
2023
2024 @node Preparing for Installation
2025 @section Preparing for Installation
2026
2027 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2028 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2029 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2030 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2031 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2032
2033 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2034 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2035 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2036 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2037 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2038 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2039 with the middle button.
2040
2041 @quotation Note
2042 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2043 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2044 ``Networking'' section below.
2045 @end quotation
2046
2047 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2048 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2049
2050 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2051 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2052
2053 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2054 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2055 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2056 the networking dialog.
2057
2058 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2059
2060 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2061 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2062 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2063 things.
2064
2065 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2066
2067 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2068 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2069
2070 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2071
2072 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2073 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2074 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2075 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2076
2077
2078 @node Manual Installation
2079 @section Manual Installation
2080
2081 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2082 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2083 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2084 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2085 Installation}).
2086
2087 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2088 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2089 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2090 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2091 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2092
2093 @menu
2094 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2095 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2096 @end menu
2097
2098 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2099 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2100
2101 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2102 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2103 guide you through this.
2104
2105 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2106
2107 @cindex keyboard layout
2108 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2109 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2110 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2111
2112 @example
2113 loadkeys dvorak
2114 @end example
2115
2116 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2117 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2118 more information.
2119
2120 @subsubsection Networking
2121
2122 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2123
2124 @example
2125 ifconfig -a
2126 @end example
2127
2128 @noindent
2129 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2130
2131 @example
2132 ip address
2133 @end example
2134
2135 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2136 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2137 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2138 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2139 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2140
2141 @table @asis
2142 @item Wired connection
2143 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2144 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2145
2146 @example
2147 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2148 @end example
2149
2150 @noindent
2151 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2152
2153 @example
2154 ip link set @var{interface} up
2155 @end example
2156
2157 @item Wireless connection
2158 @cindex wireless
2159 @cindex WiFi
2160 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2161 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2162 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2163 @command{nano}:
2164
2165 @example
2166 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2167 @end example
2168
2169 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2170 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2171 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2172
2173 @example
2174 network=@{
2175 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2176 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2177 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2178 @}
2179 @end example
2180
2181 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2182 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2183 network interface you want to use):
2184
2185 @example
2186 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2187 @end example
2188
2189 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2190 @end table
2191
2192 @cindex DHCP
2193 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2194 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2195
2196 @example
2197 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2198 @end example
2199
2200 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2201
2202 @example
2203 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2204 @end example
2205
2206 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2207 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2208
2209 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2210 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2211 following command:
2212
2213 @example
2214 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2215 @end example
2216
2217 @noindent
2218 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2219 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2220
2221 @cindex installing over SSH
2222 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2223 an SSH server:
2224
2225 @example
2226 herd start ssh-daemon
2227 @end example
2228
2229 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2230 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2231
2232 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2233
2234 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2235 then format the target partition(s).
2236
2237 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2238 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2239 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2240 the partition layout you want:
2241
2242 @example
2243 cfdisk
2244 @end example
2245
2246 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2247 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2248 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2249 manual}).
2250
2251 @cindex EFI, installation
2252 @cindex UEFI, installation
2253 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2254 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2255 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2256 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2257
2258 @example
2259 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2260 @end example
2261
2262 @quotation Note
2263 @vindex grub-bootloader
2264 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2265 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2266 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2267 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2268 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2269 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2270 bootloaders.
2271 @end quotation
2272
2273 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2274 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2275 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, and JFS file systems. In particular,
2276 code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2277 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2278 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2279
2280 @example
2281 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2282 @end example
2283
2284 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2285 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2286 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2287 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2288 deduplication}).
2289
2290 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2291 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2292 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2293 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2294 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2295 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2296
2297 @example
2298 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2299 @end example
2300
2301 @cindex encrypted disk
2302 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2303 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2304 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2305 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2306 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2307 be along these lines:
2308
2309 @example
2310 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2311 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2312 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2313 @end example
2314
2315 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2316 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2317 root file system):
2318
2319 @example
2320 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2321 @end example
2322
2323 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2324 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2325 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2326 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2327
2328 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2329 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2330 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2331 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2332
2333 @example
2334 mkswap /dev/sda3
2335 swapon /dev/sda3
2336 @end example
2337
2338 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2339 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2340 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2341 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2342 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2343 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2344
2345 @example
2346 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2347 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2348 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2349 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2350 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2351 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2355 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2356 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2357
2358 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2359 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2360
2361 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2362 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2363
2364 @example
2365 herd start cow-store /mnt
2366 @end example
2367
2368 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2369 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2370 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2371 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2372 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2373
2374 Next, you have to edit a file and
2375 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2376 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2377 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2378 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2379 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2380 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2381 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2382 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2383 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2384
2385 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2386 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2387 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2388 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2389 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2390 something along these lines:
2391
2392 @example
2393 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2394 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2395 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2396 @end example
2397
2398 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2399 in particular:
2400
2401 @itemize
2402 @item
2403 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2404 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2405 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2406 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2407 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2408 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2409 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2410 configuration.
2411
2412 @item
2413 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2414 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2415 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2416 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2417
2418 @item
2419 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2420 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2421 @end itemize
2422
2423 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2424 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2425 under @file{/mnt}):
2426
2427 @example
2428 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2429 @end example
2430
2431 @noindent
2432 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2433 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2434 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2435 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2436
2437 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2438 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2439 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2440 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2441 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2442 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2443 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2444
2445
2446 @node After System Installation
2447 @section After System Installation
2448
2449 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2450 system whenever you want by running, say:
2451
2452 @example
2453 guix pull
2454 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2455 @end example
2456
2457 @noindent
2458 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2459 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2460 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2461
2462 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2463 @quotation Note
2464 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2465 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2466 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2467 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2468
2469 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2470 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is ran
2471 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2472 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2473 @end quotation
2474
2475 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2476 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2477
2478
2479 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2480 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2481
2482 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2483 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2484 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2485 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2486 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2487 section is for you.
2488
2489 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2490 disk image, follow these steps:
2491
2492 @enumerate
2493 @item
2494 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2495 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2496
2497 @item
2498 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2499 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2500
2501 @example
2502 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2503 @end example
2504
2505 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2506 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2507
2508 @item
2509 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2510
2511 @example
2512 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2513 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2514 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2515 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2516 @end example
2517
2518 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2519 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2520
2521 @item
2522 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2523 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2524 @end enumerate
2525
2526 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2527 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2528 that.
2529
2530 @node Building the Installation Image
2531 @section Building the Installation Image
2532
2533 @cindex installation image
2534 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2535 system} command, specifically:
2536
2537 @example
2538 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2539 gnu/system/install.scm
2540 @end example
2541
2542 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2543 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2544 about the installation image.
2545
2546 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2547
2548 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2549 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2550
2551 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2552 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2553 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2554
2555 @example
2556 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2557 @end example
2558
2559 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2560 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2561
2562 @c *********************************************************************
2563 @node Package Management
2564 @chapter Package Management
2565
2566 @cindex packages
2567 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2568 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2569 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2570 features.
2571
2572 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2573 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2574 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2575 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2576 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2577 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2578 with it):
2579
2580 @example
2581 guix install emacs-guix
2582 @end example
2583
2584 @menu
2585 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2586 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2587 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2588 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2589 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2590 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2591 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2592 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2593 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2594 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2595 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2596 @end menu
2597
2598 @node Features
2599 @section Features
2600
2601 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2602 own directory---something that resembles
2603 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2604
2605 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2606 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2607 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2608 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2609
2610 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2611 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2612 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2613 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2614 simply continues to point to
2615 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2616 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2617
2618 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2619 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2620 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2621
2622 @cindex transactions
2623 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2624 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2625 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2626 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2627 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2628 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2629
2630 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2631 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2632 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2633 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2634 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2635 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2636 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2637
2638 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2639 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2640 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2641 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2642 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2643 collected.
2644
2645 @cindex reproducibility
2646 @cindex reproducible builds
2647 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2648 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2649 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2650 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2651 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2652 given package installation matches the current state of their
2653 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2654 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2655 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2656 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2657
2658 @cindex substitutes
2659 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2660 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2661 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2662 downloads it and unpacks it;
2663 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2664 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2665 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2666 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2667 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2668
2669 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2670 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2671 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2672 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2673 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2674
2675 @cindex replication, of software environments
2676 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2677 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2678 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2679 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2680 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2681 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2682 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2683
2684 @node Invoking guix package
2685 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2686
2687 @cindex installing packages
2688 @cindex removing packages
2689 @cindex package installation
2690 @cindex package removal
2691 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2692 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2693 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2694 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2695 is:
2696
2697 @example
2698 guix package @var{options}
2699 @end example
2700
2701 @cindex transactions
2702 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2703 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2704 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2705 want to roll back.
2706
2707 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2708 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2709
2710 @example
2711 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2712 @end example
2713
2714 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2715 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2716
2717 @itemize
2718 @item
2719 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2720 @item
2721 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2722 @item
2723 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2724 @item
2725 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
2726 @item
2727 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
2728 @end itemize
2729
2730 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2731 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2732 package} directly.
2733
2734 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2735 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2736 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2737 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2738
2739 @cindex profile
2740 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2741 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2742 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2743 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
2744 variable, and so on.
2745 @cindex search paths
2746 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2747 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2748 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2749 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2750
2751 @example
2752 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2753 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2754 @end example
2755
2756 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2757 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2758 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2759 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2760 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2761 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2762 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2763 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2764 package}.
2765
2766 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2767
2768 @table @code
2769
2770 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2771 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2772 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2773
2774 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2775 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2776 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2777 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
2778
2779 If no version number is specified, the
2780 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2781 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2782 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2783 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2784 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2785 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2786
2787 @cindex propagated inputs
2788 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2789 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2790 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2791 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2792 package definitions).
2793
2794 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2795 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2796 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2797 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2798 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2799 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2800
2801 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2802 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2803 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2804 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2805
2806 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2807 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2808 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2809
2810 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2811 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2812 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2813 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2814
2815 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2816 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2817 multiple-output package.
2818
2819 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2820 @itemx -f @var{file}
2821 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2822
2823 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2824 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2825
2826 @lisp
2827 @include package-hello.scm
2828 @end lisp
2829
2830 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2831 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2832 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2833 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2834
2835 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
2836 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
2837 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
2838 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
2839
2840 @example
2841 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
2842 @end example
2843
2844 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2845 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2846 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2847
2848 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2849 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2850 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2851 @code{glibc}.
2852
2853 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2854 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2855 @cindex upgrading packages
2856 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2857 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2858 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2859
2860 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2861 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2862 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2863 pull}).
2864
2865 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2866 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2867 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2868 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2869 substring ``emacs'':
2870
2871 @example
2872 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2873 @end example
2874
2875 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2876 @itemx -m @var{file}
2877 @cindex profile declaration
2878 @cindex profile manifest
2879 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2880 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
2881 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
2882
2883 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2884 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
2885 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2886 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2887 so on.
2888
2889 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2890 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2891 of packages:
2892
2893 @findex packages->manifest
2894 @lisp
2895 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2896
2897 (packages->manifest
2898 (list emacs
2899 guile-2.0
2900 ;; Use a specific package output.
2901 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2902 @end lisp
2903
2904 @findex specifications->manifest
2905 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2906 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2907 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2908 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2909 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2910 objects, like this:
2911
2912 @lisp
2913 (specifications->manifest
2914 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2915 @end lisp
2916
2917 @item --roll-back
2918 @cindex rolling back
2919 @cindex undoing transactions
2920 @cindex transactions, undoing
2921 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2922 the last transaction.
2923
2924 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
2925 before any other actions.
2926
2927 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2928 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2929 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2930
2931 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2932 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2933 generations in a profile is always linear.
2934
2935 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2936 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2937 @cindex generations
2938 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2939
2940 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2941 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2942 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2943 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
2944 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
2945
2946 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
2947 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
2948 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2949 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2950
2951 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2952 @cindex search paths
2953 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2954 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2955 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2956 of the installed packages.
2957
2958 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
2959 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2960 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2961 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2962 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
2963 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
2964 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2965
2966 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2967 shell:
2968
2969 @example
2970 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2971 @end example
2972
2973 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2974 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2975 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2976 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2977
2978 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2979 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2980
2981 @example
2982 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2983 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2984 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2985 @end example
2986
2987 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2988 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2989 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2990
2991
2992 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2993 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2994 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2995
2996 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
2997 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
2998 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
2999 installed:
3000
3001 @example
3002 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3003 @dots{}
3004 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3005 Hello, world!
3006 @end example
3007
3008 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3009 siblings that point to specific generations:
3010
3011 @example
3012 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3013 @end example
3014
3015 @item --list-profiles
3016 List all the user's profiles:
3017
3018 @example
3019 $ guix package --list-profiles
3020 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3021 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3022 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3023 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3024 @end example
3025
3026 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3027
3028 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3029 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3030 @cindex profile collisions
3031 @item --allow-collisions
3032 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3033
3034 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3035 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3036 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3037
3038 @item --bootstrap
3039 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3040 useful to distribution developers.
3041
3042 @end table
3043
3044 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3045 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3046 availability of packages:
3047
3048 @table @option
3049
3050 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3051 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3052 @anchor{guix-search}
3053 @cindex searching for packages
3054 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3055 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3056 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3057 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3058 GNU recutils manual}).
3059
3060 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3061 command, for instance:
3062
3063 @example
3064 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3065 name: jemalloc
3066 version: 4.5.0
3067 relevance: 6
3068
3069 name: glibc
3070 version: 2.25
3071 relevance: 1
3072
3073 name: libgc
3074 version: 7.6.0
3075 relevance: 1
3076 @end example
3077
3078 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3079 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3080
3081 @example
3082 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3083 name: elfutils
3084
3085 name: gmp
3086 @dots{}
3087 @end example
3088
3089 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3090 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3091 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3092 the @command{guix search} alias):
3093
3094 @example
3095 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3096 name: gnubg
3097 @dots{}
3098 @end example
3099
3100 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3101 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3102 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3103 keyboards.
3104
3105 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3106 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3107 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3108
3109 @example
3110 $ guix search crypto library | \
3111 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3112 @end example
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3116 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3117
3118 @item --show=@var{package}
3119 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3120 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3121 recutils manual}).
3122
3123 @example
3124 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3125 name: python
3126 version: 2.7.6
3127
3128 name: python
3129 version: 3.3.5
3130 @end example
3131
3132 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3133 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3134 @example
3135 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3136 name: python
3137 version: 3.4.3
3138 @end example
3139
3140
3141
3142 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3143 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3144 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3145 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3146 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3147
3148 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3149 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3150 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3151 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3152 the store.
3153
3154 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3155 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3156 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3157 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3158 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3159
3160 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3161 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3162 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3163
3164 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3165 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3166 @cindex generations
3167 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3168 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3169 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3170 shown.
3171
3172 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3173 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3174 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3175 location of this package in the store.
3176
3177 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3178 generations. Valid patterns include:
3179
3180 @itemize
3181 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3182 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3183 the first one.
3184
3185 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3186 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3187
3188 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3189 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3190 a range must be smaller than its end.
3191
3192 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3193 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3194 second one.
3195
3196 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3197 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3198 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3199 that are up to 20 days old.
3200 @end itemize
3201
3202 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3203 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3204 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3205 one.
3206
3207 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3208 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3209 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3210 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3211 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3212
3213 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3214 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3215
3216 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3217 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3218
3219 @end table
3220
3221 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3222 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3223 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3224 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3225 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3226 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3227 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3228 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3229
3230 @node Substitutes
3231 @section Substitutes
3232
3233 @cindex substitutes
3234 @cindex pre-built binaries
3235 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3236 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3237 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3238 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3239 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3240
3241 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3242 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3243 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3244 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3245
3246 @menu
3247 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3248 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3249 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3250 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3251 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3252 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3253 @end menu
3254
3255 @node Official Substitute Server
3256 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3257
3258 @cindex build farm
3259 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3260 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3261 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3262 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3263 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3264 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3265 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3266 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3267 option}).
3268
3269 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3270 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3271 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3272 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3273 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3274
3275 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3276 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3277 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3278 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3279 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3280 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3281 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3282 other substitute server.
3283
3284 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3285 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3286
3287 @cindex security
3288 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3289 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3290 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3291 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3292 mirror thereof, you
3293 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3294 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3295 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3296 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3297
3298 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3299 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3300 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3301 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3302 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3303 Then, you can run something like this:
3304
3305 @example
3306 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3307 @end example
3308
3309 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3310 should change from something like:
3311
3312 @example
3313 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3314 The following derivations would be built:
3315 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3316 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3317 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3318 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3319 @dots{}
3320 @end example
3321
3322 @noindent
3323 to something like:
3324
3325 @example
3326 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3327 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3328 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3329 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3330 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3331 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3332 @dots{}
3333 @end example
3334
3335 @noindent
3336 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3337 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3338 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3339 possible, for future builds.
3340
3341 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3342 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3343 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3344 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3345 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3346 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3347
3348 @node Substitute Authentication
3349 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3350
3351 @cindex digital signatures
3352 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3353 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3354 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3355
3356 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3357 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3358 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3359 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3360 with this option:
3361
3362 @example
3363 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3364 @end example
3365
3366 @noindent
3367 @cindex reproducible builds
3368 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3369 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3370 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3371 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3372 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3373 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3374 below).
3375
3376 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3377 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3378 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3379 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3380 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3381 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3382
3383 @node Proxy Settings
3384 @subsection Proxy Settings
3385
3386 @vindex http_proxy
3387 @vindex https_proxy
3388 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS. The @env{http_proxy} and
3389 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3390 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3391 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3392 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3393 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3394
3395 @node Substitution Failure
3396 @subsection Substitution Failure
3397
3398 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3399 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3400 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3401 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3402 etc.
3403
3404 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3405 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3406 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3407 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3408 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3409 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3410 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3411 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3412 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3413 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3414 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3415 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3416 @option{--fallback} was given.
3417
3418 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3419 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3420 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3421 by a server.
3422
3423 @node On Trusting Binaries
3424 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3425
3426 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3427 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3428 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3429 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3430 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3431 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3432 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3433 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3434 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3435 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3436
3437 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3438 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3439 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3440 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3441 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3442 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3443 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3444 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3445 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3446 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3447 @command{guix build --check}}).
3448
3449 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3450 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3451 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3452
3453 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3454 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3455
3456 @cindex multiple-output packages
3457 @cindex package outputs
3458 @cindex outputs
3459
3460 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3461 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3462 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3463 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3464 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3465 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3466 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3467 files.
3468
3469 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3470 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3471 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3472 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3473 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3474 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3475 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3476
3477 @example
3478 guix install glib
3479 @end example
3480
3481 @cindex documentation
3482 The command to install its documentation is:
3483
3484 @example
3485 guix install glib:doc
3486 @end example
3487
3488 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3489 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3490 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3491 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3492 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3493 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3494 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3495 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3496 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3497
3498 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3499 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3500 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3501 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3502 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3503 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3504 guix package}).
3505
3506
3507 @node Invoking guix gc
3508 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3509
3510 @cindex garbage collector
3511 @cindex disk space
3512 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3513 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3514 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3515 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3516 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3517
3518 @cindex GC roots
3519 @cindex garbage collector roots
3520 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3521 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3522 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3523 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3524 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3525 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3526 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3527 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3528
3529 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3530 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3531 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3532 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3533 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3534
3535 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3536 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3537 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3538
3539 @example
3540 guix gc -F 5G
3541 @end example
3542
3543 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3544 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3545 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3546 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3547 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3548 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3549 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3550
3551 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3552 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3553 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3554 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3555 options are as follows:
3556
3557 @table @code
3558 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3559 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3560 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3561 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3562 specified.
3563
3564 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3565 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3566 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3567 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3568
3569 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3570
3571 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3572 @itemx -F @var{free}
3573 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3574 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3575 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3576
3577 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3578 nothing and exit immediately.
3579
3580 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3581 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3582 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3583 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3584 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3585
3586 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3587 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3588 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3589
3590 @example
3591 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3592 @end example
3593
3594 @item --delete
3595 @itemx -D
3596 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3597 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3598 they are still live.
3599
3600 @item --list-failures
3601 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3602
3603 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3604 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3605 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3606
3607 @item --list-roots
3608 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3609 roots.
3610
3611 @item --list-busy
3612 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
3613 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
3614
3615 @item --clear-failures
3616 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3617
3618 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3619 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3620
3621 @item --list-dead
3622 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3623 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3624
3625 @item --list-live
3626 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3627
3628 @end table
3629
3630 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3631
3632 @table @code
3633
3634 @item --references
3635 @itemx --referrers
3636 @cindex package dependencies
3637 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3638 as arguments.
3639
3640 @item --requisites
3641 @itemx -R
3642 @cindex closure
3643 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3644 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3645 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3646 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3647
3648 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3649 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3650 the graph of references.
3651
3652 @item --derivers
3653 @cindex derivation
3654 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3655 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3656
3657 For example, this command:
3658
3659 @example
3660 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3661 @end example
3662
3663 @noindent
3664 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3665 installed in your profile.
3666
3667 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3668 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3669 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3670 @end table
3671
3672 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3673 store and to control disk usage.
3674
3675 @table @option
3676
3677 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3678 @cindex integrity, of the store
3679 @cindex integrity checking
3680 Verify the integrity of the store.
3681
3682 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3683 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3684
3685 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3686 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3687
3688 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3689 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3690 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3691 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3692 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3693
3694 @cindex repairing the store
3695 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3696 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3697 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3698 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3699 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3700 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3701 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3702 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3703
3704 @item --optimize
3705 @cindex deduplication
3706 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3707 @dfn{deduplication}.
3708
3709 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3710 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
3711 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3712 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3713 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
3714
3715 @end table
3716
3717 @node Invoking guix pull
3718 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3719
3720 @cindex upgrading Guix
3721 @cindex updating Guix
3722 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3723 @cindex pull
3724 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
3725 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
3726 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3727 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3728 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3729 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3730 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3731 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3732 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
3733 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
3734 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
3735
3736 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
3737 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
3738
3739 @enumerate
3740 @item
3741 the @option{--channels} option;
3742 @item
3743 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
3744 @item
3745 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
3746 @item
3747 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
3748 variable.
3749 @end enumerate
3750
3751 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3752 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3753 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3754 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3755 become available.
3756
3757 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3758 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
3759 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3760 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3761 versa.
3762
3763 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3764 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3765 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3766 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3767 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3768
3769 @example
3770 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3771 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3772 @end example
3773
3774 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
3775 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3776
3777 @example
3778 $ guix pull -l
3779 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3780 guix 65956ad
3781 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3782 branch: origin/master
3783 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3784
3785 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3786 guix e0cc7f6
3787 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3788 branch: origin/master
3789 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3790 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3791 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3792 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3793 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3794
3795 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3796 guix 844cc1c
3797 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3798 branch: origin/master
3799 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3800 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3801 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3802 @end example
3803
3804 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3805 describe the current status of Guix.
3806
3807 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
3808 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3809 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3810 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3811
3812 @example
3813 $ guix pull --roll-back
3814 switched from generation 3 to 2
3815 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
3816 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3817 @end example
3818
3819 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
3820 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
3821 @example
3822 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3823 switched from generation 3 to 2
3824 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3825 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3826 @end example
3827
3828 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3829 but it supports the following options:
3830
3831 @table @code
3832 @item --url=@var{url}
3833 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3834 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3835 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3836 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3837 string), or @var{branch}.
3838
3839 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3840 @cindex configuration file for channels
3841 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3842 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3843 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3844
3845 @item --channels=@var{file}
3846 @itemx -C @var{file}
3847 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3848 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
3849 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3850 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3851 information.
3852
3853 @cindex channel news
3854 @item --news
3855 @itemx -N
3856 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
3857 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
3858 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
3859
3860 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
3861 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
3862 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
3863
3864 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3865 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3866 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3867 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3868 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3869 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3870
3871 @item --roll-back
3872 @cindex rolling back
3873 @cindex undoing transactions
3874 @cindex transactions, undoing
3875 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
3876 undo the last transaction.
3877
3878 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3879 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3880 @cindex generations
3881 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3882
3883 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3884 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3885 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3886 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3887 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3888
3889 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3890 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3891 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3892 one.
3893
3894 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3895 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3896 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3897 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3898 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3899
3900 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
3901
3902 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3903 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3904
3905 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3906 current generation only.
3907
3908 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3909 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3910 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3911
3912 @item --dry-run
3913 @itemx -n
3914 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3915 substituted but do not actually do it.
3916
3917 @item --allow-downgrades
3918 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
3919 currently in use.
3920
3921 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
3922 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
3923 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
3924 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
3925 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
3926
3927 @quotation Note
3928 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
3929 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
3930 @end quotation
3931
3932 @item --disable-authentication
3933 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
3934
3935 @cindex authentication, of channel code
3936 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
3937 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
3938 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
3939 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
3940
3941 @quotation Note
3942 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
3943 @option{--disable-authentication}.
3944 @end quotation
3945
3946 @item --system=@var{system}
3947 @itemx -s @var{system}
3948 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3949 the system type of the build host.
3950
3951 @item --bootstrap
3952 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3953 useful to Guix developers.
3954 @end table
3955
3956 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3957 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3958 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3959 information.
3960
3961 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3962 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3963
3964 @node Channels
3965 @section Channels
3966
3967 @cindex channels
3968 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3969 @cindex configuration file for channels
3970 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3971 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3972 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3973 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3974 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3975 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3976 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3977 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3978 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
3979 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3980 Before that, some security considerations.
3981
3982 @subsection Channel Authentication
3983
3984 @anchor{channel-authentication}
3985 @cindex authentication, of channel code
3986 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
3987 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
3988 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
3989 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
3990 lead users to run malicious code.
3991
3992 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
3993 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
3994 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
3995 along these lines:
3996
3997 @lisp
3998 (channel
3999 (name 'my-channel)
4000 (url "https://example.org/my-channel.git")
4001 (introduction
4002 (make-channel-introduction
4003 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
4004 (openpgp-fingerprint
4005 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
4006 @end lisp
4007
4008 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
4009 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
4010 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
4011 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
4012
4013 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
4014 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
4015 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
4016 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
4017 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
4018
4019 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
4020
4021 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
4022
4023 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
4024 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
4025 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
4026 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
4027 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
4028
4029 @lisp
4030 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
4031 (list (channel
4032 (name 'guix)
4033 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
4034 (branch "super-hacks")))
4035 @end lisp
4036
4037 @noindent
4038 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
4039 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
4040
4041 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
4042
4043 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
4044 @cindex personal packages (channels)
4045 @cindex channels, for personal packages
4046 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
4047 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
4048 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
4049 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
4050 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
4051 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
4052 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
4053
4054 @c What follows stems from discussions at
4055 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
4056 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
4057 @quotation Warning
4058 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
4059 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
4060 of caution:
4061
4062 @itemize
4063 @item
4064 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
4065 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
4066 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
4067 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
4068 process.
4069
4070 @item
4071 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
4072 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
4073 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
4074 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
4075 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
4076 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
4077 either.
4078
4079 @item
4080 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
4081 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
4082 @end itemize
4083
4084 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
4085 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
4086 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
4087 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
4088 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
4089 @end quotation
4090
4091 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
4092 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
4093 channel(s):
4094
4095 @vindex %default-channels
4096 @lisp
4097 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
4098 (cons (channel
4099 (name 'my-personal-packages)
4100 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
4101 %default-channels)
4102 @end lisp
4103
4104 @noindent
4105 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
4106 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
4107 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
4108 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
4109 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
4110 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
4111 modules:
4112
4113 @example
4114 $ guix pull --list-generations
4115 @dots{}
4116 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
4117 guix d894ab8
4118 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4119 branch: master
4120 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4121 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
4122 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
4123 branch: master
4124 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4125 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4126 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4127 @end example
4128
4129 @noindent
4130 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4131 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
4132 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
4133 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4134 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4135
4136 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
4137 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
4138 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
4139 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
4140 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
4141 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
4142 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
4143 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
4144 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
4145 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
4146
4147 @cindex dependencies, channels
4148 @cindex meta-data, channels
4149 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
4150
4151 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
4152 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
4153 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
4154 the channel repository.
4155
4156 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
4157
4158 @lisp
4159 (channel
4160 (version 0)
4161 (dependencies
4162 (channel
4163 (name some-collection)
4164 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
4165
4166 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
4167 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
4168 (introduction
4169 (channel-introduction
4170 (version 0)
4171 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
4172 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
4173 (channel
4174 (name some-other-collection)
4175 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
4176 (branch "testing"))))
4177 @end lisp
4178
4179 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
4180 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
4181 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
4182 channels are available.
4183
4184 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
4185 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
4186 dependencies to a minimum.
4187
4188 @cindex subdirectory, channels
4189 @subsection Package Modules in a Sub-directory
4190
4191 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
4192 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
4193 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
4194
4195 @lisp
4196 (channel
4197 (version 0)
4198 (directory "guix"))
4199 @end lisp
4200
4201 @cindex channel authorizations
4202 @subsection Specifying Channel Authorizations
4203
4204 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
4205 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
4206 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
4207 specify the list of authorized developers in the
4208 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
4209 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
4210 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
4211 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
4212 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
4213 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
4214 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
4215 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
4216 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
4217
4218 @lisp
4219 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
4220
4221 (authorizations
4222 (version 0) ;current file format version
4223
4224 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
4225 (name "alice"))
4226 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
4227 (name "bob"))
4228 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
4229 (name "charlie"))))
4230 @end lisp
4231
4232 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
4233 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
4234
4235 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
4236 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
4237 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
4238 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
4239
4240 @cindex channel introduction
4241 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
4242 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
4243 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
4244 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
4245 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
4246 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
4247
4248 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are two things you have
4249 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
4250
4251 @enumerate
4252 @item
4253 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
4254 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
4255 information on how to sign Git commits.)
4256
4257 @item
4258 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
4259 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
4260 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
4261 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
4262 @end enumerate
4263
4264 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
4265 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
4266 about to push with an authorized key:
4267
4268 @example
4269 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
4270 @end example
4271
4272 @noindent
4273 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
4274 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
4275
4276 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
4277 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
4278 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
4279 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
4280 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
4281 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
4282
4283 @cindex primary URL, channels
4284 @subsection Primary URL
4285
4286 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
4287 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
4288
4289 @lisp
4290 (channel
4291 (version 0)
4292 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
4293 @end lisp
4294
4295 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
4296 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
4297 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL. That way,
4298 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
4299 not receive security updates.
4300
4301 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
4302 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
4303 the code it fetches is authentic.
4304
4305 @cindex news, for channels
4306 @subsection Writing Channel News
4307
4308 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
4309 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
4310 an email, but that's not convenient.
4311
4312 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
4313 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
4314 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
4315 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
4316
4317 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
4318 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
4319
4320 @lisp
4321 (channel
4322 (version 0)
4323 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
4324 @end lisp
4325
4326 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
4327 something like this:
4328
4329 @lisp
4330 (channel-news
4331 (version 0)
4332 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
4333 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
4334 (fr "Oh la la"))
4335 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
4336 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
4337 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
4338 (title (en "Added a great package")
4339 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
4340 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
4341 @end lisp
4342
4343 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
4344 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
4345 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
4346 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
4347
4348 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
4349 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
4350 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
4351 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
4352 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
4353
4354 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
4355 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
4356 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
4357 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
4358 file containing the strings to translate:
4359
4360 @example
4361 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.scm
4362 @end example
4363
4364 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
4365 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
4366
4367 @subsection Replicating Guix
4368
4369 @cindex pinning, channels
4370 @cindex replicating Guix
4371 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4372 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
4373 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
4374 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
4375 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
4376
4377 @lisp
4378 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
4379 (list (channel
4380 (name 'guix)
4381 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4382 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
4383 (channel
4384 (name 'my-personal-packages)
4385 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
4386 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
4387 @end lisp
4388
4389 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
4390 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
4391 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
4392 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
4393 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
4394
4395 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
4396 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
4397 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
4398 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
4399 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
4400 package it defines.
4401
4402 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
4403 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
4404 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
4405 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
4406
4407 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4408 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4409
4410 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4411 @cindex pinning, channels
4412 @cindex replicating Guix
4413 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4414
4415 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4416 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4417 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4418 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4419 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4420 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4421
4422 The general syntax is:
4423
4424 @example
4425 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4426 @end example
4427
4428 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4429 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4430 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4431
4432 @table @code
4433 @item --url=@var{url}
4434 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4435 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4436 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4437 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4438 string), or @var{branch}.
4439
4440 @item --channels=@var{file}
4441 @itemx -C @var{file}
4442 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4443 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4444 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4445 @end table
4446
4447 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4448 the latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4449
4450 @example
4451 guix time-machine -- build hello
4452 @end example
4453
4454 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4455 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4456 Time travel works in both directions!
4457
4458 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4459 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4460 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4461
4462 @node Inferiors
4463 @section Inferiors
4464
4465 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4466 @quotation Note
4467 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4468 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4469 @end quotation
4470
4471 @cindex inferiors
4472 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4473 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4474 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4475 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4476 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4477
4478 @cindex inferior packages
4479 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4480 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4481 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4482 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4483 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4484
4485 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4486 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4487 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4488 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4489 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4490 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4491 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4492 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4493 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4494
4495 @lisp
4496 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4497 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4498
4499 (define channels
4500 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4501 ;; extract guile-json.
4502 (list (channel
4503 (name 'guix)
4504 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4505 (commit
4506 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4507
4508 (define inferior
4509 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4510 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4511
4512 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4513 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4514 (packages->manifest
4515 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4516 (specification->package "guile")))
4517 @end lisp
4518
4519 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4520 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4521 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4522
4523 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4524 inferior:
4525
4526 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4527 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4528 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4529 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4530 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4531
4532 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4533 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4537 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4538 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4539 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4540 the inferior could not be launched.
4541 @end deffn
4542
4543 @cindex inferior packages
4544 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4545 packages.
4546
4547 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4548 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4552 [@var{version}]
4553 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4554 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4555 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4556 @end deffn
4557
4558 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4559 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4560 @end deffn
4561
4562 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4563 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4564 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4565 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4566 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4567 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4568 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4569 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4570 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4571 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4572 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4573 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4574 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4575 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4576 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4577 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4578 these procedures.
4579 @end deffn
4580
4581 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4582 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4583 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4584 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4585 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4586 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4587 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4588 declaration, and so on.
4589
4590 @node Invoking guix describe
4591 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4592
4593 @cindex reproducibility
4594 @cindex replicating Guix
4595 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4596 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4597 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4598 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4599 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4600 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4601 command answers these questions.
4602
4603 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4604 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4605 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4606
4607 @example
4608 $ guix describe
4609 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4610 guix e0fa68c
4611 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4612 branch: master
4613 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4614 @end example
4615
4616 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4617 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4618 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4619 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4620 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4621 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4622 also to replicate it.
4623
4624 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4625 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4626
4627 @example
4628 $ guix describe -f channels
4629 (list (channel
4630 (name 'guix)
4631 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4632 (commit
4633 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4634 (introduction
4635 (make-channel-introduction
4636 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4637 (openpgp-fingerprint
4638 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4639 @end example
4640
4641 @noindent
4642 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4643 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4644 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4645 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4646 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4647 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4648
4649 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4650 follows:
4651
4652 @table @code
4653 @item --format=@var{format}
4654 @itemx -f @var{format}
4655 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4656
4657 @table @code
4658 @item human
4659 produce human-readable output;
4660 @item channels
4661 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4662 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4663 guix pull});
4664 @item channels-sans-intro
4665 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4666 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4667 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4668 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4669 supported by these older versions;
4670 @item json
4671 @cindex JSON
4672 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4673 @item recutils
4674 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4675 @end table
4676
4677 @item --list-formats
4678 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4679
4680 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4681 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4682 Display information about @var{profile}.
4683 @end table
4684
4685 @node Invoking guix archive
4686 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4687
4688 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4689 @cindex archive
4690 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4691 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4692 a machine that runs Guix.
4693 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4694 to the store on another machine.
4695
4696 @quotation Note
4697 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4698 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4699 @end quotation
4700
4701 @cindex exporting store items
4702 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4703
4704 @example
4705 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4706 @end example
4707
4708 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4709 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4710 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4711 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4712 output of @code{emacs}:
4713
4714 @example
4715 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4716 @end example
4717
4718 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4719 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4720 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4721
4722 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4723 one would run:
4724
4725 @example
4726 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4727 @end example
4728
4729 @noindent
4730 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4731 to another like this:
4732
4733 @example
4734 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4735 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4736 @end example
4737
4738 @noindent
4739 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4740 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4741 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4742 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4743 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4744 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4745 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4746
4747 @cindex nar, archive format
4748 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4749 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4750 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4751 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4752 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4753 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4754 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4755 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4756 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4757 deterministic.
4758
4759 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4760 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4761 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4762 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4763 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4764
4765 The main options are:
4766
4767 @table @code
4768 @item --export
4769 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4770 resulting archive to the standard output.
4771
4772 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4773 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4774
4775 @item -r
4776 @itemx --recursive
4777 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4778 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4779 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4780 exported store items.
4781
4782 @item --import
4783 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4784 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4785 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4786 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4787
4788 @item --missing
4789 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4790 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4791 the store.
4792
4793 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4794 @cindex signing, archives
4795 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4796 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. Note that this
4797 operation usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy
4798 to generate the key pair.
4799
4800 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4801 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4802 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4803 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4804 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4805 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4806 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4807 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4808 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4809
4810 @item --authorize
4811 @cindex authorizing, archives
4812 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4813 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4814 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4815
4816 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4817 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4818 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4819 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4820 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4821 (SPKI)}.
4822
4823 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4824 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4825 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4826 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4827 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4828
4829 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4830 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4831
4832 @example
4833 $ wget -O - \
4834 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4835 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4836 @end example
4837
4838 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4839 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4840 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4841 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4842 unsafe.
4843
4844 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4845 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4846 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4847
4848 @item --list
4849 @itemx -t
4850 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4851 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4852 this example:
4853
4854 @example
4855 $ wget -O - \
4856 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4857 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4858 @end example
4859
4860 @end table
4861
4862
4863 @c *********************************************************************
4864 @node Development
4865 @chapter Development
4866
4867 @cindex software development
4868 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4869 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4870 this chapter is about.
4871
4872 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4873 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4874 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4875 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4876 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4877
4878 @menu
4879 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4880 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4881 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
4882 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
4883 @end menu
4884
4885 @node Invoking guix environment
4886 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4887
4888 @cindex reproducible build environments
4889 @cindex development environments
4890 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4891 @cindex environment, package build environment
4892 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4893 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4894 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4895 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4896 environment to use them.
4897
4898 The general syntax is:
4899
4900 @example
4901 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4902 @end example
4903
4904 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4905 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4906
4907 @example
4908 guix environment guile
4909 @end example
4910
4911 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4912 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
4913 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
4914 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
4915 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
4916 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
4917 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
4918 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
4919 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
4920 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
4921 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
4922 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
4923 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
4924 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
4925 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
4926
4927 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4928 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4929 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4930 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4931 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4932 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4933
4934 @example
4935 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4936 then
4937 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4938 fi
4939 @end example
4940
4941 @noindent
4942 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4943
4944 @example
4945 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4946 @end example
4947
4948 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4949 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4950 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4951 and Emacs are available:
4952
4953 @example
4954 guix environment guile emacs
4955 @end example
4956
4957 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4958 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4959 command from the rest of the arguments:
4960
4961 @example
4962 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4963 @end example
4964
4965 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4966 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4967 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4968 NumPy:
4969
4970 @example
4971 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4972 @end example
4973
4974 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4975 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4976 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4977 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4978 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4979 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4980 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4981 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4982 additionally includes Git and strace:
4983
4984 @example
4985 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
4986 @end example
4987
4988 @cindex container
4989 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4990 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4991 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4992 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4993 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4994 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4995 working directory are mounted:
4996
4997 @example
4998 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4999 @end example
5000
5001 @quotation Note
5002 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5003 @end quotation
5004
5005 @cindex certificates
5006 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5007 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5008 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5009 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5010 the @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5011 applications won't display without it.
5012
5013 @example
5014 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5015 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5016 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5017 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5018 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5019 @end example
5020
5021 The available options are summarized below.
5022
5023 @table @code
5024 @item --root=@var{file}
5025 @itemx -r @var{file}
5026 @cindex persistent environment
5027 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5028 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5029 register it as a garbage collector root.
5030
5031 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5032 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5033
5034 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5035 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5036 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5037 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5038 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5039
5040 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5041 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5042 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5043 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5044
5045 For example, running:
5046
5047 @example
5048 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5049 @end example
5050
5051 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5052 PETSc package.
5053
5054 Running:
5055
5056 @example
5057 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5058 @end example
5059
5060 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5061
5062 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5063 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5064
5065 @example
5066 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5067 @end example
5068
5069 @item --load=@var{file}
5070 @itemx -l @var{file}
5071 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5072 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5073
5074 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5075 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5076
5077 @lisp
5078 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5079 @end lisp
5080
5081 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5082 @itemx -m @var{file}
5083 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5084 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5085 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5086
5087 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5088 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5089 manifest files.
5090
5091 @item --ad-hoc
5092 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5093 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5094 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5095 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5096
5097 For instance, the command:
5098
5099 @example
5100 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5101 @end example
5102
5103 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5104 available.
5105
5106 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5107 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5108 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5109 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5110
5111 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5112 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5113 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5114 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5115 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5116
5117 @item --pure
5118 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5119 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5120 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5121
5122 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5123 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5124 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5125 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5126 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5127 several times.
5128
5129 @example
5130 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5131 -- mpirun @dots{}
5132 @end example
5133
5134 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5135 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5136 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5137 @env{USER}, etc.).
5138
5139 @item --search-paths
5140 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5141 environment.
5142
5143 @item --system=@var{system}
5144 @itemx -s @var{system}
5145 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5146
5147 @item --container
5148 @itemx -C
5149 @cindex container
5150 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5151 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5152 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5153 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5154 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5155
5156 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5157 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5158 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5159
5160 @item --network
5161 @itemx -N
5162 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5163 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5164 device.
5165
5166 @item --link-profile
5167 @itemx -P
5168 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5169 within the container. This is equivalent to running the command
5170 @samp{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile} within the container.
5171 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5172 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5173 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5174
5175 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5176 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5177 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5178 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5179 behave as expected within the environment.
5180
5181 @item --user=@var{user}
5182 @itemx -u @var{user}
5183 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5184 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5185 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5186 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5187 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5188 need not exist on the system.
5189
5190 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5191 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5192 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5193 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5194
5195 @example
5196 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5197 cd $HOME/wd
5198 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5199 --expose=$HOME/test \
5200 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5201 @end example
5202
5203 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5204 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5205 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5206
5207 @item --no-cwd
5208 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5209 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5210 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5211 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5212 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5213 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5214
5215 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5216 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5217 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5218 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5219 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5220 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5221 point in the container.
5222
5223 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5224 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5225 directory:
5226
5227 @example
5228 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5229 @end example
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @command{guix environment}
5234 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5235 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5236 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5237
5238 @node Invoking guix pack
5239 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5240
5241 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5242 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5243 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5244 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5245
5246 @quotation Note
5247 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5248 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5249 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5250 @end quotation
5251
5252 @cindex pack
5253 @cindex bundle
5254 @cindex application bundle
5255 @cindex software bundle
5256 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5257 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5258 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5259 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5260 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5261 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5262 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5263 that you pretend to be shipping.
5264
5265 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5266 their dependencies, you can run:
5267
5268 @example
5269 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5270 @dots{}
5271 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5272 @end example
5273
5274 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5275 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5276 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5277 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5278 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5279 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5280
5281 Users of this pack would have to run
5282 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5283 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5284 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5285
5286 @example
5287 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5288 @end example
5289
5290 @noindent
5291 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5292
5293 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5294 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5295 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5296 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5297 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5298 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5299 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5300 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5301
5302 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5303 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5304 the following command:
5305
5306 @example
5307 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5308 @end example
5309
5310 @noindent
5311 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5312 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5313
5314 @example
5315 docker load < @var{file}
5316 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5317 @end example
5318
5319 @noindent
5320 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5321 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5322 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5323 documentation} for more information.
5324
5325 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5326 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5327 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5328 command:
5329
5330 @example
5331 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5332 @end example
5333
5334 @noindent
5335 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5336 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5337 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5338 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5339 @command{singularity exec}.
5340
5341 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5342
5343 @table @code
5344 @item --format=@var{format}
5345 @itemx -f @var{format}
5346 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5347
5348 The available formats are:
5349
5350 @table @code
5351 @item tarball
5352 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5353 specified binaries and symlinks.
5354
5355 @item docker
5356 This produces a tarball that follows the
5357 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5358 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5359 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5360 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5361
5362 @item squashfs
5363 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5364 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5365 procfs.
5366
5367 @quotation Note
5368 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5369 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5370 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5371 with something like:
5372
5373 @example
5374 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5375 @end example
5376
5377 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5378 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5379 such file or directory'' message.
5380 @end quotation
5381 @end table
5382
5383 @cindex relocatable binaries
5384 @item --relocatable
5385 @itemx -R
5386 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5387 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5388
5389 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5390 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5391 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5392 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5393 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
5394 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
5395 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
5396
5397 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5398
5399 @example
5400 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5401 @end example
5402
5403 @noindent
5404 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5405 home directory as a normal user, run:
5406
5407 @example
5408 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5409 ./mybin/sh
5410 @end example
5411
5412 @noindent
5413 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5414 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5415 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5416 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5417 software on a non-Guix machine.
5418
5419 @quotation Note
5420 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5421 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5422 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5423 turn it off.
5424
5425 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5426 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5427 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
5428 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
5429 following execution engines are supported:
5430
5431 @table @code
5432 @item default
5433 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
5434 supported (see below).
5435
5436 @item performance
5437 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
5438 not supported (see below).
5439
5440 @item userns
5441 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
5442 supported.
5443
5444 @item proot
5445 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
5446 provides the necessary
5447 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5448 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5449 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5450 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5451
5452 @item fakechroot
5453 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
5454 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
5455 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
5456 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
5457 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
5458 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
5459 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
5460 @end table
5461
5462 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
5463 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
5464 execution engines listed above by setting the
5465 @code{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
5466 @end quotation
5467
5468 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
5469 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
5470 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
5471 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
5472 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
5473 pack.
5474
5475 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
5476 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
5477 do:
5478
5479 @example
5480 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
5481 @end example
5482
5483 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
5484 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
5485
5486 @example
5487 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
5488 docker run @var{image-id}
5489 @end example
5490
5491 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5492 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5493 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5494
5495 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5496 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
5497 @command{guix build}}).
5498
5499 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5500 @itemx -m @var{file}
5501 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
5502 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
5503 case the manifests are concatenated.
5504
5505 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5506 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
5507 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
5508 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
5509 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
5510 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
5511 but not both.
5512
5513 @item --system=@var{system}
5514 @itemx -s @var{system}
5515 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
5516 the system type of the build host.
5517
5518 @item --target=@var{triplet}
5519 @cindex cross-compilation
5520 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
5521 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
5522 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5523
5524 @item --compression=@var{tool}
5525 @itemx -C @var{tool}
5526 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
5527 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
5528 compression.
5529
5530 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
5531 @itemx -S @var{spec}
5532 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
5533 appear several times.
5534
5535 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
5536 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
5537 symlink target.
5538
5539 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
5540 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
5541
5542 @item --save-provenance
5543 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
5544 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
5545 (@pxref{Channels}).
5546
5547 Provenance information is saved in the
5548 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
5549 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
5550 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
5551 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
5552
5553 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
5554 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
5555 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
5556 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
5557 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
5558
5559 @item --root=@var{file}
5560 @itemx -r @var{file}
5561 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
5562 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
5563 collector root.
5564
5565 @item --localstatedir
5566 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
5567 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
5568 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
5569 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
5570 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
5571
5572 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
5573 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
5574 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
5575 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
5576 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
5577
5578 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
5579 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5580
5581 @item --derivation
5582 @itemx -d
5583 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
5584
5585 @item --bootstrap
5586 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
5587 useful to Guix developers.
5588 @end table
5589
5590 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
5591 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
5592 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5593
5594
5595 @node The GCC toolchain
5596 @section The GCC toolchain
5597
5598 @cindex GCC
5599 @cindex ld-wrapper
5600 @cindex linker wrapper
5601 @cindex toolchain, for C development
5602 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
5603
5604 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
5605 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
5606 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
5607 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
5608 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
5609
5610 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
5611 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
5612 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
5613 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
5614 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
5615
5616 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
5617 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
5618 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
5619
5620
5621 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
5622 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
5623
5624 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
5625 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
5626 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
5627 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
5628 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
5629 parent commit(s).
5630
5631 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
5632 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
5633 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
5634 with Guix.
5635
5636 The general syntax is:
5637
5638 @example
5639 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
5640 @end example
5641
5642 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
5643 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
5644 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
5645 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
5646 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
5647 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
5648 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
5649
5650 @table @code
5651 @item --repository=@var{directory}
5652 @itemx -r @var{directory}
5653 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
5654 directory.
5655
5656 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
5657 @itemx -k @var{reference}
5658 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
5659 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
5660 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
5661 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
5662 named @code{keyring}.
5663
5664 @item --stats
5665 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
5666
5667 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
5668 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
5669 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
5670 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
5671
5672 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
5673 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
5674 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
5675 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
5676 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
5677 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
5678 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
5679 @end table
5680
5681
5682 @c *********************************************************************
5683 @node Programming Interface
5684 @chapter Programming Interface
5685
5686 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5687 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5688 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5689 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5690 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5691 turned into concrete build actions.
5692
5693 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5694 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5695 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5696 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
5697 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5698
5699 @cindex derivation
5700 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5701 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5702 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5703 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5704 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5705 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5706 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5707
5708 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5709 package definitions.
5710
5711 @menu
5712 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5713 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5714 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5715 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5716 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5717 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5718 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5719 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
5720 @end menu
5721
5722 @node Package Modules
5723 @section Package Modules
5724
5725 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5726 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5727 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5728 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5729 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5730 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5731 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5732 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5733 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5734 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5735 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5736
5737 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5738 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5739 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5740 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5741 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5742 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5743
5744 @cindex customization, of packages
5745 @cindex package module search path
5746 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5747 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5748 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5749 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5750 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5751 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5752 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5753 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5754
5755 @enumerate
5756 @item
5757 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5758 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5759 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5760 environment variable described below.
5761
5762 @item
5763 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5764 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5765 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5766 channels.
5767 @end enumerate
5768
5769 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5770
5771 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5772 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5773 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5774 over the own modules of the distribution.
5775 @end defvr
5776
5777 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5778 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5779 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5780 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5781 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5782 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5783
5784 @node Defining Packages
5785 @section Defining Packages
5786
5787 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5788 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5789 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5790 package looks like this:
5791
5792 @lisp
5793 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5794 #:use-module (guix packages)
5795 #:use-module (guix download)
5796 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5797 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5798 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5799
5800 (define-public hello
5801 (package
5802 (name "hello")
5803 (version "2.10")
5804 (source (origin
5805 (method url-fetch)
5806 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5807 ".tar.gz"))
5808 (sha256
5809 (base32
5810 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5811 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5812 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5813 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5814 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5815 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5816 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5817 (license gpl3+)))
5818 @end lisp
5819
5820 @noindent
5821 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5822 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5823 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5824 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5825 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5826 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5827 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5828
5829 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5830 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5831 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5832
5833 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5834 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5835 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5836 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5837 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5838
5839 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5840
5841 @itemize
5842 @item
5843 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5844 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5845 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5846 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5847
5848 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5849 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5850
5851 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5852 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5853 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5854 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5855 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5856 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5857
5858 @cindex patches
5859 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5860 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5861 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5862
5863 @item
5864 @cindex GNU Build System
5865 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5866 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5867 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5868 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5869 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5870
5871 @item
5872 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5873 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5874 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5875 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5876
5877 @cindex quote
5878 @cindex quoting
5879 @findex '
5880 @findex quote
5881 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5882 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5883 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5884 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5885 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5886 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5887 Manual}).
5888
5889 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5890 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5891 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5892 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5893 Reference Manual}).
5894
5895 @item
5896 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5897 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5898 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5899 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5900
5901 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5902 @findex `
5903 @findex quasiquote
5904 @cindex comma (unquote)
5905 @findex ,
5906 @findex unquote
5907 @findex ,@@
5908 @findex unquote-splicing
5909 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5910 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5911 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5912 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5913 Reference Manual}).
5914
5915 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5916 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5917 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5918
5919 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5920 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5921 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5922 @end itemize
5923
5924 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5925
5926 Once a package definition is in place, the
5927 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5928 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5929 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5930 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5931 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5932 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5933 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5934 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5935 for style conformance.
5936 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5937 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5938 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5939 in a ``channel''.
5940
5941 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5942 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5943 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5944
5945 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5946 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5947 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5948 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5949 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5950
5951 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5952 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5953 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5954
5955 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5956 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5957 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5958 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5959 (@pxref{The Store}).
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @noindent
5963 @cindex cross-compilation
5964 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5965 package for some other system:
5966
5967 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5968 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5969 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5970 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5971
5972 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5973 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
5974 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5975 @end deffn
5976
5977 @cindex package transformations
5978 @cindex input rewriting
5979 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5980 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5981 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5982 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5983
5984 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5985 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5986 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5987 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5988 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5989 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5990 is the replacement.
5991
5992 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5993 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @noindent
5997 Consider this example:
5998
5999 @lisp
6000 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
6001 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
6002 ;; recursively.
6003 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
6004
6005 (define git-with-libressl
6006 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
6007 @end lisp
6008
6009 @noindent
6010 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
6011 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
6012 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
6013 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
6014 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
6015
6016 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
6017 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
6018
6019 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
6020 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
6021 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
6022 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
6023 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
6024 replacement for that package.
6025 @end deffn
6026
6027 The example above could be rewritten this way:
6028
6029 @lisp
6030 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
6031 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
6032 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
6033 @end lisp
6034
6035 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
6036 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
6037 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
6038
6039 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
6040 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
6041 graph.
6042
6043 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
6044 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
6045 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
6046 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
6047 @end deffn
6048
6049 @menu
6050 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6051 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6052 @end menu
6053
6054
6055 @node package Reference
6056 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6057
6058 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6059 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6060
6061 @deftp {Data Type} package
6062 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6063
6064 @table @asis
6065 @item @code{name}
6066 The name of the package, as a string.
6067
6068 @item @code{version}
6069 The version of the package, as a string.
6070
6071 @item @code{source}
6072 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6073 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6074 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6075 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6076 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6077 @code{local-file}}).
6078
6079 @item @code{build-system}
6080 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6081 Systems}).
6082
6083 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6084 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6085 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6086
6087 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6088 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6089 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6090 @cindex inputs, of packages
6091 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6092 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6093 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6094 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6095 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6096 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6097 inputs:
6098
6099 @lisp
6100 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6101 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6102 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6103 @end lisp
6104
6105 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6106 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6107 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6108 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6109 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6110 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6111
6112 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6113 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6114 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6115 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6116
6117 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6118 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6119 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
6120 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6121 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6122 propagated inputs).
6123
6124 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
6125 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
6126 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6127
6128 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6129 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6130 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6131 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
6132 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
6133 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6134
6135 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6136 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6137 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6138
6139 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6140 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6141 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6142 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6143
6144 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6145 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6146 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6147 for details.
6148
6149 @item @code{synopsis}
6150 A one-line description of the package.
6151
6152 @item @code{description}
6153 A more elaborate description of the package.
6154
6155 @item @code{license}
6156 @cindex license, of packages
6157 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6158 or a list of such values.
6159
6160 @item @code{home-page}
6161 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6162
6163 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6164 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6165 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6166
6167 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6168 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6169 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6170 automatically corrected.
6171 @end table
6172 @end deftp
6173
6174 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6175 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6176 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6177
6178 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6179 cross-compiling:
6180
6181 @lisp
6182 (package
6183 (name "guile")
6184 ;; ...
6185
6186 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6187 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6188 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6189 `(("self" ,this-package))
6190 '())))
6191 @end lisp
6192
6193 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6194 @end deffn
6195
6196 @node origin Reference
6197 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6198
6199 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
6200 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6201
6202 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6203 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6204
6205 @table @asis
6206 @item @code{uri}
6207 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6208 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6209 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6210 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6211
6212 @item @code{method}
6213 A procedure that handles the URI.
6214
6215 Examples include:
6216
6217 @table @asis
6218 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
6219 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
6220 @code{uri} field;
6221
6222 @vindex git-fetch
6223 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
6224 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
6225 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
6226 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
6227
6228 @lisp
6229 (git-reference
6230 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6231 (commit "v2.10"))
6232 @end lisp
6233 @end table
6234
6235 @item @code{sha256}
6236 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6237 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6238 @code{hash} field described below.
6239
6240 @item @code{hash}
6241 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6242 @code{content-hash}.
6243
6244 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6245 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6246 guix hash}).
6247
6248 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6249 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6250 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6251 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6252 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6253 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6254
6255 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6256 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6257 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6258
6259 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6260 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6261 @code{%current-target-system}.
6262
6263 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6264 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6265 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6266 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6267
6268 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6269 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6270 command.
6271
6272 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6273 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6274 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6275 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6276
6277 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6278 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6279 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6280
6281 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6282 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6283 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6284 @end table
6285 @end deftp
6286
6287 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6288 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6289 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6290 it is @code{sha256}.
6291
6292 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6293 or it can be a bytevector.
6294
6295 The following forms are all equivalent:
6296
6297 @lisp
6298 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6299 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6300 sha256)
6301 (content-hash (base32
6302 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6303 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6304 sha256)
6305 @end lisp
6306
6307 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6308 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6309 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6310 @end deftp
6311
6312 @node Build Systems
6313 @section Build Systems
6314
6315 @cindex build system
6316 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
6317 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
6318 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
6319 dependencies of that build procedure.
6320
6321 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
6322 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
6323 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
6324
6325 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
6326 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
6327 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
6328 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
6329 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
6330 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
6331 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
6332
6333 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
6334 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
6335 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
6336 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
6337 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
6338 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
6339 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
6340
6341 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
6342 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
6343 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
6344
6345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
6346 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
6347 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
6348 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
6349
6350 @cindex build phases
6351 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
6352 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
6353 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
6354 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
6355 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
6356 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
6357
6358 @table @code
6359 @item unpack
6360 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
6361 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
6362 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
6363
6364 @item patch-source-shebangs
6365 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
6366 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
6367 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
6368
6369 @item configure
6370 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
6371 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
6372 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
6373
6374 @item build
6375 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
6376 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
6377 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
6378
6379 @item check
6380 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
6381 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
6382 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
6383 check -j}.
6384
6385 @item install
6386 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
6387
6388 @item patch-shebangs
6389 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
6390
6391 @item strip
6392 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
6393 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
6394 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
6395 @end table
6396
6397 @vindex %standard-phases
6398 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
6399 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
6400 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
6401 procedure implements the actual phase.
6402
6403 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
6404 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
6405
6406 @example
6407 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
6408 @end example
6409
6410 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
6411 @code{configure} phase.
6412
6413 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
6414 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
6415 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
6416 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
6417 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
6418 have to mention them.
6419 @end defvr
6420
6421 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
6422 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
6423 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
6424 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
6425 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
6426
6427 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
6428 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
6429 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
6430 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
6431
6432 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
6433 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
6434 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
6435 parameters, respectively.
6436
6437 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
6438 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
6439 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
6440 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
6441 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
6442
6443 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
6444 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
6445 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
6446 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
6447 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
6448 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
6449 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
6450
6451 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
6452 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
6453 ``jar'' task will be run.
6454
6455 @end defvr
6456
6457 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
6458 @cindex Android distribution
6459 @cindex Android NDK build system
6460 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
6461 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
6462 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
6463
6464 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
6465 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
6466 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
6467
6468 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
6469 has no conflicting files.
6470
6471 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
6472 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
6473
6474 @end defvr
6475
6476 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
6477 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
6478 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
6479
6480 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
6481 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
6482 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
6483 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
6484
6485 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
6486 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
6487 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
6488 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
6489 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
6490 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
6491
6492 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
6493 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
6494 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
6495
6496 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
6497 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
6498 the @code{cl-} prefix.
6499
6500 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
6501 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
6502 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
6503 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
6504
6505 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
6506 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
6507 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
6508 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
6509 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
6510 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
6511
6512 If the system is not defined within its own @file{.asd} file of the same
6513 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
6514 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
6515 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
6516 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
6517 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
6518 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
6519 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
6520
6521 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
6522 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
6523 be used to specify the name of the system.
6524
6525 @end defvr
6526
6527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
6528 @cindex Rust programming language
6529 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
6530 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
6531 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
6532 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
6533
6534 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
6535 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
6536
6537 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
6538 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
6539 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
6540 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
6541 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
6542 should be added to the package definition via the
6543 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
6544
6545 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
6546 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
6547 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
6548 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
6549 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs any crate the binaries
6550 if they are defined by the crate.
6551 @end defvr
6552
6553
6554 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
6555 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
6556 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
6557 mostly just moving files around.
6558
6559 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
6560 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
6561 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
6562 @code{trivial-build-system}.
6563
6564 To further simplify the file installation process, an
6565 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
6566 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
6567 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
6568
6569 @itemize
6570 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
6571 @itemize
6572 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
6573 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
6574 @end itemize
6575
6576 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
6577 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
6578 as above.
6579 @itemize
6580 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
6581 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
6582 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
6583 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
6584 @itemize
6585 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
6586 at least one of the elements in the given list.
6587 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
6588 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
6589 list.
6590 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
6591 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
6592 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
6593 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
6594 on top of the inclusions.
6595 @end itemize
6596 @end itemize
6597 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
6598 @var{target}.
6599 @end itemize
6600
6601 Examples:
6602
6603 @itemize
6604 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
6605 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
6606 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
6607 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
6608 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
6609 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
6610 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
6611 @file{share/my-app/file}.
6612 @end itemize
6613 @end defvr
6614
6615
6616 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
6617 @cindex simple Clojure build system
6618 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
6619 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
6620 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
6621 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
6622 yet.
6623
6624 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
6625 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
6626 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
6627
6628 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
6629 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
6630 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
6631 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
6632 Other parameters are documented below.
6633
6634 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
6635 following phases changed:
6636
6637 @table @code
6638
6639 @item build
6640 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
6641 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
6642 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
6643 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
6644 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
6645 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
6646 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
6647 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
6648
6649 @item check
6650 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
6651 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
6652 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
6653 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
6654 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
6655 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
6656
6657 @item install
6658 This phase installs all jars built previously.
6659 @end table
6660
6661 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
6662
6663 @table @code
6664
6665 @item install-doc
6666 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
6667 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
6668 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
6669 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
6670 @end table
6671 @end defvr
6672
6673 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
6674 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
6675 implements the build procedure for packages using the
6676 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
6677
6678 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
6679 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
6680 parameter.
6681
6682 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
6683 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
6684 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
6685 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
6686 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
6687 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
6688 @end defvr
6689
6690 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
6691 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
6692 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
6693 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
6694 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
6695 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
6696 system.
6697
6698 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
6699 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
6700 parameter.
6701
6702 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
6703 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
6704 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
6705
6706 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
6707 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
6708 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
6709
6710 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
6711 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
6712 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
6713 @code{dune}.
6714 @end defvr
6715
6716 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
6717 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
6718 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
6719 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
6720 Go build mechanisms}.
6721
6722 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
6723 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
6724 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
6725 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
6726 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
6727 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
6728 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
6729 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
6730 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
6731 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
6732
6733 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
6734 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
6735 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
6736 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
6737 @end defvr
6738
6739 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
6740 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
6741 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
6742
6743 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6744 @code{gnu-build-system}:
6745
6746 @table @code
6747 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6748 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
6749 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
6750 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
6751 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
6752 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
6753 environment variables.
6754
6755 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
6756 process by listing their names in the
6757 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
6758 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
6759 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
6760 GLib and GTK+.
6761
6762 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6763 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
6764 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
6765 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
6766 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
6767 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
6768 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
6769 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
6770 @end table
6771
6772 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
6773 @end defvr
6774
6775 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6776 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6777 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6778 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6779 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6780 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6781 installs documentation.
6782
6783 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
6784 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
6785
6786 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6787 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6788 @end defvr
6789
6790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
6791 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
6792 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
6793 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
6794 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
6795 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
6796 Tests are run not run.
6797
6798 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
6799 package, correctly capitalized.
6800
6801 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
6802 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
6803 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
6804 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
6805
6806 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
6807 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
6808 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
6809 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
6810 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
6811 and their uuid.
6812 @end defvr
6813
6814 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6815 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6816 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6817
6818 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6819 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6820 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6821 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6822 output.
6823
6824 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6825 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6826 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6827 @end defvr
6828
6829 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6830 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6831 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6832 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6833 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6834 try some of them.
6835
6836 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6837 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6838 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6839 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6840 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6841 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6842 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6843 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6844 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6845
6846 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6847 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6848 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6849 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6850
6851 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6852 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6853 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6854
6855 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6856 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6857 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6858 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6859 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6860 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6861 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6862
6863 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6864 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6865 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6866 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6867 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6868 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6869 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6870 @end defvr
6871
6872 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6873 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6874 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6875 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6876 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6877
6878 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6879 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
6880 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6881
6882 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6883 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6884 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6885 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6886 interpreter version.
6887
6888 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6889 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6890 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6891 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
6892 @end defvr
6893
6894 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6895 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6896 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6897 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6898 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6899 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6900 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6901 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6902 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6903 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6904 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6905 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6906
6907 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6908 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6909 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6910
6911 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6912 @end defvr
6913
6914 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
6915 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
6916 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
6917
6918 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6919 @code{cmake-build-system}:
6920
6921 @table @code
6922 @item check-setup
6923 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
6924 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
6925 For now this only sets some environment variables:
6926 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
6927 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
6928 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
6929
6930 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
6931 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
6932
6933 @item qt-wrap
6934 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
6935 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
6936 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
6937 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
6938 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
6939
6940 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
6941 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
6942 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
6943 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
6944 or such.
6945
6946 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
6947 @end table
6948 @end defvr
6949
6950 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6951 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6952 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6953 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
6954 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6955 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
6956 run after installation using the R function
6957 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6958 @end defvr
6959
6960 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6961 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6962 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6963 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6964 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6965 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6966 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6967 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6968
6969 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6970 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6971 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6972 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6973 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6974 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6975 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6976 @end defvr
6977
6978 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6979 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6980 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6981 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6982 files in the inputs.
6983
6984 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6985 different engine and format can be specified with the
6986 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6987 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6988 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6989 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6990 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6991 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6992
6993 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6994 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6995 @end defvr
6996
6997 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6998 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6999 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
7000 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
7001
7002 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
7003 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
7004 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
7005 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
7006 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
7007 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
7008 a traditional source release tarball.
7009
7010 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
7011 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
7012 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
7013 @end defvr
7014
7015 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
7016 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
7017 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
7018 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
7019 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
7020 script.
7021
7022 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
7023 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
7024 @code{#:python} parameter.
7025 @end defvr
7026
7027 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
7028 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
7029 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
7030 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
7031 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
7032 the package.
7033
7034 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
7035 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
7036 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
7037 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
7038 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
7039 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
7040 @end defvr
7041
7042 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
7043 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
7044 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
7045 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
7046 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
7047 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
7048 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
7049 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
7050 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
7051 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
7052 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
7053 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
7054 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
7055 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
7056
7057 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
7058 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
7059 @end defvr
7060
7061 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
7062 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
7063 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
7064 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
7065 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
7066
7067 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
7068 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
7069 @end defvr
7070
7071 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
7072 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
7073 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
7074 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
7075
7076 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
7077 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
7078 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
7079 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
7080 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
7081 @end defvr
7082
7083 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
7084 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
7085 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
7086 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
7087 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
7088 locations in the output directory.
7089 @end defvr
7090
7091 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
7092 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
7093 implements the build procedure for packages that use
7094 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
7095
7096 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
7097 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
7098 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
7099 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
7100 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
7101
7102 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
7103 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
7104
7105 @table @code
7106
7107 @item configure
7108 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
7109 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
7110 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
7111 @code{#:build-type}.
7112
7113 @item build
7114 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
7115 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
7116
7117 @item check
7118 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
7119 which is @code{"test"} by default.
7120
7121 @item install
7122 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
7123 @end table
7124
7125 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
7126
7127 @table @code
7128
7129 @item fix-runpath
7130 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
7131 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
7132 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
7133 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
7134 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
7135 required for the program to run.
7136
7137 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7138 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
7139 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
7140
7141 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7142 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
7143 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
7144 @end table
7145 @end defvr
7146
7147 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
7148 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
7149
7150 @cindex build phases
7151 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
7152 following phases changed:
7153
7154 @table @code
7155
7156 @item configure
7157 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
7158 can be used to build the external kernel module.
7159
7160 @item build
7161 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
7162 kernel module.
7163
7164 @item install
7165 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
7166 kernel module.
7167 @end table
7168
7169 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
7170 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
7171 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
7172 @end defvr
7173
7174 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
7175 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
7176 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
7177 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
7178 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
7179
7180 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
7181 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
7182 @code{node}.
7183 @end defvr
7184
7185 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
7186 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
7187 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
7188 and does not have a notion of build phases.
7189
7190 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
7191 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
7192
7193 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
7194 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
7195 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
7196 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
7197 @end defvr
7198
7199 @node The Store
7200 @section The Store
7201
7202 @cindex store
7203 @cindex store items
7204 @cindex store paths
7205
7206 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
7207 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
7208 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
7209 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
7210 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
7211 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
7212 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
7213 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
7214 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
7215
7216 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
7217 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
7218 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
7219 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
7220
7221 @quotation Note
7222 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
7223 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
7224 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
7225
7226 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
7227 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
7228 accidental modifications.
7229 @end quotation
7230
7231 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
7232 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
7233 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
7234 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
7235 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
7236
7237 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
7238 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
7239 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
7240 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
7241 supported URI schemes are:
7242
7243 @table @code
7244 @item file
7245 @itemx unix
7246 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
7247 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
7248 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
7249
7250 @item guix
7251 @cindex daemon, remote access
7252 @cindex remote access to the daemon
7253 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
7254 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
7255 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
7256 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
7257 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
7258
7259 @example
7260 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
7261 @end example
7262
7263 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
7264 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
7265 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
7266
7267 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
7268 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
7269 @option{--listen}}).
7270
7271 @item ssh
7272 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
7273 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH. This
7274 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
7275 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
7276 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
7277 like this:
7278
7279 @example
7280 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
7281 @end example
7282
7283 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
7284 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
7285 @end table
7286
7287 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
7288
7289 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
7290 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
7291 @quotation Note
7292 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
7293 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
7294 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
7295 @end quotation
7296 @end defvr
7297
7298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
7299 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
7300 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
7301 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
7302 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
7303
7304 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
7305 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
7306 @end deffn
7307
7308 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
7309 Close the connection to @var{server}.
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
7313 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
7314 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
7315 @end defvr
7316
7317 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
7318 argument.
7319
7320 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
7321 @cindex invalid store items
7322 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
7323 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
7324 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
7325 build).
7326
7327 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
7328 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7332 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
7333 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
7334 resulting store path.
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
7338 [@var{mode}]
7339 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
7340 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
7341 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
7342 @end deffn
7343
7344 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
7345 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
7346 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
7347 Store Monad}).
7348
7349 @c FIXME
7350 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
7351
7352 @node Derivations
7353 @section Derivations
7354
7355 @cindex derivations
7356 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
7357 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
7358 following pieces of information:
7359
7360 @itemize
7361 @item
7362 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
7363 directory in the store, but may produce more.
7364
7365 @item
7366 @cindex build-time dependencies
7367 @cindex dependencies, build-time
7368 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
7369 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
7370 etc.).
7371
7372 @item
7373 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
7374
7375 @item
7376 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
7377 to be passed.
7378
7379 @item
7380 A list of environment variables to be defined.
7381
7382 @end itemize
7383
7384 @cindex derivation path
7385 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
7386 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
7387 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
7388 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
7389 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
7390 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
7391 Store}).
7392
7393 @cindex fixed-output derivations
7394 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
7395 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
7396 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
7397 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
7398 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
7399 method and tools being used.
7400
7401 @cindex references
7402 @cindex run-time dependencies
7403 @cindex dependencies, run-time
7404 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
7405 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
7406 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
7407 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
7408 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
7409 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
7410
7411 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
7412 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
7413 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
7414 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
7415
7416 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
7417 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7418 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
7419 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
7420 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7421 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
7422 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
7423 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
7424 @code{<derivation>} object.
7425
7426 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
7427 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
7428 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
7429 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
7430 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
7431 containing this output.
7432
7433 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
7434 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
7435 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
7436 a simple text format.
7437
7438 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
7439 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
7440 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
7441 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
7442
7443 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
7444 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
7445 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
7446 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
7447 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
7448 derivations that download files.
7449
7450 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
7451 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
7452 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
7453 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
7454
7455 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
7456 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
7457 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
7458 host CPU instruction set.
7459
7460 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
7461 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @noindent
7465 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
7466 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
7467 to a Bash executable in the store:
7468
7469 @lisp
7470 (use-modules (guix utils)
7471 (guix store)
7472 (guix derivations))
7473
7474 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
7475 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
7476 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
7477 (derivation store "foo"
7478 bash `("-e" ,builder)
7479 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
7480 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
7481 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
7482 @end lisp
7483
7484 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
7485 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
7486 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
7487 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
7488 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
7489
7490 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
7491 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
7492 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
7493 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
7494
7495 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
7496 @var{name} @var{exp} @
7497 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
7498 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7499 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7500 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7501 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7502 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7503 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
7504 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
7505 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
7506 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
7507 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
7508 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
7509 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
7510 gnu-build-system))}.
7511
7512 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
7513 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
7514 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
7515 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
7516 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
7517 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
7518 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
7519
7520 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
7521 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
7522 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
7523
7524 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
7525 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
7526 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
7527 @var{substitutable?}.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @noindent
7531 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
7532 containing one file:
7533
7534 @lisp
7535 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
7536 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
7537 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
7538 (lambda (p)
7539 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
7540 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
7541
7542 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
7543 @end lisp
7544
7545
7546 @node The Store Monad
7547 @section The Store Monad
7548
7549 @cindex monad
7550
7551 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
7552 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
7553 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
7554 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
7555
7556 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
7557 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
7558 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
7559 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
7560 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
7561
7562 @cindex monadic values
7563 @cindex monadic functions
7564 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
7565 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
7566 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
7567 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
7568 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
7569 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
7570 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
7571 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
7572 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
7573
7574 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
7575
7576 @lisp
7577 (define (sh-symlink store)
7578 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
7579 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
7580 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
7581 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
7582 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
7583 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
7584 @end lisp
7585
7586 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
7587 as a monadic function:
7588
7589 @lisp
7590 (define (sh-symlink)
7591 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
7592 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
7593 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7594 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
7595 #$output))))
7596 @end lisp
7597
7598 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
7599 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
7600 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
7601 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
7602 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
7603
7604 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
7605 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
7606 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
7607
7608 @lisp
7609 (define (sh-symlink)
7610 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7611 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
7612 #$output)))
7613 @end lisp
7614
7615 @c See
7616 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
7617 @c for the funny quote.
7618 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
7619 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
7620 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
7621 @code{run-with-store}:
7622
7623 @lisp
7624 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
7625 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
7626 @end lisp
7627
7628 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
7629 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
7630 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
7631 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
7632
7633 @example
7634 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
7635 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7636 @end example
7637
7638 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
7639 automatically run through the store:
7640
7641 @example
7642 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
7643 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
7644 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7645 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
7646 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
7647 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
7648 scheme@@(guile-user)>
7649 @end example
7650
7651 @noindent
7652 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
7653 @code{store-monad} REPL.
7654
7655 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
7656 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
7657
7658 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
7659 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
7660 in @var{monad}.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
7664 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
7665 @end deffn
7666
7667 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
7668 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
7669 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
7670 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
7671 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
7672 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
7673 in this example:
7674
7675 @lisp
7676 (run-with-state
7677 (with-monad %state-monad
7678 (>>= (return 1)
7679 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
7680 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
7681 'some-state)
7682
7683 @result{} 4
7684 @result{} some-state
7685 @end lisp
7686 @end deffn
7687
7688 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7689 @var{body} ...
7690 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7691 @var{body} ...
7692 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
7693 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
7694 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
7695 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
7696 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
7697 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
7698 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
7699 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
7700 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
7701 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
7702
7703 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
7704 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
7708 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
7709 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
7710 sequence must be a monadic expression.
7711
7712 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
7713 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
7714 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7718 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7719 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7720 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7721 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7722 @end deffn
7723
7724 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7725 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7726 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7727 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7728 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7729 @end deffn
7730
7731 @cindex state monad
7732 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
7733 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
7734 monadic procedure calls.
7735
7736 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
7737 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
7738 the state that is threaded.
7739
7740 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
7741 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
7742 increments the current state value:
7743
7744 @lisp
7745 (define (square x)
7746 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
7747 (mbegin %state-monad
7748 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
7749 (return (* x x)))))
7750
7751 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
7752 @result{} (0 1 4)
7753 @result{} 3
7754 @end lisp
7755
7756 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
7757 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
7758 @end defvr
7759
7760 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
7761 Return the current state as a monadic value.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
7765 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
7766 monadic value.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
7770 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
7771 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
7772 @end deffn
7773
7774 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
7775 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
7776 The state is assumed to be a list.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
7780 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
7781 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
7782 @end deffn
7783
7784 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
7785 store)} module, is as follows.
7786
7787 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
7788 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
7789
7790 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
7791 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
7792 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
7793 @end defvr
7794
7795 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
7796 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
7797 open store connection.
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7801 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7802 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
7803 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7804 @end deffn
7805
7806 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
7807 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7808 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
7809 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7813 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
7814 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
7815 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
7816 @var{name} is omitted.
7817
7818 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
7819 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
7820 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
7821
7822 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7823 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7824 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7825 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7826
7827 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
7828
7829 @lisp
7830 (run-with-store (open-connection)
7831 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
7832 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
7833 (return (list a b))))
7834
7835 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
7836 @end lisp
7837
7838 @end deffn
7839
7840 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
7841 monadic procedures:
7842
7843 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
7844 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
7845 [#:output "out"]
7846 Return as a monadic
7847 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
7848 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
7849 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
7850 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7851
7852 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
7853 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
7854 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
7855 @end deffn
7856
7857 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7858 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7859 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7860 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7861 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864
7865 @node G-Expressions
7866 @section G-Expressions
7867
7868 @cindex G-expression
7869 @cindex build code quoting
7870 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7871 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7872 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7873 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7874 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7875
7876 @cindex strata of code
7877 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7878 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7879 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7880 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7881 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7882 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7883 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7884 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7885 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7886 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7887 @command{make}, etc.
7888
7889 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7890 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7891 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7892 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7893 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7894 expressions.
7895
7896 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7897 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7898 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7899 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7900 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7901 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7902 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7903 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7904
7905 @itemize
7906 @item
7907 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7908 processes.
7909
7910 @item
7911 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7912 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7913 introduced.
7914
7915 @item
7916 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7917 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7918 processes that use them.
7919 @end itemize
7920
7921 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7922 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7923 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7924 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7925 such that these objects can also be inserted
7926 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7927 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7928 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7929 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7930 below).
7931
7932 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7933
7934 @lisp
7935 (define build-exp
7936 #~(begin
7937 (mkdir #$output)
7938 (chdir #$output)
7939 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7940 "list-files")))
7941 @end lisp
7942
7943 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7944 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7945 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7946
7947 @lisp
7948 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7949 @end lisp
7950
7951 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7952 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7953 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7954 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7955 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7956 output of the derivation.
7957
7958 @cindex cross compilation
7959 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7960 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7961 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7962 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7963 native package build:
7964
7965 @lisp
7966 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7967 #~(begin
7968 (mkdir #$output)
7969 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
7970 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7971 "-s"
7972 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7973 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7974 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
7975 @end lisp
7976
7977 @noindent
7978 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7979 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7980 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7981
7982 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7983 @findex with-imported-modules
7984 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7985 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7986 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7987 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7988
7989 @lisp
7990 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7991 #~(begin
7992 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7993 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7994 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7995 #~(begin
7996 #$build
7997 (display "success!\n")
7998 #t)))
7999 @end lisp
8000
8001 @noindent
8002 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
8003 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
8004 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
8005
8006 @cindex module closure
8007 @findex source-module-closure
8008 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
8009 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
8010 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
8011 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
8012 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
8013 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
8014
8015 @lisp
8016 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
8017
8018 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
8019 '((guix build utils)
8020 (gnu build vm)))
8021 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
8022 #~(begin
8023 (use-modules (guix build utils)
8024 (gnu build vm))
8025 @dots{})))
8026 @end lisp
8027
8028 @cindex extensions, for gexps
8029 @findex with-extensions
8030 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
8031 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
8032 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
8033 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
8034
8035 @lisp
8036 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
8037
8038 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
8039 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
8040 #~(begin
8041 (use-modules (json))
8042 @dots{})))
8043 @end lisp
8044
8045 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
8046
8047 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
8048 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
8049 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
8050 or more of the following forms:
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @item #$@var{obj}
8054 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
8055 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
8056 supported types, for example a package or a
8057 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
8058 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
8059
8060 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
8061 objects are substituted similarly.
8062
8063 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
8064 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
8065
8066 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
8067
8068 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
8069 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
8070 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
8071 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
8072 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
8073
8074 @item #+@var{obj}
8075 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
8076 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
8077 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
8078 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
8079 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
8080
8081 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
8082 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
8083 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
8084 output when @var{output} is omitted.
8085
8086 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
8087
8088 @item #$@@@var{lst}
8089 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
8090 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
8091 containing list.
8092
8093 @item #+@@@var{lst}
8094 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
8095 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
8096 @var{lst}.
8097
8098 @end table
8099
8100 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
8101 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
8105 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
8106 in their execution environment.
8107
8108 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
8109 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
8110 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
8111
8112 @lisp
8113 `((guix build utils)
8114 (guix gcrypt)
8115 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
8116 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
8117 @end lisp
8118
8119 @noindent
8120 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
8121 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
8122
8123 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
8124 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
8125 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
8126 @end deffn
8127
8128 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
8129 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
8130 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
8131 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
8132 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
8133
8134 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
8135 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
8136 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
8137 @var{body}@dots{}.
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
8141 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
8142 @end deffn
8143
8144 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
8145 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
8146 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
8147 information about monads).
8148
8149 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
8150 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
8151 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8152 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8153 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
8154 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
8155 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8156 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8157 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
8158 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
8159 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
8160 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
8161 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8162 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
8163 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
8164 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
8165 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
8166 to by @var{exp}.
8167
8168 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
8169 Its meaning is to
8170 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
8171 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
8172 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
8173 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
8174 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
8175
8176 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
8177 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
8178
8179 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
8180 applicable.
8181
8182 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
8183 following forms:
8184
8185 @example
8186 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
8187 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
8188 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
8189 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
8190 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
8191 @end example
8192
8193 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
8194 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
8195 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
8196 text format.
8197
8198 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
8199 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
8200 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
8201 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
8202 referenced by the outputs.
8203
8204 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
8205 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
8206
8207 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @cindex file-like objects
8211 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
8212 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
8213 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
8214 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
8215
8216 @lisp
8217 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
8218 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
8219 @end lisp
8220
8221 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
8222 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
8223 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
8224 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
8225 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
8226 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
8227 content is directly passed as a string.
8228
8229 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
8230 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
8231 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
8232 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
8233 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
8234 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
8235 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
8236 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
8237 base name of @var{file}.
8238
8239 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
8240 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
8241 permission bits are kept.
8242
8243 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
8244 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
8245 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
8246 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
8247
8248 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
8249 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
8250 @end deffn
8251
8252 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
8253 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
8254 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
8255
8256 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
8257 @end deffn
8258
8259 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
8260 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
8261 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
8262 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
8263 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
8264
8265 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
8269 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
8270 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
8271 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
8272 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
8273 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
8274
8275 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
8276 command:
8277
8278 @lisp
8279 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
8280
8281 (gexp->script "list-files"
8282 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
8283 "ls"))
8284 @end lisp
8285
8286 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
8287 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
8288 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
8289
8290 @example
8291 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
8292 !#
8293 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
8294 @end example
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
8298 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
8299 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
8300 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
8301 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
8302
8303 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
8304 @end deffn
8305
8306 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
8307 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
8308 [#:splice? #f] @
8309 [#:guile (default-guile)]
8310 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
8311 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
8312 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
8313
8314 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
8315 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
8316 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
8317 @var{module-path}.
8318
8319 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
8320 or a subset thereof.
8321 @end deffn
8322
8323 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
8324 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
8325 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
8326 @var{exp}.
8327
8328 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
8329 @end deffn
8330
8331 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
8332 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
8333 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
8334 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
8335 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
8336 references to all these.
8337
8338 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
8339 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
8340 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
8341 like this:
8342
8343 @lisp
8344 (define (profile.sh)
8345 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
8346 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
8347 (text-file* "profile.sh"
8348 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
8349 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
8350 @end lisp
8351
8352 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
8353 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
8354 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
8358 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
8359 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
8360 as in:
8361
8362 @lisp
8363 (mixed-text-file "profile"
8364 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
8365 @end lisp
8366
8367 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
8371 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
8372 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
8373 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
8374 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
8375
8376 @lisp
8377 (file-union "etc"
8378 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
8379 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
8380 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
8381 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
8382 @end lisp
8383
8384 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
8385 @end deffn
8386
8387 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
8388 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
8389 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
8390
8391 @lisp
8392 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
8393 @end lisp
8394
8395 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
8396 @end deffn
8397
8398 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
8399 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
8400 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
8401 @var{suffix} is a string.
8402
8403 As an example, consider this gexp:
8404
8405 @lisp
8406 (gexp->script "run-uname"
8407 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
8408 "/bin/uname")))
8409 @end lisp
8410
8411 The same effect could be achieved with:
8412
8413 @lisp
8414 (gexp->script "run-uname"
8415 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
8416 "/bin/uname")))
8417 @end lisp
8418
8419 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
8420 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
8421 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
8422 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
8426 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
8427 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
8428 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
8429
8430 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
8431 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
8432 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
8433 cross-compiling.
8434
8435 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
8436 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
8437
8438 @example
8439 #~(system*
8440 #+(let-system system
8441 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
8442 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
8443 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
8444 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
8445 (else
8446 (error "dunno!"))))
8447 "-net" "user" #$image)
8448 @end example
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
8452 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
8453 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
8454 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
8455 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
8456 derivation or store item.
8457
8458 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
8459 for a given object:
8460
8461 @lisp
8462 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
8463 coreutils)
8464 @end lisp
8465
8466 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
8467 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470
8471 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
8472 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
8473 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
8474 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
8475
8476 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
8477 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
8478 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
8479 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
8480 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
8481
8482 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
8483 [#:target #f]
8484 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
8485 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
8486 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
8487 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 @node Invoking guix repl
8491 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
8492
8493 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
8494 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
8495 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
8496 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
8497 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
8498 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
8499 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8500 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
8501 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
8502 dependencies are available in the search path.
8503
8504 The general syntax is:
8505
8506 @example
8507 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
8508 @end example
8509
8510 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
8511 executed as a Guile scripts:
8512
8513 @example
8514 guix repl my-script.scm
8515 @end example
8516
8517 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
8518 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
8519
8520 @example
8521 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
8522 @end example
8523
8524 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
8525 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
8526 lines at the top of the script:
8527
8528 @example
8529 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
8530 @code{!#}
8531 @end example
8532
8533 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
8534
8535 @example
8536 $ guix repl
8537 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
8538 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
8539 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
8540 @end example
8541
8542 @cindex inferiors
8543 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
8544 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
8545 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
8546 of Guix.
8547
8548 The available options are as follows:
8549
8550 @table @code
8551 @item --type=@var{type}
8552 @itemx -t @var{type}
8553 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
8554
8555 @table @code
8556 @item guile
8557 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
8558 @item machine
8559 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
8560 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
8561 @end table
8562
8563 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
8564 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
8565 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
8566 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
8567
8568 @table @code
8569 @item --listen=tcp:37146
8570 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
8571
8572 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
8573 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
8574 @end table
8575
8576 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8577 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8578 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8579 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8580
8581 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8582 the script or REPL.
8583
8584 @item -q
8585 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
8586 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
8587 @end table
8588
8589 @c *********************************************************************
8590 @node Utilities
8591 @chapter Utilities
8592
8593 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
8594 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
8595 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
8596 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
8597
8598 @menu
8599 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
8600 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
8601 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
8602 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
8603 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
8604 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
8605 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
8606 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
8607 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
8608 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
8609 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
8610 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
8611 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
8612 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
8613 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
8614 @end menu
8615
8616 @node Invoking guix build
8617 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
8618
8619 @cindex package building
8620 @cindex @command{guix build}
8621 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
8622 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
8623 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
8624 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
8625 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
8626
8627 The general syntax is:
8628
8629 @example
8630 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
8631 @end example
8632
8633 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
8634 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
8635 resulting directories:
8636
8637 @example
8638 guix build emacs guile
8639 @end example
8640
8641 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
8642
8643 @example
8644 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
8645 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
8646 @end example
8647
8648 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
8649 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
8650 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
8651 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
8652 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
8653 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8654
8655 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
8656 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
8657 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
8658 needed.
8659
8660 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
8661 described in the subsections below.
8662
8663 @menu
8664 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
8665 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
8666 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
8667 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
8668 @end menu
8669
8670 @node Common Build Options
8671 @subsection Common Build Options
8672
8673 A number of options that control the build process are common to
8674 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
8675 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
8676 following:
8677
8678 @table @code
8679
8680 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8681 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8682 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8683 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8684
8685 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8686 the command-line tools.
8687
8688 @item --keep-failed
8689 @itemx -K
8690 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
8691 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
8692 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
8693 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
8694 build issues.
8695
8696 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
8697 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
8698 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
8699
8700 @item --keep-going
8701 @itemx -k
8702 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
8703 all the builds have either completed or failed.
8704
8705 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
8706 derivations has failed.
8707
8708 @item --dry-run
8709 @itemx -n
8710 Do not build the derivations.
8711
8712 @anchor{fallback-option}
8713 @item --fallback
8714 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
8715 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
8716
8717 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
8718 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
8719 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
8720 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
8721 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
8722
8723 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
8724 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
8725 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8726
8727 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
8728 disabled.
8729
8730 @item --no-substitutes
8731 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
8732 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
8733 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8734
8735 @item --no-grafts
8736 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
8737 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8738 information on grafts.
8739
8740 @item --rounds=@var{n}
8741 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
8742 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
8743
8744 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
8745 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
8746 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
8747 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
8748
8749 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
8750 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
8751 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
8752 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
8753 the two results.
8754
8755 @item --no-offload
8756 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
8757 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
8758 builds to remote machines.
8759
8760 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
8761 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
8762 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8763
8764 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8765 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
8766
8767 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
8768 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
8769 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8770
8771 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8772 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
8773
8774 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
8775 @c most programs honor it.
8776 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
8777 @cindex build logs, verbosity
8778 @item -v @var{level}
8779 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
8780 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
8781 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
8782 output on standard error.
8783
8784 @item --cores=@var{n}
8785 @itemx -c @var{n}
8786 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
8787 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
8788
8789 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
8790 @itemx -M @var{n}
8791 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
8792 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
8793 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
8794
8795 @item --debug=@var{level}
8796 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
8797 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
8798 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
8799
8800 @end table
8801
8802 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
8803 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
8804 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
8805 derivations)} module.
8806
8807 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
8808 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
8809 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
8810
8811 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
8812 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
8813 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
8814 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
8815 below:
8816
8817 @example
8818 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
8819 @end example
8820
8821 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
8822 the parsed command-line options.
8823 @end defvr
8824
8825
8826 @node Package Transformation Options
8827 @subsection Package Transformation Options
8828
8829 @cindex package variants
8830 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
8831 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
8832 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
8833 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
8834 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
8835 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
8836 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8837
8838 @table @code
8839
8840 @item --with-source=@var{source}
8841 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
8842 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
8843 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
8844 its version number.
8845 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
8846 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
8847
8848 When @var{package} is omitted,
8849 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
8850 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
8851 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
8852 package is @code{guile}.
8853
8854 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
8855 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
8856
8857 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
8858 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
8859 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
8860 the @code{ed} package:
8861
8862 @example
8863 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
8864 @end example
8865
8866 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
8867 candidates:
8868
8869 @example
8870 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
8871 @end example
8872
8873 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
8874
8875 @example
8876 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
8877 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
8878 @end example
8879
8880 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8881 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
8882 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
8883 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
8884 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
8885
8886 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
8887 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
8888 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
8889
8890 @example
8891 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
8892 @end example
8893
8894 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
8895 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
8896 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
8897
8898 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
8899 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
8900
8901 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8902 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
8903 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
8904 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
8905 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8906 information on grafts.
8907
8908 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
8909 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
8910 they currently refer to:
8911
8912 @example
8913 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
8914 @end example
8915
8916 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
8917 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
8918 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
8919 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
8920 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
8921 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
8922 care!
8923
8924 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
8925 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
8926 @cindex latest commit, building
8927 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
8928 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
8929 recursively.
8930
8931 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
8932 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
8933
8934 @example
8935 guix build python-numpy \
8936 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
8937 @end example
8938
8939 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
8940 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
8941
8942 @cindex continuous integration
8943 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
8944 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
8945 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
8946 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
8947 integration (CI).
8948
8949 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
8950 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
8951 in a while to save disk space.
8952
8953 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8954 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8955 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8956 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8957 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8958 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8959
8960 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8961 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8962 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8963 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8964
8965 @example
8966 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8967 @end example
8968
8969 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8970 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8971 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8972 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
8973 @end table
8974
8975 @node Additional Build Options
8976 @subsection Additional Build Options
8977
8978 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8979 build}.
8980
8981 @table @code
8982
8983 @item --quiet
8984 @itemx -q
8985 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8986 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8987 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8988
8989 @item --file=@var{file}
8990 @itemx -f @var{file}
8991 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8992 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8993
8994 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8995 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8996
8997 @lisp
8998 @include package-hello.scm
8999 @end lisp
9000
9001 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
9002 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
9003 with the following contents would result in building the packages
9004 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
9005
9006 @example
9007 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
9008 @end example
9009
9010 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
9011 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
9012 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
9013 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
9014
9015 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9016 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9017 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
9018
9019 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
9020 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
9021 version 1.8 of Guile.
9022
9023 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
9024 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
9025 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9026
9027 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
9028 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
9029 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
9030
9031 @item --source
9032 @itemx -S
9033 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
9034 themselves.
9035
9036 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
9037 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
9038 source tarball.
9039
9040 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
9041 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
9042 Packages}).
9043
9044 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
9045 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
9046 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
9047 the packages.
9048
9049 @item --sources
9050 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
9051 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
9052 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
9053 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
9054 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
9055 optional argument values:
9056
9057 @table @code
9058 @item package
9059 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
9060 as the @option{--source} option.
9061
9062 @item all
9063 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
9064 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
9065
9066 @example
9067 $ guix build --sources tzdata
9068 The following derivations will be built:
9069 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
9070 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
9071 @end example
9072
9073 @item transitive
9074 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
9075 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
9076 prefetch package source for later offline building.
9077
9078 @example
9079 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
9080 The following derivations will be built:
9081 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
9082 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
9083 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
9084 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
9085 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
9086 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
9087 @dots{}
9088 @end example
9089
9090 @end table
9091
9092 @item --system=@var{system}
9093 @itemx -s @var{system}
9094 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
9095 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
9096 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
9097 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
9098
9099 @quotation Note
9100 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
9101 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
9102 information on cross-compilation.
9103 @end quotation
9104
9105 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
9106 different personalities. For instance, passing
9107 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
9108 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
9109 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
9110
9111 @quotation Note
9112 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
9113 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
9114 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
9115 @end quotation
9116
9117 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
9118 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
9119 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
9120 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
9121
9122 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
9123 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
9124 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
9125
9126 @item --target=@var{triplet}
9127 @cindex cross-compilation
9128 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
9129 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
9130 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
9131
9132 @anchor{build-check}
9133 @item --check
9134 @cindex determinism, checking
9135 @cindex reproducibility, checking
9136 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
9137 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
9138 identical.
9139
9140 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
9141 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
9142 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
9143 background information and tools.
9144
9145 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
9146 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
9147 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
9148
9149 @item --repair
9150 @cindex repairing store items
9151 @cindex corruption, recovering from
9152 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
9153 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
9154
9155 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
9156
9157 @item --derivations
9158 @itemx -d
9159 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
9160 packages.
9161
9162 @item --root=@var{file}
9163 @itemx -r @var{file}
9164 @cindex GC roots, adding
9165 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
9166 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
9167 collector root.
9168
9169 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
9170 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
9171 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
9172 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
9173 more on GC roots.
9174
9175 @item --log-file
9176 @cindex build logs, access
9177 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
9178 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
9179 missing.
9180
9181 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
9182 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
9183
9184 @example
9185 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
9186 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
9187 guix build --log-file guile
9188 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
9189 @end example
9190
9191 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
9192 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
9193 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
9194
9195 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
9196 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
9197
9198 @example
9199 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
9200 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
9201 @end example
9202
9203 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
9204 @end table
9205
9206 @node Debugging Build Failures
9207 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
9208
9209 @cindex build failures, debugging
9210 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
9211 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
9212 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
9213 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
9214 build daemon uses.
9215
9216 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
9217 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
9218 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
9219 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
9220
9221 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
9222 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
9223 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
9224 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
9225 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
9226
9227 @example
9228 $ guix build foo -K
9229 @dots{} @i{build fails}
9230 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
9231 $ source ./environment-variables
9232 $ cd foo-1.2
9233 @end example
9234
9235 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
9236 troubleshoot your build process.
9237
9238 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
9239 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
9240 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
9241 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
9242 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
9243
9244 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
9245 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
9246
9247 @example
9248 $ guix build -K foo
9249 @dots{}
9250 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
9251 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
9252 [env]# source ./environment-variables
9253 [env]# cd foo-1.2
9254 @end example
9255
9256 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
9257 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
9258 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
9259 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
9260 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
9261 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
9262 info on grafts).
9263
9264 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
9265 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
9266
9267 @example
9268 [env]# rm /bin/sh
9269 @end example
9270
9271 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
9272 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
9273
9274 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
9275 can run:
9276
9277 @example
9278 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
9279 @end example
9280
9281 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
9282 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
9283 similar to the one the daemon uses.
9284
9285
9286 @node Invoking guix edit
9287 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
9288
9289 @cindex @command{guix edit}
9290 @cindex package definition, editing
9291 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
9292 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
9293 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
9294 For instance:
9295
9296 @example
9297 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
9298 @end example
9299
9300 @noindent
9301 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
9302 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
9303 and that of Vim.
9304
9305 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
9306 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
9307 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
9308 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
9309 for packages currently in the store.
9310
9311 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
9312 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
9313 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
9314 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
9315
9316 @node Invoking guix download
9317 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
9318
9319 @cindex @command{guix download}
9320 @cindex downloading package sources
9321 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
9322 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
9323 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
9324 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
9325 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
9326 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
9327
9328 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
9329 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
9330 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
9331 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
9332 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
9333 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9334
9335 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
9336 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
9337 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
9338 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
9339 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
9340 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
9341 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
9342
9343 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
9344 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
9345 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
9346 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
9347
9348 The following options are available:
9349
9350 @table @code
9351 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
9352 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
9353 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
9354 hash}, for more information.
9355
9356 @item --format=@var{fmt}
9357 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
9358 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
9359 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
9360
9361 @item --no-check-certificate
9362 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
9363
9364 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
9365 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
9366 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
9367
9368 @item --output=@var{file}
9369 @itemx -o @var{file}
9370 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
9371 store.
9372 @end table
9373
9374 @node Invoking guix hash
9375 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
9376
9377 @cindex @command{guix hash}
9378 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
9379 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
9380 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
9381 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9382
9383 The general syntax is:
9384
9385 @example
9386 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
9387 @end example
9388
9389 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
9390 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
9391 following options:
9392
9393 @table @code
9394
9395 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
9396 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
9397 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
9398 default.
9399
9400 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
9401 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
9402 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
9403 Reference Manual}).
9404
9405 @item --format=@var{fmt}
9406 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
9407 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
9408
9409 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
9410 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
9411
9412 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
9413 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
9414 in the definitions of packages.
9415
9416 @item --recursive
9417 @itemx -r
9418 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
9419
9420 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
9421 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
9422 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
9423 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
9424 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
9425 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
9426 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
9427 @c it exists.
9428
9429 @item --exclude-vcs
9430 @itemx -x
9431 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
9432 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
9433
9434 @vindex git-fetch
9435 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
9436 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
9437 Reference}):
9438
9439 @example
9440 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
9441 $ cd foo
9442 $ guix hash -rx .
9443 @end example
9444 @end table
9445
9446 @node Invoking guix import
9447 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
9448
9449 @cindex importing packages
9450 @cindex package import
9451 @cindex package conversion
9452 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
9453 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
9454 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
9455 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
9456 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
9457 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
9458 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9459
9460 The general syntax is:
9461
9462 @example
9463 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
9464 @end example
9465
9466 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
9467 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
9468 options specific to @var{importer}.
9469
9470 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
9471 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
9472 gnupg} if needed.
9473
9474 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
9475
9476 @table @code
9477 @item gnu
9478 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
9479 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
9480 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
9481
9482 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
9483 license needs to be figured out manually.
9484
9485 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
9486 GNU@tie{}Hello:
9487
9488 @example
9489 guix import gnu hello
9490 @end example
9491
9492 Specific command-line options are:
9493
9494 @table @code
9495 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9496 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
9497 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
9498 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
9499 @end table
9500
9501 @item pypi
9502 @cindex pypi
9503 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
9504 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
9505 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
9506 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
9507 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
9508 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
9509
9510 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
9511 package:
9512
9513 @example
9514 guix import pypi itsdangerous
9515 @end example
9516
9517 @table @code
9518 @item --recursive
9519 @itemx -r
9520 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9521 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9522 in Guix.
9523 @end table
9524
9525 @item gem
9526 @cindex gem
9527 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
9528 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
9529 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
9530 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
9531 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
9532 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
9533 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
9534 as an exercise to the packager.
9535
9536 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
9537
9538 @example
9539 guix import gem rails
9540 @end example
9541
9542 @table @code
9543 @item --recursive
9544 @itemx -r
9545 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9546 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9547 in Guix.
9548 @end table
9549
9550 @item cpan
9551 @cindex CPAN
9552 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
9553 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
9554 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
9555 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
9556 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
9557 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
9558 list of dependencies.
9559
9560 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
9561 module:
9562
9563 @example
9564 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
9565 @end example
9566
9567 @item cran
9568 @cindex CRAN
9569 @cindex Bioconductor
9570 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
9571 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
9572 statistical and graphical environment}.
9573
9574 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
9575
9576 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
9577
9578 @example
9579 guix import cran Cairo
9580 @end example
9581
9582 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
9583 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
9584 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
9585
9586 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
9587 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
9588 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
9589 genomic data in bioinformatics.
9590
9591 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
9592 package archive.
9593
9594 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
9595
9596 @example
9597 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
9598 @end example
9599
9600 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
9601 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
9602 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
9603
9604 @example
9605 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
9606 @end example
9607
9608 @item texlive
9609 @cindex TeX Live
9610 @cindex CTAN
9611 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
9612 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
9613 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
9614
9615 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
9616 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
9617 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
9618 versioned archives.
9619
9620 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
9621 TeX package:
9622
9623 @example
9624 guix import texlive fontspec
9625 @end example
9626
9627 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
9628 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
9629 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
9630 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
9631
9632 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
9633 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
9634 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
9635
9636 @example
9637 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
9638 @end example
9639
9640 @item json
9641 @cindex JSON, import
9642 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
9643 example package definition in JSON format:
9644
9645 @example
9646 @{
9647 "name": "hello",
9648 "version": "2.10",
9649 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9650 "build-system": "gnu",
9651 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
9652 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
9653 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
9654 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
9655 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
9656 @}
9657 @end example
9658
9659 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
9660 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
9661 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
9662 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
9663
9664 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
9665 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
9666
9667 @example
9668 @{
9669 @dots{}
9670 "source": @{
9671 "method": "url-fetch",
9672 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9673 "sha256": @{
9674 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
9675 @}
9676 @}
9677 @dots{}
9678 @}
9679 @end example
9680
9681 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
9682 and outputs a package expression:
9683
9684 @example
9685 guix import json hello.json
9686 @end example
9687
9688 @item nix
9689 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
9690 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
9691 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
9692 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
9693 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
9694 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
9695 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
9696 package definition.
9697
9698 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
9699 by their canonical upstream variant.
9700
9701 Usually, you will first need to do:
9702
9703 @example
9704 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
9705 @end example
9706
9707 @noindent
9708 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
9709
9710 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
9711 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
9712 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
9713
9714 @example
9715 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
9716 @end example
9717
9718 @item hackage
9719 @cindex hackage
9720 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
9721 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
9722 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
9723 dependencies.
9724
9725 Specific command-line options are:
9726
9727 @table @code
9728 @item --stdin
9729 @itemx -s
9730 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
9731 @item --no-test-dependencies
9732 @itemx -t
9733 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9734 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
9735 @itemx -e @var{alist}
9736 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
9737 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
9738 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
9739 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
9740 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
9741 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
9742 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
9743 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
9744 @item --recursive
9745 @itemx -r
9746 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9747 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9748 in Guix.
9749 @end table
9750
9751 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
9752 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
9753 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
9754
9755 @example
9756 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
9757 @end example
9758
9759 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
9760 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
9761
9762 @example
9763 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
9764 @end example
9765
9766 @item stackage
9767 @cindex stackage
9768 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
9769 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
9770 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
9771 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
9772 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
9773 GHC compiler used by Guix.
9774
9775 Specific command-line options are:
9776
9777 @table @code
9778 @item --no-test-dependencies
9779 @itemx -t
9780 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9781 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
9782 @itemx -l @var{version}
9783 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
9784 release is used.
9785 @item --recursive
9786 @itemx -r
9787 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9788 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9789 in Guix.
9790 @end table
9791
9792 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
9793 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
9794
9795 @example
9796 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
9797 @end example
9798
9799 @item elpa
9800 @cindex elpa
9801 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
9802 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9803
9804 Specific command-line options are:
9805
9806 @table @code
9807 @item --archive=@var{repo}
9808 @itemx -a @var{repo}
9809 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
9810 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
9811 are:
9812 @itemize -
9813 @item
9814 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
9815 identifier. This is the default.
9816
9817 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
9818 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
9819 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
9820 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
9821 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9822
9823 @item
9824 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
9825 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
9826
9827 @item
9828 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
9829 identifier.
9830 @end itemize
9831
9832 @item --recursive
9833 @itemx -r
9834 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9835 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9836 in Guix.
9837 @end table
9838
9839 @item crate
9840 @cindex crate
9841 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
9842 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
9843
9844 @example
9845 guix import crate blake2-rfc
9846 @end example
9847
9848 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
9849
9850 @example
9851 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
9852 @end example
9853
9854 Additional options include:
9855
9856 @table @code
9857 @item --recursive
9858 @itemx -r
9859 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9860 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9861 in Guix.
9862 @end table
9863
9864 @item opam
9865 @cindex OPAM
9866 @cindex OCaml
9867 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
9868 repository used by the OCaml community.
9869 @end table
9870
9871 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
9872 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
9873 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
9874
9875 @node Invoking guix refresh
9876 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
9877
9878 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
9879 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
9880 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
9881 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
9882 upstream version, like this:
9883
9884 @example
9885 $ guix refresh
9886 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
9887 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
9888 @end example
9889
9890 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
9891 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
9892
9893 @example
9894 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
9895 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
9896 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
9897 @end example
9898
9899 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
9900 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
9901 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
9902 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
9903 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
9904 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
9905 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
9906
9907 @table @code
9908
9909 @item --recursive
9910 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
9911
9912 @example
9913 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
9914 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
9915 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
9916 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
9917 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
9918 @dots{}
9919 @end example
9920
9921 @end table
9922
9923 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
9924 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
9925 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
9926 to that effect:
9927
9928 @lisp
9929 (define-public network-manager
9930 (package
9931 (name "network-manager")
9932 ;; @dots{}
9933 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
9934 @end lisp
9935
9936 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
9937 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
9938 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
9939 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
9940 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
9941 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
9942 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
9943
9944 When the public
9945 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
9946 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
9947 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
9948 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
9949
9950 The following options are supported:
9951
9952 @table @code
9953
9954 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9955 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9956 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9957
9958 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9959
9960 @example
9961 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
9962 @end example
9963
9964 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
9965 the packages).
9966
9967 @item --update
9968 @itemx -u
9969 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
9970 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
9971 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
9972
9973 @example
9974 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
9975 @end example
9976
9977 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
9978
9979 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
9980 @itemx -s @var{subset}
9981 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
9982 @code{non-core}.
9983
9984 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
9985 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
9986 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
9987 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
9988 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
9989 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
9990
9991 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
9992 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
9993 inconvenient.
9994
9995 @item --manifest=@var{file}
9996 @itemx -m @var{file}
9997 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
9998 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
9999
10000 @item --type=@var{updater}
10001 @itemx -t @var{updater}
10002 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
10003 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
10004
10005 @table @code
10006 @item gnu
10007 the updater for GNU packages;
10008 @item gnome
10009 the updater for GNOME packages;
10010 @item kde
10011 the updater for KDE packages;
10012 @item xorg
10013 the updater for X.org packages;
10014 @item kernel.org
10015 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
10016 @item elpa
10017 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
10018 @item cran
10019 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
10020 @item bioconductor
10021 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
10022 @item cpan
10023 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
10024 @item pypi
10025 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
10026 @item gem
10027 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
10028 @item github
10029 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
10030 @item hackage
10031 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
10032 @item stackage
10033 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
10034 @item crate
10035 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
10036 @item launchpad
10037 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
10038 @end table
10039
10040 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
10041 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
10042
10043 @example
10044 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
10045 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
10046 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
10047 @end example
10048
10049 @end table
10050
10051 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
10052 names, as in this example:
10053
10054 @example
10055 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
10056 @end example
10057
10058 @noindent
10059 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
10060 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
10061 effect in this case.
10062
10063 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
10064 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
10065 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
10066 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
10067
10068 @table @code
10069
10070 @item --list-updaters
10071 @itemx -L
10072 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
10073
10074 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
10075 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
10076
10077 @item --list-dependent
10078 @itemx -l
10079 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
10080 result of upgrading one or more packages.
10081
10082 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
10083 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
10084 dependents of a package.
10085
10086 @end table
10087
10088 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
10089 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
10090 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
10091
10092 @example
10093 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
10094 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
10095 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
10096 @end example
10097
10098 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
10099 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
10100
10101 @table @code
10102
10103 @item --list-transitive
10104 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
10105
10106 @example
10107 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
10108 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
10109 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
10110 @end example
10111
10112 @end table
10113
10114 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
10115 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
10116
10117 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
10118
10119 @table @code
10120
10121 @item --gpg=@var{command}
10122 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
10123 for in @code{$PATH}.
10124
10125 @item --keyring=@var{file}
10126 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
10127 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
10128 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
10129 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
10130 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
10131
10132 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
10133 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
10134 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
10135 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
10136 @option{--key-download} below).
10137
10138 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
10139 commands like this one:
10140
10141 @example
10142 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
10143 @end example
10144
10145 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
10146
10147 @example
10148 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
10149 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
10150 @end example
10151
10152 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
10153 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
10154
10155 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
10156 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
10157 of:
10158
10159 @table @code
10160 @item always
10161 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
10162 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
10163
10164 @item never
10165 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
10166
10167 @item interactive
10168 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
10169 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
10170 @end table
10171
10172 @item --key-server=@var{host}
10173 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
10174
10175 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10176 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10177 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10178
10179 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10180 the command-line tools.
10181
10182 @end table
10183
10184 The @code{github} updater uses the
10185 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
10186 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
10187 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
10188 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
10189 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
10190 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
10191 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
10192 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
10193 otherwise.
10194
10195
10196 @node Invoking guix lint
10197 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
10198
10199 @cindex @command{guix lint}
10200 @cindex package, checking for errors
10201 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
10202 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
10203 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
10204 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
10205 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
10206
10207 @table @code
10208 @item synopsis
10209 @itemx description
10210 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
10211 descriptions and synopses.
10212
10213 @item inputs-should-be-native
10214 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
10215
10216 @item source
10217 @itemx home-page
10218 @itemx mirror-url
10219 @itemx github-url
10220 @itemx source-file-name
10221 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
10222 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
10223 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
10224 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
10225 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
10226 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
10227
10228 @item source-unstable-tarball
10229 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
10230 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
10231 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
10232
10233 @item derivation
10234 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
10235 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
10236
10237 @item profile-collisions
10238 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
10239 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
10240 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
10241 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
10242 on propagated inputs.
10243
10244 @item archival
10245 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
10246 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
10247 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
10248 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
10249
10250 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
10251 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
10252 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
10253 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
10254 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
10255 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
10256 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
10257
10258 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
10259 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
10260 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
10261 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
10262
10263 Software Heritage
10264 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
10265 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
10266 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
10267 that limit has been reset.
10268
10269 @item cve
10270 @cindex security vulnerabilities
10271 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
10272 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
10273 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
10274 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
10275 NIST}.
10276
10277 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
10278
10279 @itemize
10280 @item
10281 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
10282 @item
10283 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
10284 @end itemize
10285
10286 @noindent
10287 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
10288 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
10289
10290 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
10291 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
10292 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
10293 that Guix uses, as in this example:
10294
10295 @lisp
10296 (package
10297 (name "grub")
10298 ;; @dots{}
10299 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
10300 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
10301 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
10302 @end lisp
10303
10304 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
10305 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
10306 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
10307 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
10308 declare them as in this example:
10309
10310 @lisp
10311 (package
10312 (name "t1lib")
10313 ;; @dots{}
10314 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
10315 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
10316 "CVE-2011-1553"
10317 "CVE-2011-1554"
10318 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
10319 @end lisp
10320
10321 @item formatting
10322 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
10323 use of tabulations, etc.
10324 @end table
10325
10326 The general syntax is:
10327
10328 @example
10329 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
10330 @end example
10331
10332 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
10333 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
10334
10335 @table @code
10336 @item --list-checkers
10337 @itemx -l
10338 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
10339 and exit.
10340
10341 @item --checkers
10342 @itemx -c
10343 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
10344 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
10345
10346 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10347 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10348 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10349 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10350
10351 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10352 the command-line tools.
10353
10354 @end table
10355
10356 @node Invoking guix size
10357 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
10358
10359 @cindex size
10360 @cindex package size
10361 @cindex closure
10362 @cindex @command{guix size}
10363 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
10364 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
10365 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
10366 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
10367 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
10368 @command{guix size} can highlight.
10369
10370 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
10371 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
10372 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
10373 example:
10374
10375 @example
10376 $ guix size coreutils
10377 store item total self
10378 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
10379 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
10380 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
10381 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
10382 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
10383 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
10384 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
10385 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
10386 total: 78.9 MiB
10387 @end example
10388
10389 @cindex closure
10390 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
10391 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
10392 would be returned by:
10393
10394 @example
10395 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
10396 @end example
10397
10398 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
10399 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
10400 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
10401 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
10402 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
10403 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
10404
10405 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
10406 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
10407 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
10408 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
10409 on the system anyway.)
10410
10411 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
10412 a build result is straightforward:
10413
10414 @example
10415 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
10416 @end example
10417
10418 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
10419 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
10420 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
10421 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
10422 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
10423 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
10424 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
10425 Coreutils}).
10426
10427 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
10428 reports information based on the available substitutes
10429 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
10430 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
10431
10432 You can also specify several package names:
10433
10434 @example
10435 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
10436 store item total self
10437 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
10438 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
10439 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
10440 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
10441 @dots{}
10442 total: 102.3 MiB
10443 @end example
10444
10445 @noindent
10446 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
10447 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
10448 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
10449
10450 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
10451 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
10452 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
10453 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
10454 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
10455
10456 The available options are:
10457
10458 @table @option
10459
10460 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10461 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
10462 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
10463
10464 @item --sort=@var{key}
10465 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
10466
10467 @table @code
10468 @item self
10469 the size of each item (the default);
10470 @item closure
10471 the total size of the item's closure.
10472 @end table
10473
10474 @item --map-file=@var{file}
10475 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
10476
10477 For the example above, the map looks like this:
10478
10479 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
10480 produced by @command{guix size}}
10481
10482 This option requires that
10483 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
10484 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
10485 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
10486
10487 @item --system=@var{system}
10488 @itemx -s @var{system}
10489 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
10490
10491 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10492 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10493 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10494 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10495
10496 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10497 the command-line tools.
10498 @end table
10499
10500 @node Invoking guix graph
10501 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
10502
10503 @cindex DAG
10504 @cindex @command{guix graph}
10505 @cindex package dependencies
10506 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
10507 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
10508 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
10509 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
10510 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
10511 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
10512 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
10513 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
10514 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
10515 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
10516 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
10517 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
10518 packages. The general syntax is:
10519
10520 @example
10521 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
10522 @end example
10523
10524 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
10525 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
10526 dependencies:
10527
10528 @example
10529 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
10530 @end example
10531
10532 The output looks like this:
10533
10534 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
10535
10536 Nice little graph, no?
10537
10538 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
10539 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
10540
10541 @example
10542 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
10543 @end example
10544
10545 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
10546 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
10547 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
10548 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
10549 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
10550
10551 @table @code
10552 @item package
10553 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
10554 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
10555 filters out many details.
10556
10557 @item reverse-package
10558 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
10559
10560 @example
10561 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
10562 @end example
10563
10564 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
10565 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
10566 @code{reverse-bag} below).
10567
10568 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
10569 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
10570 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
10571 @option{--list-dependent}}).
10572
10573 @item bag-emerged
10574 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
10575
10576 For instance, the following command:
10577
10578 @example
10579 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
10580 @end example
10581
10582 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
10583
10584 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
10585
10586 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
10587 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
10588
10589 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
10590 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
10591 here, for conciseness.
10592
10593 @item bag
10594 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
10595 dependencies.
10596
10597 @item bag-with-origins
10598 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
10599
10600 @item reverse-bag
10601 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
10602 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
10603
10604 @example
10605 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
10606 @end example
10607
10608 @noindent
10609 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
10610 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
10611 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
10612 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
10613
10614 @item derivation
10615 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
10616 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
10617 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
10618 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
10619
10620 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
10621 name instead of a package name, as in:
10622
10623 @example
10624 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
10625 @end example
10626
10627 @item module
10628 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10629 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
10630 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
10631
10632 @example
10633 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
10634 @end example
10635 @end table
10636
10637 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
10638 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
10639
10640 @table @code
10641 @item references
10642 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
10643 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10644
10645 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
10646 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
10647
10648 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
10649 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
10650 (which can be big!):
10651
10652 @example
10653 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10654 @end example
10655
10656 @item referrers
10657 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
10658 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10659
10660 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
10661 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
10662 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
10663 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
10664 to it.
10665
10666 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
10667 collected.
10668
10669 @end table
10670
10671 @cindex shortest path, between packages
10672 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
10673 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
10674 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
10675 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
10676 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
10677 etc.):
10678
10679 @example
10680 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
10681 emacs@@26.3
10682 mailutils@@3.9
10683 libunistring@@0.9.10
10684 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
10685 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
10686 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
10687 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
10688 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
10689 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
10690 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
10691 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
10692 @end example
10693
10694 The available options are the following:
10695
10696 @table @option
10697 @item --type=@var{type}
10698 @itemx -t @var{type}
10699 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
10700 the values listed above.
10701
10702 @item --list-types
10703 List the supported graph types.
10704
10705 @item --backend=@var{backend}
10706 @itemx -b @var{backend}
10707 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
10708
10709 @item --list-backends
10710 List the supported graph backends.
10711
10712 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
10713
10714 @item --path
10715 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
10716 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
10717 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
10718 @code{libreoffice}:
10719
10720 @example
10721 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
10722 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
10723 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
10724 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
10725 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
10726 @end example
10727
10728 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10729 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10730 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
10731
10732 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
10733
10734 @example
10735 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
10736 @end example
10737
10738 @item --system=@var{system}
10739 @itemx -s @var{system}
10740 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
10741
10742 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
10743 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
10744
10745 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10746 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10747 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10748 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10749
10750 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10751 the command-line tools.
10752 @end table
10753
10754 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
10755 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
10756 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
10757 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
10758 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
10759 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
10760
10761 @example
10762 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
10763 @end example
10764
10765 So many possibilities, so much fun!
10766
10767 @node Invoking guix publish
10768 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
10769
10770 @cindex @command{guix publish}
10771 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
10772 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
10773 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10774
10775 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
10776 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
10777 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
10778 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
10779 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
10780
10781 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
10782 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
10783 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
10784 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
10785 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
10786
10787 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
10788 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10789 guix archive}).
10790
10791 The general syntax is:
10792
10793 @example
10794 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
10795 @end example
10796
10797 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
10798 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
10799
10800 @example
10801 guix publish
10802 @end example
10803
10804 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
10805 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
10806
10807 @example
10808 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
10809 @end example
10810
10811 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
10812 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
10813 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
10814 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
10815 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
10816 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
10817 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
10818
10819 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
10820 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
10821 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
10822 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
10823 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
10824 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
10825
10826 @example
10827 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
10828 @end example
10829
10830 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
10831 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
10832
10833 @cindex build logs, publication
10834 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
10835
10836 @example
10837 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
10838 @end example
10839
10840 @noindent
10841 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
10842 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
10843 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
10844 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
10845 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
10846 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
10847 Bzip2 compression.
10848
10849 The following options are available:
10850
10851 @table @code
10852 @item --port=@var{port}
10853 @itemx -p @var{port}
10854 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
10855
10856 @item --listen=@var{host}
10857 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
10858 accept connections from any interface.
10859
10860 @item --user=@var{user}
10861 @itemx -u @var{user}
10862 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
10863 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
10864
10865 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10866 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10867 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
10868 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
10869 is used.
10870
10871 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
10872 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
10873 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
10874
10875 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
10876 increase in CPU usage; see
10877 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
10878 page}.
10879
10880 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
10881 the compressed streams are not
10882 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
10883 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
10884 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
10885 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
10886 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
10887 to its responses.
10888
10889 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
10890 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
10891 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
10892 the one they support.
10893
10894 @item --cache=@var{directory}
10895 @itemx -c @var{directory}
10896 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
10897 and only serve archives that are in cache.
10898
10899 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
10900 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
10901 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
10902 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
10903 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
10904 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
10905 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
10906
10907 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
10908 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
10909 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
10910 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
10911 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
10912 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
10913 the best possible bandwidth.
10914
10915 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
10916 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
10917 @option{--workers} below.
10918
10919 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
10920 when they have expired.
10921
10922 @item --workers=@var{N}
10923 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
10924 threads to ``bake'' archives.
10925
10926 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
10927 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
10928 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
10929 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
10930
10931 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
10932 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
10933 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
10934 for as long as @var{ttl}.
10935
10936 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
10937 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
10938 item in the store, may be deleted.
10939
10940 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
10941 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
10942 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
10943
10944 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
10945 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
10946 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
10947
10948 @item --public-key=@var{file}
10949 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
10950 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
10951 the store items being published.
10952
10953 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
10954 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
10955 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
10956 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10957 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
10958 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
10959
10960 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
10961 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
10962 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
10963 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
10964 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
10965 @end table
10966
10967 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
10968 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
10969 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
10970 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
10971
10972 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
10973 instructions:
10974
10975 @itemize
10976 @item
10977 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
10978
10979 @example
10980 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
10981 /etc/systemd/system/
10982 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
10983 @end example
10984
10985 @item
10986 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
10987
10988 @example
10989 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
10990 # start guix-publish
10991 @end example
10992
10993 @item
10994 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
10995 @end itemize
10996
10997 @node Invoking guix challenge
10998 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
10999
11000 @cindex reproducible builds
11001 @cindex verifiable builds
11002 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
11003 @cindex challenge
11004 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
11005 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
11006 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
11007 answer.
11008
11009 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
11010 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
11011 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
11012 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
11013 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
11014 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
11015 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
11016
11017 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
11018 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
11019 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
11020 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
11021 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
11022 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
11023 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
11024 any given store item.
11025
11026 The command output looks like this:
11027
11028 @smallexample
11029 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
11030 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
11031 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
11032 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
11033 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
11034 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
11035 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
11036 differing files:
11037 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
11038 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
11039
11040 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
11041 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
11042 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
11043 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
11044 differing file:
11045 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
11046
11047 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
11048 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
11049 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
11050 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
11051 differing file:
11052 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
11053
11054 @dots{}
11055
11056 6,406 store items were analyzed:
11057 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
11058 - 525 (8.2%) differed
11059 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
11060 @end smallexample
11061
11062 @noindent
11063 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
11064 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
11065 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
11066 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
11067 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
11068
11069 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
11070 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
11071 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
11072 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
11073 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
11074 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
11075 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
11076 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
11077 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
11078 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
11079 more information.
11080
11081 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
11082 to run:
11083
11084 @example
11085 guix challenge git \
11086 --diff=diffoscope \
11087 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
11088 @end example
11089
11090 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
11091 information about files that differ.
11092
11093 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
11094 archive}):
11095
11096 @example
11097 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
11098 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
11099 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
11100 @end example
11101
11102 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
11103 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
11104 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
11105 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
11106 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
11107 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
11108 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
11109
11110 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
11111 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
11112 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
11113 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
11114 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
11115 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
11116 the problem.
11117
11118 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
11119 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
11120 same build result as you did with:
11121
11122 @example
11123 $ guix challenge @var{package}
11124 @end example
11125
11126 @noindent
11127 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
11128 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
11129
11130 The general syntax is:
11131
11132 @example
11133 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
11134 @end example
11135
11136 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
11137 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
11138 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
11139 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
11140 errors).
11141
11142 The one option that matters is:
11143
11144 @table @code
11145
11146 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
11147 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
11148 URLs to compare to.
11149
11150 @item --diff=@var{mode}
11151 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
11152
11153 @table @asis
11154 @item @code{simple} (the default)
11155 Show the list of files that differ.
11156
11157 @item @code{diffoscope}
11158 @itemx @var{command}
11159 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
11160 two directories whose contents do not match.
11161
11162 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
11163 of Diffoscope.
11164
11165 @item @code{none}
11166 Do not show further details about the differences.
11167 @end table
11168
11169 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
11170 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
11171 can compare them.
11172
11173 @item --verbose
11174 @itemx -v
11175 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
11176 information about mismatches.
11177
11178 @end table
11179
11180 @node Invoking guix copy
11181 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
11182
11183 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
11184 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
11185 @cindex sharing store items across machines
11186 @cindex transferring store items across machines
11187 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
11188 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
11189 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
11190 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
11191 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
11192 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
11193
11194 @example
11195 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
11196 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
11197 @end example
11198
11199 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
11200 they are not actually sent.
11201
11202 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
11203 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
11204
11205 @example
11206 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
11207 @end example
11208
11209 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
11210 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
11211 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
11212
11213 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
11214 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
11215 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
11216 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
11217 store item authentication.
11218
11219 The general syntax is:
11220
11221 @example
11222 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
11223 @end example
11224
11225 You must always specify one of the following options:
11226
11227 @table @code
11228 @item --to=@var{spec}
11229 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
11230 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
11231 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
11232 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
11233 @end table
11234
11235 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
11236 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
11237
11238 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
11239 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
11240 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
11241
11242
11243 @node Invoking guix container
11244 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
11245 @cindex container
11246 @cindex @command{guix container}
11247 @quotation Note
11248 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
11249 is subject to radical change in the future.
11250 @end quotation
11251
11252 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
11253 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
11254 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
11255 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
11256 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
11257
11258 The general syntax is:
11259
11260 @example
11261 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
11262 @end example
11263
11264 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
11265 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
11266
11267 The following actions are available:
11268
11269 @table @code
11270 @item exec
11271 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
11272
11273 The syntax is:
11274
11275 @example
11276 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
11277 @end example
11278
11279 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
11280 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
11281 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
11282 will be passed to @var{program}.
11283
11284 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
11285 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
11286 process ID is 9001:
11287
11288 @example
11289 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
11290 @end example
11291
11292 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
11293 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
11294
11295 @end table
11296
11297 @node Invoking guix weather
11298 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
11299
11300 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
11301 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
11302 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
11303 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
11304 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
11305 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
11306 publish}).
11307
11308 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
11309 @cindex availability of substitutes
11310 @cindex substitute availability
11311 @cindex weather, substitute availability
11312 Here's a sample run:
11313
11314 @example
11315 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
11316 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
11317 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
11318 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
11319 https://guix.example.org
11320 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
11321 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
11322 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
11323 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
11324 33.5 requests per second
11325
11326 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
11327 867 queued builds
11328 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
11329 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
11330 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
11331 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
11332 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
11333 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
11334 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
11335 @end example
11336
11337 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
11338 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
11339 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
11340 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
11341 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
11342 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
11343 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
11344 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
11345 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
11346 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
11347 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
11348
11349 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
11350 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
11351 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
11352 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
11353 those substitutes.
11354
11355 The general syntax is:
11356
11357 @example
11358 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
11359 @end example
11360
11361 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
11362 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
11363 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
11364 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
11365 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
11366 available substitutes is below 100%.
11367
11368 The available options are listed below.
11369
11370 @table @code
11371 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
11372 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
11373 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
11374 servers is queried.
11375
11376 @item --system=@var{system}
11377 @itemx -s @var{system}
11378 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
11379 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
11380 substitutes for several system types.
11381
11382 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11383 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
11384 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
11385 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
11386 guix package}).
11387
11388 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
11389 are concatenated.
11390
11391 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
11392 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
11393 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
11394 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
11395 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
11396 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
11397 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
11398
11399 @example
11400 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
11401 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
11402 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
11403 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
11404 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
11405 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
11406 @dots{}
11407 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
11408 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
11409 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
11410 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
11411 @dots{}
11412 @end example
11413
11414 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
11415 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
11416 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
11417
11418 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
11419 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
11420 fail to build.
11421
11422 @item --display-missing
11423 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
11424 @end table
11425
11426 @node Invoking guix processes
11427 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
11428
11429 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
11430 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
11431 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
11432 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
11433 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
11434 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
11435
11436 @example
11437 $ sudo guix processes
11438 SessionPID: 19002
11439 ClientPID: 19090
11440 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
11441
11442 SessionPID: 19402
11443 ClientPID: 19367
11444 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
11445
11446 SessionPID: 19444
11447 ClientPID: 19419
11448 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
11449 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
11450 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
11451 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
11452 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
11453 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
11454 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
11455 @end example
11456
11457 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
11458 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
11459 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
11460 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
11461 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
11462
11463 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
11464 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
11465 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
11466 running as root). Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
11467 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
11468 Setup}).
11469
11470 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
11471 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
11472 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
11473 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
11474
11475 @example
11476 $ sudo guix processes | \
11477 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
11478 ClientPID: 19419
11479 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
11480 @end example
11481
11482 @node System Configuration
11483 @chapter System Configuration
11484
11485 @cindex system configuration
11486 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
11487 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
11488 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
11489 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
11490 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
11491
11492 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
11493 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
11494 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
11495 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
11496 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
11497 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
11498 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
11499 the own tools of the system.
11500 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
11501
11502 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
11503 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
11504 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
11505 instance to support new system services.
11506
11507 @menu
11508 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
11509 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
11510 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
11511 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
11512 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
11513 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
11514 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
11515 * Services:: Specifying system services.
11516 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
11517 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
11518 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
11519 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
11520 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
11521 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
11522 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
11523 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
11524 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
11525 @end menu
11526
11527 @node Using the Configuration System
11528 @section Using the Configuration System
11529
11530 The operating system is configured by providing an
11531 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
11532 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
11533 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
11534 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
11535
11536 @findex operating-system
11537 @lisp
11538 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
11539 @end lisp
11540
11541 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
11542 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
11543 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
11544 which case they get a default value.
11545
11546 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
11547 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
11548 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
11549 @command{guix system}.
11550
11551 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
11552
11553 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
11554 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
11555 @cindex UEFI boot
11556 @cindex EFI boot
11557 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
11558 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
11559 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
11560 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
11561 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
11562
11563 @lisp
11564 (bootloader-configuration
11565 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11566 (target "/boot/efi"))
11567 @end lisp
11568
11569 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
11570 configuration options.
11571
11572 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
11573
11574 @vindex %base-packages
11575 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
11576 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
11577 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
11578 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
11579 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
11580 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
11581 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
11582 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
11583 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
11584 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
11585 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
11586 of a package:
11587
11588 @lisp
11589 (use-modules (gnu packages))
11590 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
11591
11592 (operating-system
11593 ;; ...
11594 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
11595 %base-packages)))
11596 @end lisp
11597
11598 @findex specification->package
11599 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
11600 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
11601 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
11602 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
11603 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
11604 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
11605 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
11606 version:
11607
11608 @lisp
11609 (use-modules (gnu packages))
11610
11611 (operating-system
11612 ;; ...
11613 (packages (append (map specification->package
11614 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
11615 %base-packages)))
11616 @end lisp
11617
11618 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
11619
11620 @cindex services
11621 @vindex %base-services
11622 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
11623 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
11624 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
11625 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
11626 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
11627 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
11628 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
11629 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
11630 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
11631
11632 @cindex customization, of services
11633 @findex modify-services
11634 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
11635 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
11636 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
11637
11638 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
11639 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
11640 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
11641 following in your operating system declaration:
11642
11643 @lisp
11644 (define %my-services
11645 ;; My very own list of services.
11646 (modify-services %base-services
11647 (guix-service-type config =>
11648 (guix-configuration
11649 (inherit config)
11650 (use-substitutes? #f)
11651 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
11652 (mingetty-service-type config =>
11653 (mingetty-configuration
11654 (inherit config)))))
11655
11656 (operating-system
11657 ;; @dots{}
11658 (services %my-services))
11659 @end lisp
11660
11661 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
11662 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
11663 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
11664 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
11665 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
11666 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
11667 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
11668 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
11669 configuration, but with a few modifications.
11670
11671 @cindex encrypted disk
11672 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
11673 root partition, the X11 display
11674 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
11675 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
11676 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
11677
11678 @lisp
11679 @include os-config-desktop.texi
11680 @end lisp
11681
11682 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
11683 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
11684
11685 @lisp
11686 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
11687 @end lisp
11688
11689 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
11690 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
11691 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
11692
11693 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
11694 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
11695 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
11696
11697 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
11698 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
11699 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
11700 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
11701 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
11702 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
11703
11704 @lisp
11705 (remove (lambda (service)
11706 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
11707 %desktop-services)
11708 @end lisp
11709
11710 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
11711
11712 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
11713 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
11714 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
11715 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
11716 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
11717
11718 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
11719 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
11720 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
11721 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
11722 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
11723 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
11724 system, should you ever need to.
11725
11726 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
11727 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
11728 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
11729 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
11730 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
11731 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
11732 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
11733 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
11734 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
11735 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
11736
11737 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
11738 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
11739 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
11740 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
11741 system}).
11742
11743 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
11744
11745 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
11746 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
11747 Monad}):
11748
11749 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
11750 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
11751 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
11752
11753 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
11754 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
11755 instantiate @var{os}.
11756 @end deffn
11757
11758 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
11759 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
11760 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
11761
11762
11763 @node operating-system Reference
11764 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
11765
11766 This section summarizes all the options available in
11767 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
11768 System}).
11769
11770 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
11771 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
11772 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
11773 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
11774
11775 @table @asis
11776 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
11777 The package object of the operating system kernel to
11778 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
11779 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
11780 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
11781
11782 @cindex hurd
11783 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
11784 The package object of the hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
11785 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
11786 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
11787 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
11788
11789 @quotation Warning
11790 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
11791 @end quotation
11792
11793 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
11794 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
11795 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
11796
11797 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
11798 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
11799 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
11800
11801 @item @code{bootloader}
11802 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
11803
11804 @item @code{label}
11805 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
11806 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
11807
11808 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
11809 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
11810 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
11811 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
11812
11813 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
11814 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
11815 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
11816 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11817
11818 @quotation Note
11819 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
11820 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
11821 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
11822 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
11823 Window System.
11824 @end quotation
11825
11826 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
11827 @cindex initrd
11828 @cindex initial RAM disk
11829 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
11830 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11831
11832 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
11833 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
11834 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
11835 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11836
11837 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
11838 @cindex firmware
11839 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
11840
11841 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
11842 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
11843 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
11844 supported hardware.
11845
11846 @item @code{host-name}
11847 The host name.
11848
11849 @item @code{hosts-file}
11850 @cindex hosts file
11851 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
11852 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11853 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
11854 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
11855
11856 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11857 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
11858
11859 @item @code{file-systems}
11860 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
11861
11862 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11863 @cindex swap devices
11864 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
11865 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11866 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
11867 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
11868 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
11869 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
11870
11871 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
11872 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
11873 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
11874
11875 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
11876 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
11877
11878 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
11879 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
11880 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
11881 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
11882
11883 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
11884
11885 @lisp
11886 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
11887 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
11888 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
11889 (activate-readline)")))
11890 @end lisp
11891
11892 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
11893 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
11894 displayed when users log in on a text console.
11895
11896 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
11897 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
11898 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
11899
11900 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
11901 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
11902 package}).
11903
11904 @item @code{timezone}
11905 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
11906
11907 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
11908 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
11909 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
11910
11911 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
11912 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
11913 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
11914
11915 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
11916 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
11917 run time. @xref{Locales}.
11918
11919 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
11920 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
11921 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
11922 considerations that justify this option.
11923
11924 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
11925 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
11926 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
11927 details.
11928
11929 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
11930 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
11931
11932 @cindex essential services
11933 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
11934 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
11935 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
11936 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
11937 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
11938
11939 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
11940 @cindex PAM
11941 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
11942 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
11943 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
11944
11945 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
11946 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
11947 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
11948
11949 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
11950 @cindex sudoers file
11951 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
11952 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
11953
11954 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
11955 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
11956 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
11957 @code{sudo}.
11958
11959 @end table
11960
11961 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
11962 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
11963 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
11964
11965 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
11966 the definition of the @code{label} field:
11967
11968 @lisp
11969 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
11970
11971 (operating-system
11972 ;; ...
11973 (label (package-full-name
11974 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
11975 @end lisp
11976
11977 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
11978 system definition.
11979 @end deffn
11980
11981 @end deftp
11982
11983 @node File Systems
11984 @section File Systems
11985
11986 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
11987 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
11988 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
11989 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
11990
11991 @lisp
11992 (file-system
11993 (mount-point "/home")
11994 (device "/dev/sda3")
11995 (type "ext4"))
11996 @end lisp
11997
11998 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
11999 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
12000
12001 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
12002 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
12003 contain the following members:
12004
12005 @table @asis
12006 @item @code{type}
12007 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
12008 @code{"ext4"}.
12009
12010 @item @code{mount-point}
12011 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
12012
12013 @item @code{device}
12014 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
12015 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
12016 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
12017 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
12018 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
12019 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
12020 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
12021 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
12022 mounted.}.
12023
12024 @findex file-system-label
12025 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
12026 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
12027 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
12028 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
12029
12030 @lisp
12031 (file-system
12032 (mount-point "/home")
12033 (type "ext4")
12034 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
12035 @end lisp
12036
12037 @findex uuid
12038 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
12039 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
12040 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
12041 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
12042 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
12043 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
12044 like this:
12045
12046 @lisp
12047 (file-system
12048 (mount-point "/home")
12049 (type "ext4")
12050 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
12051 @end lisp
12052
12053 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
12054 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
12055 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
12056 This is required so that
12057 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
12058 corresponding device mapping established.
12059
12060 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
12061 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
12062 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
12063 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
12064 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
12065 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
12066 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
12067 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
12068 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
12069 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
12070
12071 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
12072 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
12073 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
12074 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
12075 options for various file systems. Note that the
12076 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
12077 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
12078 file system options given as an association list to the string
12079 representation, and vice-versa.
12080
12081 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
12082 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
12083 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
12084 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
12085 is not automatically mounted.
12086
12087 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
12088 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
12089 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
12090 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
12091 instance, for the root file system.
12092
12093 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
12094 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
12095 errors before being mounted.
12096
12097 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
12098 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
12099
12100 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
12101 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
12102 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
12103 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
12104
12105 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
12106 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
12107 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
12108
12109 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
12110 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
12111 @end table
12112 @end deftp
12113
12114 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
12115 variables.
12116
12117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
12118 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
12119 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
12120 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
12121 these.
12122 @end defvr
12123
12124 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
12125 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
12126 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
12127 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
12128 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
12129 @command{xterm}.
12130 @end defvr
12131
12132 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
12133 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
12134 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
12135 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12136 @end defvr
12137
12138 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
12139 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
12140 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
12141 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
12142 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
12143
12144 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
12145 read-write in its own ``name space.''
12146 @end defvr
12147
12148 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
12149 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
12150 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
12151 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
12152 @end defvr
12153
12154 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
12155 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
12156 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
12157 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
12158 @end defvr
12159
12160 @node Btrfs file system
12161 @subsection Btrfs file system
12162
12163 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
12164 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
12165 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
12166 System.
12167
12168 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
12169 example, by:
12170
12171 @lisp
12172 (file-system
12173 (mount-point "/home")
12174 (type "btrfs")
12175 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
12176 @end lisp
12177
12178 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
12179 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
12180 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
12181 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
12182
12183 @lisp
12184 (file-system
12185 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
12186 (mount-point "/")
12187 (type "btrfs")
12188 (options "subvol=rootfs")
12189 (dependencies mapped-devices))
12190 @end lisp
12191
12192 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
12193 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
12194 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
12195 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
12196 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
12197 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
12198 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
12199 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
12200 path of a subvolume.
12201
12202 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
12203 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
12204 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
12205 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
12206 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
12207 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
12208 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
12209
12210 @example
12211 / (top level)
12212 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
12213 ├── gnu (normal directory)
12214 ├── store (normal directory)
12215 [...]
12216 @end example
12217
12218 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
12219 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
12220 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
12221
12222 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
12223 directories:
12224
12225 @example
12226 / (top level)
12227 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
12228 ├── gnu (normal directory)
12229 ├── store (subvolume)
12230 [...]
12231 @end example
12232
12233 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
12234 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
12235 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
12236 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
12237 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
12238
12239 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
12240
12241 @example
12242 / (top level)
12243 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
12244 ├── root-current (subvolume)
12245 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
12246 [...]
12247 @end example
12248
12249 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
12250 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
12251 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
12252 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
12253 a file system declaration such as:
12254
12255 @lisp
12256 (file-system
12257 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
12258 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
12259 (type "btrfs")
12260 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
12261 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
12262 @end lisp
12263
12264 @node Mapped Devices
12265 @section Mapped Devices
12266
12267 @cindex device mapping
12268 @cindex mapped devices
12269 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
12270 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
12271 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
12272 with additional processing over the data that flows through
12273 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
12274 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
12275 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
12276 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
12277 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
12278 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
12279 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
12280 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
12281 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
12282 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
12283 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
12284 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
12285 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
12286
12287 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
12288 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
12289
12290 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
12291 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
12292 the system boots up.
12293
12294 @table @code
12295 @item source
12296 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
12297 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
12298 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
12299
12300 @item target
12301 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
12302 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
12303 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
12304 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
12305 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
12306 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
12307
12308 @item type
12309 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
12310 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
12311 @end table
12312 @end deftp
12313
12314 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
12315 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
12316 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
12317 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
12318 @end defvr
12319
12320 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
12321 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
12322 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
12323 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
12324 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
12325 @end defvr
12326
12327 @cindex disk encryption
12328 @cindex LUKS
12329 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
12330 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
12331 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
12332 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
12333 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
12334 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
12335 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
12336
12337 @lisp
12338 (mapped-device
12339 (source "/dev/sda3")
12340 (target "home")
12341 (type luks-device-mapping))
12342 @end lisp
12343
12344 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
12345 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
12346 command like:
12347
12348 @example
12349 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
12350 @end example
12351
12352 and use it as follows:
12353
12354 @lisp
12355 (mapped-device
12356 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
12357 (target "home")
12358 (type luks-device-mapping))
12359 @end lisp
12360
12361 @cindex swap encryption
12362 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
12363 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
12364 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
12365 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
12366 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
12367
12368 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
12369 may be declared as follows:
12370
12371 @lisp
12372 (mapped-device
12373 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
12374 (target "/dev/md0")
12375 (type raid-device-mapping))
12376 @end lisp
12377
12378 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
12379 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
12380 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
12381 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
12382 automatically later.
12383
12384
12385 @node User Accounts
12386 @section User Accounts
12387
12388 @cindex users
12389 @cindex accounts
12390 @cindex user accounts
12391 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
12392 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
12393 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
12394
12395 @lisp
12396 (user-account
12397 (name "alice")
12398 (group "users")
12399 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
12400 "audio" ;sound card
12401 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
12402 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
12403 (comment "Bob's sister")
12404 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
12405 @end lisp
12406
12407 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
12408 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
12409 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
12410 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
12411 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
12412 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
12413 as declared.
12414
12415 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
12416 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
12417 be specified:
12418
12419 @table @asis
12420 @item @code{name}
12421 The name of the user account.
12422
12423 @item @code{group}
12424 @cindex groups
12425 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
12426 this account belongs to.
12427
12428 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
12429 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
12430 account belongs to.
12431
12432 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
12433 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
12434 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
12435 account is created.
12436
12437 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
12438 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
12439
12440 @item @code{home-directory}
12441 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
12442
12443 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
12444 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
12445 if it does not exist yet.
12446
12447 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
12448 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
12449 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12450
12451 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
12452 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
12453 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
12454 graphical login managers do not list them.
12455
12456 @anchor{user-account-password}
12457 @cindex password, for user accounts
12458 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
12459 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
12460 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
12461 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
12462 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
12463 reconfiguration.
12464
12465 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
12466 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
12467 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
12468
12469 @lisp
12470 (user-account
12471 (name "charlie")
12472 (group "users")
12473
12474 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
12475 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
12476 @end lisp
12477
12478 @quotation Note
12479 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
12480 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
12481 care.
12482 @end quotation
12483
12484 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
12485 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
12486 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
12487
12488 @end table
12489 @end deftp
12490
12491 @cindex groups
12492 User group declarations are even simpler:
12493
12494 @lisp
12495 (user-group (name "students"))
12496 @end lisp
12497
12498 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
12499 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
12500
12501 @table @asis
12502 @item @code{name}
12503 The name of the group.
12504
12505 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
12506 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
12507 automatically allocated when the group is created.
12508
12509 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
12510 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
12511 System groups have low numerical IDs.
12512
12513 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
12514 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
12515 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
12516
12517 @end table
12518 @end deftp
12519
12520 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
12521 expect:
12522
12523 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
12524 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
12525 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
12526 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
12527 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
12528 @end defvr
12529
12530 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
12531 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
12532 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
12533
12534 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
12535 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
12536 @end defvr
12537
12538 @node Keyboard Layout
12539 @section Keyboard Layout
12540
12541 @cindex keyboard layout
12542 @cindex keymap
12543 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
12544 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
12545 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
12546 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
12547 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
12548 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
12549 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
12550
12551 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
12552 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
12553
12554 @itemize
12555 @item
12556 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
12557 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
12558 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
12559 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
12560
12561 @item
12562 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
12563 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
12564 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
12565
12566 @item
12567 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
12568 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
12569 @end itemize
12570
12571 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
12572 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
12573
12574 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
12575 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
12576 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
12577 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
12578 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
12579 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
12580 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
12581 about. Here are a few example:
12582
12583 @lisp
12584 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
12585 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
12586 (keyboard-layout "de")
12587
12588 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
12589 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
12590
12591 ;; The Catalan layout.
12592 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
12593
12594 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
12595 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
12596
12597 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
12598 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
12599 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
12600 ;; accented letters.
12601 (keyboard-layout "latam"
12602 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
12603
12604 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
12605 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
12606
12607 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
12608 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
12609 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
12610 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
12611 @end lisp
12612
12613 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
12614 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
12615
12616 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
12617 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
12618 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
12619 configuration would look like:
12620
12621 @findex set-xorg-configuration
12622 @lisp
12623 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
12624 ;; and for Xorg.
12625
12626 (operating-system
12627 ;; ...
12628 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
12629 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
12630 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
12631 (target "/boot/efi")
12632 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
12633 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
12634 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
12635 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
12636 %desktop-services)))
12637 @end lisp
12638
12639 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
12640 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
12641 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
12642 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
12643 GDM.
12644
12645 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
12646 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
12647
12648 @itemize
12649 @item
12650 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
12651 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
12652
12653 @item
12654 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
12655 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
12656 change the layout to US Dvorak:
12657
12658 @example
12659 setxkbmap us dvorak
12660 @end example
12661
12662 @item
12663 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
12664 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
12665 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
12666 French bépo layout:
12667
12668 @example
12669 loadkeys fr-bepo
12670 @end example
12671 @end itemize
12672
12673 @node Locales
12674 @section Locales
12675
12676 @cindex locale
12677 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
12678 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12679 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
12680 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
12681 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
12682 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
12683
12684 @cindex locale definition
12685 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
12686 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
12687 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
12688
12689 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
12690 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
12691 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
12692 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
12693 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
12694 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
12695 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
12696 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
12697
12698 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
12699 that field may be:
12700
12701 @lisp
12702 (cons (locale-definition
12703 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
12704 %default-locale-definitions)
12705 @end lisp
12706
12707 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
12708 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
12709
12710 @lisp
12711 (list (locale-definition
12712 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
12713 (charset "EUC-JP")))
12714 @end lisp
12715
12716 @vindex LOCPATH
12717 The compiled locale definitions are available at
12718 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
12719 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
12720 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
12721 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
12722 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
12723
12724 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
12725 locale)} module. Details are given below.
12726
12727 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
12728 This is the data type of a locale definition.
12729
12730 @table @asis
12731
12732 @item @code{name}
12733 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12734 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
12735
12736 @item @code{source}
12737 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
12738 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
12739
12740 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
12741 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
12742 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
12743 IANA}.
12744
12745 @end table
12746 @end deftp
12747
12748 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
12749 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
12750 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
12751 declarations.
12752
12753 @cindex locale name
12754 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
12755 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
12756 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
12757 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
12758 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
12759 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
12760 @end defvr
12761
12762 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
12763
12764 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
12765 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
12766 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
12767 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
12768 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
12769 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
12770 another.
12771
12772 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
12773 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
12774 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
12775 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
12776 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
12777 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
12778 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
12779 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
12780 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
12781 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
12782 programs will not abort.
12783
12784 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
12785 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
12786 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
12787 used to build the system-wide locale data.
12788
12789 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
12790 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
12791 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
12792
12793 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
12794 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
12795 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
12796 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
12797 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
12798 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
12799
12800 @lisp
12801 (use-package-modules base)
12802
12803 (operating-system
12804 ;; @dots{}
12805 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
12806 @end lisp
12807
12808 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
12809 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
12810 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
12811
12812
12813 @node Services
12814 @section Services
12815
12816 @cindex system services
12817 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
12818 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
12819 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
12820 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
12821 configuring network access.
12822
12823 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
12824 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
12825 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
12826 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
12827 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
12828 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
12829
12830 @example
12831 # herd status
12832 @end example
12833
12834 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
12835 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
12836 service and its associated actions:
12837
12838 @example
12839 # herd doc nscd
12840 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
12841
12842 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
12843 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
12844 @end example
12845
12846 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
12847 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
12848 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
12849
12850 @example
12851 # herd stop nscd
12852 Service nscd has been stopped.
12853 # herd restart xorg-server
12854 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
12855 Service xorg-server has been started.
12856 @end example
12857
12858 The following sections document the available services, starting with
12859 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
12860 declaration.
12861
12862 @menu
12863 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
12864 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
12865 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
12866 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
12867 * X Window:: Graphical display.
12868 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
12869 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
12870 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
12871 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
12872 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
12873 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
12874 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
12875 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
12876 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
12877 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
12878 * Web Services:: Web servers.
12879 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
12880 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
12881 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
12882 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
12883 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
12884 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
12885 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
12886 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
12887 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
12888 * Game Services:: Game servers.
12889 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
12890 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
12891 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
12892 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
12893 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
12894 @end menu
12895
12896 @node Base Services
12897 @subsection Base Services
12898
12899 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
12900 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
12901 this module are listed below.
12902
12903 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
12904 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
12905 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
12906 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
12907 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
12908 more.
12909
12910 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
12911 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
12912 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
12913 this:
12914
12915 @lisp
12916 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
12917 (service openssh-service-type))
12918 %base-services)
12919 @end lisp
12920 @end defvr
12921
12922 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
12923 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
12924 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
12925
12926 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
12927 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
12928 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
12929
12930 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
12931 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
12932 @lisp
12933 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
12934 @end lisp
12935
12936 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
12937 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
12938 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
12939 change it to:
12940
12941 @lisp
12942 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
12943 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
12944 @end lisp
12945
12946 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
12947 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
12948 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
12949 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
12950 (see below).
12951 @end defvr
12952
12953 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
12954 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
12955
12956 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
12957 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
12958 symlink:
12959
12960 @lisp
12961 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
12962 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
12963 @end lisp
12964 @end deffn
12965
12966 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
12967 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
12968 @end deffn
12969
12970 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
12971 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
12972 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
12973 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
12974 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
12975
12976 @lisp
12977 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
12978 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
12979 font-tamzen
12980 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
12981 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
12982 font-terminus
12983 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
12984 @end lisp
12985 @end defvr
12986
12987 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
12988 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
12989 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
12990 among other things.
12991 @end deffn
12992
12993 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
12994 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
12995
12996 @table @asis
12997
12998 @item @code{motd}
12999 @cindex message of the day
13000 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
13001
13002 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
13003 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
13004 the 'root' account has just been created.
13005
13006 @end table
13007 @end deftp
13008
13009 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
13010 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
13011 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
13012 other things.
13013 @end deffn
13014
13015 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
13016 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
13017 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
13018
13019 @table @asis
13020
13021 @item @code{tty}
13022 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
13023
13024 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
13025 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
13026 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
13027 user name and password must be entered to log in.
13028
13029 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
13030 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
13031 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
13032 the name of the log-in program.
13033
13034 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
13035 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
13036 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
13037
13038 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
13039 The Mingetty package to use.
13040
13041 @end table
13042 @end deftp
13043
13044 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
13045 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
13046 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
13047 among other things.
13048 @end deffn
13049
13050 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
13051 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
13052 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
13053 man page for more information.
13054
13055 @table @asis
13056
13057 @item @code{tty}
13058 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
13059 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
13060 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
13061
13062 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
13063 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
13064 from it and use that.
13065
13066 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
13067 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
13068 serial port from it and use that.
13069
13070 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
13071 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
13072 correct values.
13073
13074 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
13075 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
13076 descending order.
13077
13078 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
13079 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
13080 variable.
13081
13082 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
13083 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
13084 disabled.
13085
13086 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
13087 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
13088 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
13089
13090 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
13091 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
13092
13093 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
13094 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
13095 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
13096
13097 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
13098 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
13099 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
13100 specified in @var{login-program}.
13101
13102 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
13103 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
13104
13105 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
13106 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
13107 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
13108
13109 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
13110 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
13111 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
13112
13113 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
13114 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
13115 the login prompt.
13116
13117 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
13118 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
13119 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
13120 Shadow tool suite.
13121
13122 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
13123 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
13124 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
13125 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
13126
13127 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
13128 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
13129 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
13130
13131 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13132 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
13133 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
13134 systems.
13135
13136 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
13137 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
13138 @file{/etc/issue} file.
13139
13140 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
13141 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
13142 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
13143 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
13144 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
13145 options that could be parsed by the login program.
13146
13147 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
13148 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
13149 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
13150 lazily spawning shells.
13151
13152 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
13153 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
13154 path as a string.
13155
13156 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
13157 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
13158 specified terminal.
13159
13160 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
13161 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
13162 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
13163 character.
13164
13165 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
13166 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
13167 within @var{timeout} seconds.
13168
13169 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
13170 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
13171 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
13172 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
13173 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
13174 Unicode characters.
13175
13176 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
13177 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
13178 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
13179 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
13180 @var{init-string} option.
13181
13182 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
13183 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
13184 locks.
13185
13186 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
13187 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
13188 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
13189
13190 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
13191 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
13192 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
13193 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
13194
13195 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
13196 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
13197 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
13198
13199 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
13200 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
13201 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
13202 types their login name.
13203
13204 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
13205 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
13206 to before login.
13207
13208 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
13209 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
13210 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
13211
13212 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
13213 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
13214 @command{login} program.
13215
13216 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
13217 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
13218 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
13219
13220 @end table
13221 @end deftp
13222
13223 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
13224 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
13225 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
13226 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
13227 @end deffn
13228
13229 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
13230 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
13231 implements virtual console log-in.
13232
13233 @table @asis
13234
13235 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
13236 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
13237
13238 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
13239 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
13240 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
13241
13242 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
13243 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
13244
13245 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
13246 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
13247 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
13248
13249 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
13250 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
13251
13252 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
13253 The Kmscon package to use.
13254
13255 @end table
13256 @end deftp
13257
13258 @cindex name service cache daemon
13259 @cindex nscd
13260 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
13261 [#:name-services '()]
13262 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
13263 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
13264 Service Switch}, for an example.
13265
13266 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
13267
13268 @table @code
13269 @item invalidate
13270 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
13271 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
13272 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
13273
13274 @example
13275 herd invalidate nscd hosts
13276 @end example
13277
13278 @noindent
13279 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
13280
13281 @item statistics
13282 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
13283 and caches.
13284 @end table
13285
13286 @end deffn
13287
13288 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
13289 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
13290 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
13291 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
13292 @end defvr
13293
13294 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
13295 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
13296 configuration.
13297
13298 @table @asis
13299
13300 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
13301 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
13302 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
13303
13304 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
13305 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
13306 command.
13307
13308 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
13309 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
13310 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
13311
13312 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
13313 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
13314 debugging output is logged.
13315
13316 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
13317 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
13318 below.
13319
13320 @end table
13321 @end deftp
13322
13323 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
13324 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
13325
13326 @table @asis
13327
13328 @item @code{database}
13329 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
13330 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
13331 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
13332 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13333
13334 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
13335 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
13336 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
13337 negative lookup result remains in cache.
13338
13339 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
13340 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
13341 @var{database}.
13342
13343 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
13344 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
13345 them into account.
13346
13347 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
13348 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
13349
13350 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
13351 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
13352
13353 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
13354 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
13355
13356 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
13357 @c settings, so leave them out.
13358
13359 @end table
13360 @end deftp
13361
13362 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
13363 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
13364 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
13365
13366 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
13367 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
13368 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
13369 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
13370 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
13371 @end defvr
13372
13373 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
13374 @cindex syslog
13375 @cindex logging
13376 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
13377 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
13378
13379 @table @asis
13380 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
13381 The syslog daemon to use.
13382
13383 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
13384 The syslog configuration file to use.
13385
13386 @end table
13387 @end deftp
13388
13389 @anchor{syslog-service}
13390 @cindex syslog
13391 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
13392 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
13393
13394 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
13395 information on the configuration file syntax.
13396 @end deffn
13397
13398 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
13399 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
13400 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
13401 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
13402 @end defvr
13403
13404 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
13405 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
13406 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
13407 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
13408
13409 @table @asis
13410 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
13411 The Guix package to use.
13412
13413 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
13414 Name of the group for build user accounts.
13415
13416 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
13417 Number of build user accounts to create.
13418
13419 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
13420 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
13421 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
13422 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
13423 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
13424
13425 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
13426 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
13427 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
13428 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
13429 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
13430
13431 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
13432 Whether to use substitutes.
13433
13434 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
13435 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
13436
13437 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
13438 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
13439 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
13440 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
13441 disables the timeout.
13442
13443 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
13444 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
13445 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
13446
13447 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
13448 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
13449
13450 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
13451 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
13452 are written.
13453
13454 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
13455 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
13456 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
13457 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
13458 derivations and substitutes.
13459
13460 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
13461 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
13462
13463 @example
13464 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
13465 @end example
13466
13467 To clear the proxy settings, run:
13468
13469 @example
13470 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
13471 @end example
13472
13473 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
13474 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
13475
13476 @end table
13477 @end deftp
13478
13479 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
13480 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
13481 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
13482 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
13483 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
13484 creation of such rule files.
13485
13486 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
13487 directory containing all the active udev rules.
13488 @end deffn
13489
13490 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
13491 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
13492 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
13493
13494 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
13495 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
13496 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
13497
13498 @lisp
13499 (define %example-udev-rule
13500 (udev-rule
13501 "90-usb-thing.rules"
13502 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
13503 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
13504 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
13505 @end lisp
13506 @end deffn
13507
13508 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
13509 [#:groups @var{groups}]
13510 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
13511 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
13512 This works by creating a singleton service type
13513 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
13514 instance.
13515
13516 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
13517 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
13518
13519 @lisp
13520 (operating-system
13521 ;; @dots{}
13522 (services
13523 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
13524 %desktop-services)))
13525 @end lisp
13526 @end deffn
13527
13528 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
13529 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
13530 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
13531
13532 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
13533
13534 @lisp
13535 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
13536 (guix packages) ;for origin
13537 @dots{})
13538
13539 (define %android-udev-rules
13540 (file->udev-rule
13541 "51-android-udev.rules"
13542 (let ((version "20170910"))
13543 (origin
13544 (method url-fetch)
13545 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
13546 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
13547 (sha256
13548 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
13549 @end lisp
13550 @end deffn
13551
13552 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
13553 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
13554 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
13555 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
13556 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
13557 packages android)} module.
13558
13559 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
13560 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
13561 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
13562 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
13563 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
13564 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
13565 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
13566 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
13567
13568 @lisp
13569 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
13570 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
13571 @dots{})
13572
13573 (operating-system
13574 ;; @dots{}
13575 (users (cons (user-account
13576 ;; @dots{}
13577 (supplementary-groups
13578 '("adbusers" ;for adb
13579 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
13580 ;; @dots{}
13581 (services
13582 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
13583 #:groups '("adbusers"))
13584 %desktop-services)))
13585 @end lisp
13586
13587 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
13588 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
13589 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
13590 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
13591 readable.
13592 @end defvr
13593
13594 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
13595 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
13596 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
13597 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
13598 @end defvr
13599
13600 @cindex mouse
13601 @cindex gpm
13602 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
13603 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
13604 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
13605 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
13606 and paste text.
13607
13608 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
13609 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
13610 @end defvr
13611
13612 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
13613 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
13614
13615 @table @asis
13616 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
13617 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
13618 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
13619 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
13620 more information.
13621
13622 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
13623 The GPM package to use.
13624
13625 @end table
13626 @end deftp
13627
13628 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
13629 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
13630 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
13631 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
13632 object, as described below.
13633
13634 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
13635 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13636 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
13637 @end deffn
13638
13639 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
13640 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
13641 service.
13642
13643 @table @asis
13644 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
13645 The Guix package to use.
13646
13647 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
13648 The TCP port to listen for connections.
13649
13650 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
13651 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
13652 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
13653
13654 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
13655 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
13656 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
13657 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
13658
13659 @lisp
13660 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
13661 @end lisp
13662
13663 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
13664 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
13665
13666 An empty list disables compression altogether.
13667
13668 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
13669 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
13670 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
13671
13672 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
13673 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
13674 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
13675 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
13676 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
13677 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
13678
13679 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
13680 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
13681 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
13682 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
13683
13684 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
13685 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
13686 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
13687 for more information.
13688 @end table
13689 @end deftp
13690
13691 @anchor{rngd-service}
13692 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
13693 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
13694 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
13695 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
13696 @var{device} does not exist.
13697 @end deffn
13698
13699 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
13700 @cindex session limits
13701 @cindex ulimit
13702 @cindex priority
13703 @cindex realtime
13704 @cindex jackd
13705 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
13706
13707 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
13708 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
13709 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
13710 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
13711 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
13712
13713 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
13714 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
13715
13716 @lisp
13717 (pam-limits-service
13718 (list
13719 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
13720 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
13721 @end lisp
13722
13723 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
13724 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
13725 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
13726 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
13727 @end deffn
13728
13729 @node Scheduled Job Execution
13730 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
13731
13732 @cindex cron
13733 @cindex mcron
13734 @cindex scheduling jobs
13735 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
13736 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
13737 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
13738 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
13739 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
13740 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
13741
13742 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
13743 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
13744 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
13745 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
13746 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
13747 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
13748 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
13749
13750 @lisp
13751 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
13752 (use-package-modules base idutils)
13753
13754 (define updatedb-job
13755 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
13756 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
13757 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
13758 (lambda ()
13759 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
13760 "updatedb"
13761 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
13762
13763 (define garbage-collector-job
13764 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
13765 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
13766 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
13767 "guix gc -F 1G"))
13768
13769 (define idutils-job
13770 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
13771 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
13772 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
13773 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
13774 #:user "charlie"))
13775
13776 (operating-system
13777 ;; @dots{}
13778 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
13779 (mcron-configuration
13780 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
13781 updatedb-job
13782 idutils-job))))
13783 %base-services)))
13784 @end lisp
13785
13786 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
13787 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
13788 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
13789 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
13790 illustrates that.
13791
13792 @lisp
13793 (define %battery-alert-job
13794 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
13795 #~(job
13796 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
13797 #$(program-file
13798 "battery-alert.scm"
13799 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
13800 '((guix build utils)))
13801 #~(begin
13802 (define %min-level 20)
13803 (use-modules (guix build utils)
13804 (ice-9 popen)
13805 (ice-9 regex)
13806 (ice-9 textual-ports)
13807 (srfi srfi-2))
13808 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
13809 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
13810 OPEN_READ
13811 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
13812 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
13813 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
13814 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
13815 ((< level %min-level)))
13816 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
13817 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
13818 @end lisp
13819
13820 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
13821 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
13822 reference of the mcron service.
13823
13824 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
13825 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
13826
13827 @example
13828 # herd schedule mcron
13829 @end example
13830
13831 @noindent
13832 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
13833 also specify the number of tasks to display:
13834
13835 @example
13836 # herd schedule mcron 10
13837 @end example
13838
13839 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
13840 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
13841 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
13842
13843 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
13844 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
13845 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
13846 mcron jobs to run.
13847 @end defvr
13848
13849 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
13850 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
13851
13852 @table @asis
13853 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
13854 The mcron package to use.
13855
13856 @item @code{jobs}
13857 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
13858 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
13859 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
13860 @end table
13861 @end deftp
13862
13863
13864 @node Log Rotation
13865 @subsection Log Rotation
13866
13867 @cindex rottlog
13868 @cindex log rotation
13869 @cindex logging
13870 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
13871 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
13872 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
13873 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
13874 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13875
13876 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
13877 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
13878 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
13879 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
13880 produce log files already take care of that):
13881
13882 @lisp
13883 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
13884 (use-service-modules admin)
13885
13886 (define my-log-files
13887 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
13888 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
13889
13890 (operating-system
13891 ;; @dots{}
13892 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
13893 rottlog-service-type
13894 (list (log-rotation
13895 (frequency 'daily)
13896 (files my-log-files))))
13897 %base-services)))
13898 @end lisp
13899
13900 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
13901 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
13902 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
13903
13904 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
13905 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
13906
13907 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
13908 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
13909 @end defvr
13910
13911 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
13912 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
13913
13914 @table @asis
13915 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
13916 The Rottlog package to use.
13917
13918 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
13919 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
13920 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13921
13922 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
13923 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
13924
13925 @item @code{jobs}
13926 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
13927 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
13928 @end table
13929 @end deftp
13930
13931 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
13932 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
13933
13934 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
13935 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
13936 defined like this:
13937
13938 @lisp
13939 (log-rotation
13940 (frequency 'daily)
13941 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
13942 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
13943 "rotate 6"
13944 "notifempty"
13945 "nocompress")))
13946 @end lisp
13947
13948 The list of fields is as follows:
13949
13950 @table @asis
13951 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
13952 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
13953
13954 @item @code{files}
13955 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
13956
13957 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
13958 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
13959 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
13960
13961 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
13962 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
13963 @end table
13964 @end deftp
13965
13966 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
13967 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
13968 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
13969 @end defvr
13970
13971 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
13972 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
13973 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
13974 "/var/log/maillog")}.
13975 @end defvr
13976
13977 @node Networking Services
13978 @subsection Networking Services
13979
13980 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
13981 the network interface.
13982
13983 @cindex DHCP, networking service
13984 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
13985 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
13986 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
13987 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
13988 @end defvr
13989
13990 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
13991 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
13992 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
13993 For example:
13994
13995 @lisp
13996 (service dhcpd-service-type
13997 (dhcpd-configuration
13998 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
13999 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
14000 @end lisp
14001 @end deffn
14002
14003 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
14004 @table @asis
14005 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
14006 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
14007 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
14008 directory. The default package is the
14009 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
14010 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
14011 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
14012 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
14013 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
14014 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
14015 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
14016 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
14017 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
14018 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
14019 details.
14020 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
14021 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
14022 will be created if it does not exist.
14023 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
14024 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
14025 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
14026 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
14027 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
14028 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
14029 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
14030 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
14031 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
14032 @end table
14033 @end deftp
14034
14035 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
14036 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
14037 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
14038 @end defvr
14039
14040 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
14041 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
14042 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
14043 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
14044 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
14045 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
14046 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
14047 interface.
14048
14049 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
14050 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
14051 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
14052 to handle.
14053
14054 For example:
14055
14056 @lisp
14057 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
14058 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
14059 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
14060 @end lisp
14061 @end deffn
14062
14063 @cindex wicd
14064 @cindex wireless
14065 @cindex WiFi
14066 @cindex network management
14067 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
14068 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
14069 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
14070
14071 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
14072 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
14073 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
14074 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
14075 @end deffn
14076
14077 @cindex ModemManager
14078
14079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
14080 This is the service type for the
14081 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
14082 service. The value for this service type is a
14083 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
14084
14085 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
14086 Services}).
14087 @end defvr
14088
14089 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
14090 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
14091
14092 @table @asis
14093 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
14094 The ModemManager package to use.
14095
14096 @end table
14097 @end deftp
14098
14099 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
14100 @cindex Modeswitching
14101
14102 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
14103 This is the service type for the
14104 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
14105 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
14106
14107 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
14108 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
14109 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
14110 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
14111 plugged in.
14112
14113 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
14114 Services}).
14115 @end defvr
14116
14117 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
14118 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
14119
14120 @table @asis
14121 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
14122 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
14123
14124 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
14125 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
14126 USB_ModeSwitch.
14127
14128 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
14129 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
14130 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
14131 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
14132 file is used.
14133
14134 @end table
14135 @end deftp
14136
14137 @cindex NetworkManager
14138
14139 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
14140 This is the service type for the
14141 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
14142 service. The value for this service type is a
14143 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
14144
14145 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
14146 Services}).
14147 @end defvr
14148
14149 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
14150 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
14151
14152 @table @asis
14153 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
14154 The NetworkManager package to use.
14155
14156 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
14157 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
14158 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
14159
14160 @table @samp
14161 @item default
14162 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
14163 provided by currently active connections.
14164
14165 @item dnsmasq
14166 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
14167 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
14168 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
14169
14170 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
14171 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
14172 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
14173 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
14174 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
14175
14176 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
14177 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
14178 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
14179 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
14180 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
14181 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
14182
14183 @example
14184 nmcli connection add type tun \
14185 connection.interface-name tap0 \
14186 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
14187 ipv4.method shared \
14188 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
14189 @end example
14190
14191 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
14192 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
14193 @command{qemu-system-...}.
14194
14195 @item none
14196 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
14197 @end table
14198
14199 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
14200 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
14201 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
14202 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
14203
14204 @end table
14205 @end deftp
14206
14207 @cindex Connman
14208 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
14209 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
14210 a network connection manager.
14211
14212 Its value must be an
14213 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
14214
14215 @lisp
14216 (service connman-service-type
14217 (connman-configuration
14218 (disable-vpn? #t)))
14219 @end lisp
14220
14221 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
14222 @end deffn
14223
14224 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
14225 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
14226
14227 @table @asis
14228 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
14229 The connman package to use.
14230
14231 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
14232 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
14233 @end table
14234 @end deftp
14235
14236 @cindex WPA Supplicant
14237 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
14238 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
14239 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
14240 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
14241 @end defvr
14242
14243 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
14244 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
14245
14246 It takes the following parameters:
14247
14248 @table @asis
14249 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
14250 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
14251
14252 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes dbus-system loopback syslogd)}
14253 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
14254
14255 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
14256 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
14257
14258 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
14259 Where to store the PID file.
14260
14261 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
14262 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
14263 WPA supplicant will control.
14264
14265 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
14266 Optional configuration file to use.
14267
14268 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
14269 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
14270 @end table
14271 @end deftp
14272
14273 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
14274 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
14275 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
14276 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
14277 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
14278 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
14279 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
14280
14281 @lisp
14282 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
14283 (service hostapd-service-type
14284 (hostapd-configuration
14285 (interface "wlan1")
14286 (ssid "My Network")
14287 (channel 12)))
14288 @end lisp
14289 @end defvr
14290
14291 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
14292 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
14293 the following fields:
14294
14295 @table @asis
14296 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
14297 The hostapd package to use.
14298
14299 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
14300 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
14301
14302 @item @code{ssid}
14303 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
14304 network.
14305
14306 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
14307 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
14308
14309 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
14310 The WiFi channel to use.
14311
14312 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
14313 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
14314 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
14315 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
14316
14317 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
14318 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
14319 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
14320 configuration file reference.
14321 @end table
14322 @end deftp
14323
14324 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
14325 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
14326 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
14327 Linux kernel
14328 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
14329 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
14330 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
14331
14332 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
14333 @end defvr
14334
14335 @cindex iptables
14336 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
14337 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
14338 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
14339 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
14340 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
14341 22 is shown below.
14342
14343 @lisp
14344 (service iptables-service-type
14345 (iptables-configuration
14346 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
14347 :INPUT ACCEPT
14348 :FORWARD ACCEPT
14349 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
14350 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
14351 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
14352 COMMIT
14353 "))
14354 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
14355 :INPUT ACCEPT
14356 :FORWARD ACCEPT
14357 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
14358 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
14359 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
14360 COMMIT
14361 "))))
14362 @end lisp
14363 @end defvr
14364
14365 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
14366 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
14367
14368 @table @asis
14369 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
14370 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
14371 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
14372 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
14373 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
14374 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
14375 objects}).
14376 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
14377 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
14378 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
14379 objects}).
14380 @end table
14381 @end deftp
14382
14383 @cindex nftables
14384 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
14385 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
14386 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
14387 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
14388 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
14389 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
14390 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
14391 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
14392
14393 @lisp
14394 (service nftables-service-type)
14395 @end lisp
14396 @end defvr
14397
14398 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
14399 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
14400
14401 @table @asis
14402 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
14403 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
14404 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
14405 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
14406 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
14407 @end table
14408 @end deftp
14409
14410 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
14411 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
14412 @cindex real time clock
14413 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
14414 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
14415 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
14416 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
14417
14418 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
14419 below.
14420 @end defvr
14421
14422 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
14423 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
14424
14425 @table @asis
14426 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
14427 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
14428 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
14429 definition below.
14430
14431 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
14432 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
14433 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
14434
14435 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
14436 The NTP package to use.
14437 @end table
14438 @end deftp
14439
14440 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
14441 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
14442 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
14443 @end defvr
14444
14445 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
14446 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
14447
14448 @table @asis
14449 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
14450 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
14451 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
14452
14453 @item @code{address}
14454 The address of the server, as a string.
14455
14456 @item @code{options}
14457 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
14458 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
14459 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
14460 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
14461
14462 @example
14463 (ntp-server
14464 (type 'server)
14465 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
14466 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
14467 @end example
14468 @end table
14469 @end deftp
14470
14471 @cindex OpenNTPD
14472 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
14473 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
14474 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
14475 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
14476
14477 @lisp
14478 (service
14479 openntpd-service-type
14480 (openntpd-configuration
14481 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
14482 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
14483 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
14484 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
14485 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
14486
14487 @end lisp
14488 @end deffn
14489
14490 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
14491 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
14492 @code{%ntp-servers}.
14493 @end defvr
14494
14495 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
14496 @table @asis
14497 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
14498 The openntpd executable to use.
14499 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
14500 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
14501 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
14502 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
14503 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
14504 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
14505 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
14506 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
14507 information.
14508 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
14509 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
14510 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
14511 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
14512 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
14513 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
14514 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
14515 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
14516 man-in-the-middle attacks.
14517 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
14518 a constraint.
14519 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
14520 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
14521 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
14522 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
14523 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
14524 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
14525 than 180 seconds.
14526 @end table
14527 @end deftp
14528
14529 @cindex inetd
14530 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
14531 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
14532 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
14533 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
14534 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
14535
14536 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
14537 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
14538 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
14539 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
14540 gateway @code{hostname}:
14541
14542 @lisp
14543 (service
14544 inetd-service-type
14545 (inetd-configuration
14546 (entries (list
14547 (inetd-entry
14548 (name "echo")
14549 (socket-type 'stream)
14550 (protocol "tcp")
14551 (wait? #f)
14552 (user "root"))
14553 (inetd-entry
14554 (node "127.0.0.1")
14555 (name "smtp")
14556 (socket-type 'stream)
14557 (protocol "tcp")
14558 (wait? #f)
14559 (user "root")
14560 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
14561 (arguments
14562 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
14563 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
14564 @end lisp
14565
14566 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
14567 @end deffn
14568
14569 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
14570 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
14571
14572 @table @asis
14573 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
14574 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
14575
14576 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
14577 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
14578 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
14579 @end table
14580 @end deftp
14581
14582 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
14583 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
14584 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
14585 requests.
14586
14587 @table @asis
14588 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
14589 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
14590 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
14591 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
14592 description of all options.
14593 @item @code{name}
14594 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
14595 @item @code{socket-type}
14596 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
14597 @code{'seqpacket}.
14598 @item @code{protocol}
14599 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
14600 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
14601 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
14602 listening to new service requests.
14603 @item @code{user}
14604 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
14605 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
14606 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
14607 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
14608 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
14609 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
14610 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
14611 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
14612 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
14613 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
14614 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
14615 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
14616 @end table
14617
14618 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
14619 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
14620 @end deftp
14621
14622 @cindex Tor
14623 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
14624 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
14625 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
14626 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
14627 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
14628
14629 @end defvr
14630
14631 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
14632 @table @asis
14633 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
14634 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
14635 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
14636 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
14637 implementation.
14638
14639 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
14640 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
14641 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
14642 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
14643 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
14644 syntax.
14645
14646 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
14647 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
14648 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
14649 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
14650 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
14651 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
14652
14653 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
14654 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
14655 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
14656 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
14657 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
14658 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
14659 @code{tor} group.
14660
14661 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
14662 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
14663 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
14664 @code{SocksPort} option.
14665 @end table
14666 @end deftp
14667
14668 @cindex hidden service
14669 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
14670 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
14671 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
14672
14673 @example
14674 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
14675 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
14676 @end example
14677
14678 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
14679 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
14680
14681 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
14682 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
14683 service.
14684
14685 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
14686 project's documentation} for more information.
14687 @end deffn
14688
14689 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
14690
14691 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
14692 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
14693 files.
14694
14695 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
14696 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
14697 The value for this service type is a
14698 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
14699
14700 @lisp
14701 (service rsync-service-type)
14702 @end lisp
14703
14704 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
14705 @end deffn
14706
14707 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
14708 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
14709
14710 @table @asis
14711 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
14712 @code{rsync} package to use.
14713
14714 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
14715 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
14716 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
14717 @code{root} user and group.
14718
14719 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
14720 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
14721
14722 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
14723 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
14724
14725 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
14726 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
14727
14728 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
14729 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
14730
14731 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
14732 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
14733
14734 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
14735 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
14736
14737 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
14738 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
14739
14740 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
14741 I/O timeout in seconds.
14742
14743 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
14744 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
14745
14746 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
14747 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
14748
14749 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
14750 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
14751 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
14752
14753 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
14754 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
14755
14756 @end table
14757 @end deftp
14758
14759 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
14760 @cindex SSH
14761 @cindex SSH server
14762
14763 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
14764 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
14765 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
14766 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
14767 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
14768 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
14769 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
14770 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
14771 only by root.
14772
14773 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
14774 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
14775 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
14776 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
14777 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
14778
14779 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
14780 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
14781 require interaction.
14782
14783 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
14784 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
14785 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
14786 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
14787
14788 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
14789 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
14790 or addresses.
14791
14792 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
14793 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
14794 root.
14795
14796 The other options should be self-descriptive.
14797 @end deffn
14798
14799 @cindex SSH
14800 @cindex SSH server
14801 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
14802 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
14803 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
14804 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
14805
14806 @lisp
14807 (service openssh-service-type
14808 (openssh-configuration
14809 (x11-forwarding? #t)
14810 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
14811 (authorized-keys
14812 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
14813 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
14814 @end lisp
14815
14816 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
14817
14818 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
14819 example:
14820
14821 @lisp
14822 (service-extension openssh-service-type
14823 (const `(("charlie"
14824 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
14825 @end lisp
14826 @end deffn
14827
14828 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
14829 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
14830
14831 @table @asis
14832 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
14833 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
14834
14835 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
14836 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
14837
14838 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
14839 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
14840 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
14841 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
14842 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
14843
14844 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
14845 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
14846 not.
14847
14848 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14849 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
14850 other authentication methods.
14851
14852 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14853 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
14854 false, users have to use other authentication method.
14855
14856 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
14857 This is used only by protocol version 2.
14858
14859 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
14860 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
14861 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
14862 @option{-Y} will work.
14863
14864 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
14865 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
14866
14867 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
14868 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
14869
14870 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
14871 Whether to allow gateway ports.
14872
14873 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
14874 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
14875 PAM).
14876
14877 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
14878 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
14879 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
14880 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
14881 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
14882 module processing for all authentication types.
14883
14884 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
14885 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
14886 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
14887 @code{password-authentication?}.
14888
14889 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
14890 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
14891 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
14892
14893 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
14894 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
14895
14896 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
14897 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
14898 subsystem request.
14899
14900 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
14901 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
14902 @lisp
14903 (service openssh-service-type
14904 (openssh-configuration
14905 (subsystems
14906 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
14907 @end lisp
14908
14909 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
14910 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
14911
14912 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
14913 @code{man sshd_config}.
14914
14915 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
14916 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
14917 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
14918 if this variable is set.
14919
14920 @lisp
14921 (service openssh-service-type
14922 (openssh-configuration
14923 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
14924 @end lisp
14925
14926 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
14927 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
14928 @cindex SSH authorized keys
14929 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
14930 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
14931 keys. For example:
14932
14933 @lisp
14934 (openssh-configuration
14935 (authorized-keys
14936 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
14937 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
14938 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
14939 @end lisp
14940
14941 @noindent
14942 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
14943 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
14944
14945 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
14946 @code{service-extension}.
14947
14948 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
14949 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
14950
14951 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
14952 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
14953 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
14954 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
14955
14956 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
14957 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
14958 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
14959 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
14960 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
14961
14962 @lisp
14963 (openssh-configuration
14964 (extra-content "\
14965 Match Address 192.168.0.1
14966 PermitRootLogin yes"))
14967 @end lisp
14968
14969 @end table
14970 @end deftp
14971
14972 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
14973 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
14974 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
14975 object.
14976
14977 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
14978 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
14979
14980 @lisp
14981 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
14982 (port-number 1234)))
14983 @end lisp
14984 @end deffn
14985
14986 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
14987 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
14988
14989 @table @asis
14990 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
14991 The Dropbear package to use.
14992
14993 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
14994 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
14995
14996 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
14997 Whether to enable syslog output.
14998
14999 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
15000 File name of the daemon's PID file.
15001
15002 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15003 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
15004
15005 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
15006 Whether to allow empty passwords.
15007
15008 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
15009 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
15010 @end table
15011 @end deftp
15012
15013 @cindex AutoSSH
15014 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
15015 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
15016 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
15017 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
15018 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
15019 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
15020 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
15021 here.
15022
15023 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
15024 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
15025 is run as.
15026
15027 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
15028 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
15029 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
15030 system's @code{services} field:
15031
15032 @lisp
15033 (service autossh-service-type
15034 (autossh-configuration
15035 (user "pino")
15036 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
15037 @end lisp
15038 @end deffn
15039
15040 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
15041 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
15042
15043 @table @asis
15044
15045 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
15046 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
15047 This assumes that the specified user exists.
15048
15049 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
15050 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
15051
15052 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
15053 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
15054 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
15055 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
15056 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
15057 @code{poll}.
15058
15059 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
15060 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
15061 considered successful.
15062
15063 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
15064 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
15065 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
15066
15067 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
15068 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
15069 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
15070
15071 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
15072 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
15073
15074 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
15075 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
15076 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
15077 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
15078 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
15079 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
15080 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
15081 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for monitoring the
15082 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
15083 @var{m} is the echo port.
15084
15085 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
15086 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
15087 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
15088 may cause undefined behaviour.
15089
15090 @end table
15091 @end deftp
15092
15093 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
15094 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
15095 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
15096 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
15097 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
15098 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
15099
15100 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
15101 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
15102 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
15103
15104 @lisp
15105 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
15106
15107 (operating-system
15108 (host-name "mymachine")
15109 ;; ...
15110 (hosts-file
15111 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
15112 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
15113 (plain-file "hosts"
15114 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
15115 %facebook-host-aliases))))
15116 @end lisp
15117
15118 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
15119 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
15120 @end defvr
15121
15122 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
15123
15124 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
15125 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
15126 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
15127 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
15128 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
15129
15130 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
15131 resolve @code{.local} host names using
15132 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
15133 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
15134
15135 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
15136 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
15137 @end defvr
15138
15139 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
15140 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
15141
15142 @table @asis
15143
15144 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
15145 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
15146 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
15147
15148 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
15149 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
15150 network.
15151
15152 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
15153 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
15154 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
15155 your local network, you can run:
15156
15157 @example
15158 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
15159 @end example
15160
15161 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
15162 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
15163
15164 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
15165 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
15166 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
15167
15168 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
15169 This is a list of domains to browse.
15170 @end table
15171 @end deftp
15172
15173 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
15174 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
15175 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
15176 object.
15177 @end deffn
15178
15179 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
15180 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
15181 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
15182 through programmatic extension.
15183
15184 @table @asis
15185 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
15186 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
15187
15188 @end table
15189 @end deftp
15190
15191 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
15192 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
15193 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
15194 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
15195 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
15196
15197 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
15198
15199 @lisp
15200 (service pagekite-service-type
15201 (pagekite-configuration
15202 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
15203 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
15204 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
15205 @end lisp
15206 @end defvr
15207
15208 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
15209 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
15210
15211 @table @asis
15212 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
15213 Package object of PageKite.
15214
15215 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
15216 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
15217
15218 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
15219 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
15220 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
15221
15222 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
15223 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
15224 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
15225
15226 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
15227 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
15228 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
15229
15230 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
15231 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
15232 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
15233
15234 @end table
15235 @end deftp
15236
15237 @node X Window
15238 @subsection X Window
15239
15240 @cindex X11
15241 @cindex X Window System
15242 @cindex login manager
15243 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
15244 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
15245 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
15246 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
15247
15248 @cindex GDM
15249 @cindex GNOME, login manager
15250 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
15251 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
15252 features such as automatic screen locking.
15253
15254 @cindex window manager
15255 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
15256 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
15257 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
15258 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
15259
15260 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
15261 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
15262 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
15263 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
15264 (see below).
15265
15266 @cindex session types (X11)
15267 @cindex X11 session types
15268 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
15269 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
15270 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
15271 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
15272 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
15273
15274 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
15275 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
15276 and/or other X clients.
15277 @end defvr
15278
15279 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
15280 @table @asis
15281 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15282 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
15283 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
15284
15285 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
15286 @code{default-user}.
15287
15288 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
15289 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
15290
15291 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
15292 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
15293
15294 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
15295 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
15296
15297 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
15298 Script to run before starting a X session.
15299
15300 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
15301 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
15302
15303 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
15304 The GDM package to use.
15305 @end table
15306 @end deftp
15307
15308 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
15309 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
15310
15311 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
15312 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
15313 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
15314
15315 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
15316 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
15317 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
15318 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
15319 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
15320 and tty8.
15321
15322 @lisp
15323 (use-modules (gnu services)
15324 (gnu services desktop)
15325 (gnu services xorg)
15326 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
15327
15328 (operating-system
15329 ;; ...
15330 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
15331 (display ":0")
15332 (vt "vt7")))
15333 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
15334 (display ":1")
15335 (vt "vt8")))
15336 (remove (lambda (service)
15337 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
15338 %desktop-services))))
15339 @end lisp
15340
15341 @end defvr
15342
15343 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
15344 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
15345
15346 @table @asis
15347 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
15348 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
15349
15350 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15351 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
15352 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
15353
15354 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
15355 @code{default-user}.
15356
15357 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
15358 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
15359 The graphical theme to use and its name.
15360
15361 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
15362 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
15363 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
15364
15365 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
15366 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
15367 will be used.
15368
15369 @quotation Note
15370 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
15371 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
15372 false, you will be unable to log in.
15373 @end quotation
15374
15375 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
15376 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
15377
15378 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
15379 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
15380
15381 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
15382 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
15383
15384 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
15385 The XAuth package to use.
15386
15387 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
15388 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
15389 @command{reboot}.
15390
15391 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
15392 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
15393
15394 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
15395 The SLiM package to use.
15396 @end table
15397 @end deftp
15398
15399 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
15400 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
15401 The default SLiM theme and its name.
15402 @end defvr
15403
15404
15405 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
15406 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
15407
15408 @table @asis
15409 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
15410 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
15411 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
15412
15413 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
15414 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
15415
15416 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
15417 Command to run when halting.
15418
15419 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
15420 Command to run when rebooting.
15421
15422 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
15423 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
15424 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
15425
15426 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
15427 Directory to look for themes.
15428
15429 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
15430 Directory to look for faces.
15431
15432 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
15433 Default PATH to use.
15434
15435 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
15436 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
15437
15438 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
15439 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
15440
15441 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
15442 Remember last user.
15443
15444 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
15445 Remember last session.
15446
15447 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
15448 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
15449
15450 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
15451 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
15452
15453 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
15454 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
15455
15456 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
15457 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
15458
15459 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
15460 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
15461
15462 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
15463 Path to xauth.
15464
15465 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
15466 Path to Xephyr.
15467
15468 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
15469 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
15470
15471 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
15472 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
15473
15474 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
15475 Script to run before starting a X session.
15476
15477 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
15478 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
15479
15480 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
15481 Minimum VT to use.
15482
15483 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
15484 User to use for auto-login.
15485
15486 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
15487 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
15488
15489 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
15490 Relogin after logout.
15491
15492 @end table
15493 @end deftp
15494
15495 @cindex login manager
15496 @cindex X11 login
15497 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
15498 This is the type of the service to run the
15499 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
15500 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
15501
15502 Here's an example use:
15503
15504 @lisp
15505 (service sddm-service-type
15506 (sddm-configuration
15507 (auto-login-user "alice")
15508 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
15509 @end lisp
15510 @end defvr
15511
15512 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
15513 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
15514 The available fields are:
15515
15516 @table @asis
15517 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
15518 The SDDM package to use.
15519
15520 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
15521 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
15522
15523 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
15524
15525 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
15526 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
15527 automatically.
15528
15529 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
15530 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
15531 auto-login session.
15532 @end table
15533 @end deftp
15534
15535 @cindex Xorg, configuration
15536 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
15537 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
15538 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
15539 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
15540 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
15541
15542 @table @asis
15543 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
15544 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
15545 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
15546
15547 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
15548 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
15549
15550 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
15551 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
15552 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
15553 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
15554
15555 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
15556 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
15557 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
15558 768) (640 480))}.
15559
15560 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
15561 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
15562 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
15563 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
15564 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
15565
15566 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
15567 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
15568 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
15569
15570 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
15571 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
15572 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
15573
15574 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
15575 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
15576
15577 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
15578 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
15579 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
15580 @end table
15581 @end deftp
15582
15583 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
15584 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
15585 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
15586 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
15587
15588 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
15589 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
15590 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
15591 @end deffn
15592
15593 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
15594 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
15595 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
15596 @code{startx}.
15597
15598 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
15599 @end deffn
15600
15601
15602 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
15603 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
15604 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
15605 for it. For example:
15606
15607 @lisp
15608 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
15609 @end lisp
15610
15611 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
15612 @end deffn
15613
15614
15615 @node Printing Services
15616 @subsection Printing Services
15617
15618 @cindex printer support with CUPS
15619 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
15620 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
15621 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
15622
15623 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
15624 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
15625 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
15626 write:
15627 @lisp
15628 (service cups-service-type)
15629 @end lisp
15630 @end deffn
15631
15632 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
15633 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
15634 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
15635 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
15636 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
15637 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
15638 secure connections to the print server.
15639
15640 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
15641 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
15642 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
15643 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
15644
15645 @lisp
15646 (service cups-service-type
15647 (cups-configuration
15648 (web-interface? #t)
15649 (extensions
15650 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
15651 @end lisp
15652
15653 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
15654 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
15655 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
15656
15657 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
15658 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
15659 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
15660 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
15661 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
15662 from some other system; see the end for more details.
15663
15664 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
15665 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
15666 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
15667 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
15668 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
15669 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
15670 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
15671
15672
15673 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
15674
15675 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
15676 The CUPS package.
15677 @end deftypevr
15678
15679 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
15680 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
15681 @end deftypevr
15682
15683 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
15684 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
15685 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
15686
15687 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
15688
15689 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
15690 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
15691 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
15692 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
15693 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
15694 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
15695 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
15696 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
15697
15698 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
15699 @end deftypevr
15700
15701 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
15702 Where CUPS should cache data.
15703
15704 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
15705 @end deftypevr
15706
15707 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
15708 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
15709 writes.
15710
15711 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
15712 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
15713 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
15714 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
15715 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
15716
15717 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
15718 @end deftypevr
15719
15720 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
15721 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
15722 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
15723 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
15724 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
15725 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
15726 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
15727 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
15728
15729 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
15730 @end deftypevr
15731
15732 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
15733 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
15734 kind strings are:
15735
15736 @table @code
15737 @item none
15738 No errors are fatal.
15739
15740 @item all
15741 All of the errors below are fatal.
15742
15743 @item browse
15744 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
15745 to the DNS-SD daemon.
15746
15747 @item config
15748 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
15749
15750 @item listen
15751 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
15752 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
15753
15754 @item log
15755 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
15756
15757 @item permissions
15758 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
15759 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
15760 @end table
15761
15762 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
15763 @end deftypevr
15764
15765 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
15766 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
15767 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
15768
15769 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15770 @end deftypevr
15771
15772 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
15773 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
15774 programs.
15775
15776 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
15777 @end deftypevr
15778
15779 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
15780 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
15781
15782 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
15783 @end deftypevr
15784
15785 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
15786 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
15787 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
15788 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
15789 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
15790 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
15791 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
15792 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
15793
15794 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
15795 @end deftypevr
15796
15797 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
15798 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
15799 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
15800
15801 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
15802 @end deftypevr
15803
15804 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
15805 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
15806 data.
15807
15808 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
15809 @end deftypevr
15810
15811 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
15812 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
15813 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
15814 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
15815 used/supported on macOS.
15816
15817 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
15818 @end deftypevr
15819
15820 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
15821 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
15822 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
15823 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
15824 PEM-encoded private keys.
15825
15826 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
15827 @end deftypevr
15828
15829 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
15830 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
15831
15832 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
15833 @end deftypevr
15834
15835 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
15836 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
15837 configuration or state files.
15838
15839 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15840 @end deftypevr
15841
15842 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
15843 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
15844 @end deftypevr
15845
15846 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
15847 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
15848
15849 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
15850 @end deftypevr
15851
15852 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
15853 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
15854 programs.
15855
15856 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
15857 @end deftypevr
15858
15859 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
15860 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
15861
15862 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
15863 @end deftypevr
15864 @end deftypevr
15865
15866 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
15867 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
15868 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
15869 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
15870 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
15871 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
15872 level logs all requests.
15873
15874 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
15875 @end deftypevr
15876
15877 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
15878 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
15879 longer required for quotas.
15880
15881 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15882 @end deftypevr
15883
15884 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
15885 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
15886 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
15887 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
15888
15889 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
15890 @end deftypevr
15891
15892 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
15893 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
15894
15895 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
15896 @end deftypevr
15897
15898 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
15899 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
15900
15901 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15902 @end deftypevr
15903
15904 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
15905 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
15906
15907 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15908 @end deftypevr
15909
15910 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
15911 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
15912 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
15913 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
15914 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
15915
15916 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15917 @end deftypevr
15918
15919 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
15920 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
15921 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
15922
15923 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15924 @end deftypevr
15925
15926 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
15927 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
15928
15929 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
15930 @end deftypevr
15931
15932 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
15933 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
15934
15935 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
15936 @end deftypevr
15937
15938 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
15939 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
15940
15941 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
15942 @end deftypevr
15943
15944 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
15945 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
15946 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
15947 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
15948 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
15949
15950 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
15951 @end deftypevr
15952
15953 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
15954 Specifies the default access policy to use.
15955
15956 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
15957 @end deftypevr
15958
15959 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
15960 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
15961
15962 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15963 @end deftypevr
15964
15965 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
15966 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
15967 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
15968 typically within a few milliseconds.
15969
15970 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15971 @end deftypevr
15972
15973 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
15974 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
15975 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
15976 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
15977 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
15978 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
15979
15980 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
15981 @end deftypevr
15982
15983 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
15984 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
15985 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
15986 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
15987 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
15988 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
15989 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
15990 at any time.
15991
15992 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15993 @end deftypevr
15994
15995 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
15996 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
15997 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
15998 lowest priority.
15999
16000 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16001 @end deftypevr
16002
16003 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
16004 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
16005 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
16006 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
16007 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
16008 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
16009 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
16010
16011 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16012 @end deftypevr
16013
16014 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
16015 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
16016 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
16017
16018 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16019 @end deftypevr
16020
16021 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
16022 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
16023 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
16024 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
16025 @code{retry-current-job}.
16026
16027 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16028 @end deftypevr
16029
16030 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
16031 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
16032 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
16033 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
16034 @code{retry-current-job}.
16035
16036 Defaults to @samp{5}.
16037 @end deftypevr
16038
16039 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
16040 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
16041
16042 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16043 @end deftypevr
16044
16045 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
16046 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
16047
16048 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16049 @end deftypevr
16050
16051 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
16052 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
16053 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
16054
16055 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16056 @end deftypevr
16057
16058 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
16059 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
16060 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
16061 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
16062 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
16063 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
16064 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
16065 @end deftypevr
16066
16067 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
16068 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
16069 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
16070 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
16071 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
16072 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
16073 ones.
16074
16075 Defaults to @samp{128}.
16076 @end deftypevr
16077
16078 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
16079 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
16080
16081 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
16082
16083 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
16084 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
16085 @end deftypevr
16086
16087 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
16088 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
16089 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
16090
16091 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16092 @end deftypevr
16093
16094 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
16095 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
16096
16097 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16098
16099 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
16100
16101 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
16102 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
16103 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
16104
16105 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16106 @end deftypevr
16107
16108 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
16109 Methods to which this access control applies.
16110
16111 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16112 @end deftypevr
16113
16114 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
16115 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
16116 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
16117
16118 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16119 @end deftypevr
16120 @end deftypevr
16121 @end deftypevr
16122
16123 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
16124 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
16125 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
16126 of the LogLevel setting.
16127
16128 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16129 @end deftypevr
16130
16131 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
16132 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
16133 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
16134
16135 Defaults to @samp{info}.
16136 @end deftypevr
16137
16138 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
16139 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
16140 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
16141
16142 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
16143 @end deftypevr
16144
16145 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
16146 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
16147 the scheduler.
16148
16149 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16150 @end deftypevr
16151
16152 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
16153 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
16154 from a single address.
16155
16156 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16157 @end deftypevr
16158
16159 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
16160 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
16161 job.
16162
16163 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
16164 @end deftypevr
16165
16166 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
16167 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
16168 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
16169 held jobs.
16170
16171 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16172 @end deftypevr
16173
16174 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
16175 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
16176 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
16177
16178 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16179 @end deftypevr
16180
16181 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
16182 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
16183 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
16184
16185 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16186 @end deftypevr
16187
16188 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
16189 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
16190 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
16191
16192 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16193 @end deftypevr
16194
16195 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
16196 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
16197 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
16198
16199 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
16200 @end deftypevr
16201
16202 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
16203 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
16204 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
16205
16206 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
16207 @end deftypevr
16208
16209 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
16210 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
16211 multiple file print job, in seconds.
16212
16213 Defaults to @samp{300}.
16214 @end deftypevr
16215
16216 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
16217 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
16218 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
16219 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
16220 sequences are recognized:
16221
16222 @table @samp
16223 @item %%
16224 insert a single percent character
16225
16226 @item %@{name@}
16227 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
16228
16229 @item %C
16230 insert the number of copies for the current page
16231
16232 @item %P
16233 insert the current page number
16234
16235 @item %T
16236 insert the current date and time in common log format
16237
16238 @item %j
16239 insert the job ID
16240
16241 @item %p
16242 insert the printer name
16243
16244 @item %u
16245 insert the username
16246 @end table
16247
16248 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
16249 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
16250 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
16251 standard items.
16252
16253 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16254 @end deftypevr
16255
16256 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
16257 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
16258 of strings.
16259
16260 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16261 @end deftypevr
16262
16263 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
16264 Specifies named access control policies.
16265
16266 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
16267
16268 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
16269 Name of the policy.
16270 @end deftypevr
16271
16272 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
16273 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
16274 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
16275 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
16276 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
16277 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
16278 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
16279 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
16280 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
16281 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
16282
16283 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
16284 @end deftypevr
16285
16286 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
16287 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
16288 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
16289
16290 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
16291 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
16292 @end deftypevr
16293
16294 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
16295 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
16296 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
16297 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
16298 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
16299 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
16300 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
16301 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
16302 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
16303 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
16304
16305 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
16306 @end deftypevr
16307
16308 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
16309 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
16310 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
16311
16312 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
16313 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
16314 @end deftypevr
16315
16316 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
16317 Access control by IPP operation.
16318
16319 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16320 @end deftypevr
16321 @end deftypevr
16322
16323 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
16324 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
16325 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
16326 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
16327 value applies indefinitely.
16328
16329 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
16330 @end deftypevr
16331
16332 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
16333 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
16334 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
16335 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
16336 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
16337
16338 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16339 @end deftypevr
16340
16341 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
16342 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
16343 restarting the scheduler.
16344
16345 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16346 @end deftypevr
16347
16348 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
16349 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
16350 into bitmaps for a printer.
16351
16352 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
16353 @end deftypevr
16354
16355 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
16356 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
16357
16358 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
16359 @end deftypevr
16360
16361 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
16362 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
16363 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
16364 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
16365 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
16366 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
16367 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
16368 @code{*}.
16369
16370 Defaults to @samp{*}.
16371 @end deftypevr
16372
16373 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
16374 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
16375
16376 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
16377 @end deftypevr
16378
16379 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
16380 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
16381 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
16382 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
16383 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
16384 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
16385 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
16386 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
16387
16388 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
16389 @end deftypevr
16390
16391 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
16392 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
16393 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
16394 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
16395 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
16396
16397 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16398 @end deftypevr
16399
16400 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
16401 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
16402 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
16403 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
16404 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
16405 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
16406 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
16407 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
16408 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
16409 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
16410
16411 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16412 @end deftypevr
16413
16414 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
16415 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
16416 the IPP specifications.
16417
16418 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16419 @end deftypevr
16420
16421 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
16422 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
16423
16424 Defaults to @samp{300}.
16425
16426 @end deftypevr
16427
16428 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
16429 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
16430
16431 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16432 @end deftypevr
16433
16434 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
16435 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
16436 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
16437 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
16438 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
16439 @code{cups-service-type}.
16440
16441 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
16442
16443 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
16444 The CUPS package.
16445 @end deftypevr
16446
16447 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
16448 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
16449 @end deftypevr
16450
16451 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
16452 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
16453 @end deftypevr
16454
16455 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
16456 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
16457 this:
16458
16459 @lisp
16460 (service cups-service-type
16461 (opaque-cups-configuration
16462 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
16463 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
16464 @end lisp
16465
16466
16467 @node Desktop Services
16468 @subsection Desktop Services
16469
16470 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
16471 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
16472 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
16473 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
16474 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
16475
16476 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
16477 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
16478 environment and networking:
16479
16480 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
16481 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
16482 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
16483
16484 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
16485 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
16486 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
16487 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
16488 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
16489 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
16490 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
16491 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
16492 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
16493 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
16494 @end defvr
16495
16496 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
16497 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
16498 Reference, @code{services}}).
16499
16500 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
16501 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
16502 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
16503 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
16504 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
16505 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
16506 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
16507 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
16508 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
16509 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
16510 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
16511 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
16512 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
16513 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
16514 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
16515 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
16516 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
16517 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
16518 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
16519 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
16520 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
16521 functionality to work as expected.
16522
16523 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
16524 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
16525 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
16526 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
16527 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
16528 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
16529 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
16530 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
16531
16532 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
16533 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
16534 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
16535 object (see below).
16536
16537 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
16538 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
16539 @end defvr
16540
16541 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
16542 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
16543
16544 @table @asis
16545 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
16546 The GNOME package to use.
16547 @end table
16548 @end deftp
16549
16550 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
16551 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
16552 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
16553 (see below).
16554
16555 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
16556 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
16557 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
16558 with the administrator's password.
16559 @end defvr
16560
16561 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
16562 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
16563
16564 @table @asis
16565 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
16566 The Xfce package to use.
16567 @end table
16568 @end deftp
16569
16570 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
16571 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
16572 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
16573 object (see below).
16574
16575 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
16576 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
16577 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
16578 @end deffn
16579
16580 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
16581 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
16582
16583 @table @asis
16584 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
16585 The MATE package to use.
16586 @end table
16587 @end deftp
16588
16589 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
16590 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
16591 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
16592 @end deffn
16593
16594 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
16595 @table @asis
16596 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
16597 The enlightenment package to use.
16598 @end table
16599 @end deftp
16600
16601 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
16602 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
16603 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
16604 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
16605 @code{operating-system}:
16606
16607 @lisp
16608 (use-modules (gnu))
16609 (use-service-modules desktop)
16610 (operating-system
16611 ...
16612 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
16613 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
16614 (service xfce-desktop-service)
16615 %desktop-services))
16616 ...)
16617 @end lisp
16618
16619 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
16620 graphical login window.
16621
16622 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
16623 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
16624 are described below.
16625
16626 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
16627 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
16628 support for @var{services}.
16629
16630 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
16631 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
16632 and to be notified of system-wide events.
16633
16634 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
16635 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
16636 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
16637 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
16638 @end deffn
16639
16640 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
16641 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
16642 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
16643 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
16644 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
16645 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
16646
16647 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
16648 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
16649 when the power button is pressed.
16650
16651 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
16652 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
16653 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
16654 their default values are:
16655
16656 @table @code
16657 @item kill-user-processes?
16658 @code{#f}
16659 @item kill-only-users
16660 @code{()}
16661 @item kill-exclude-users
16662 @code{("root")}
16663 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
16664 @code{5}
16665 @item handle-power-key
16666 @code{poweroff}
16667 @item handle-suspend-key
16668 @code{suspend}
16669 @item handle-hibernate-key
16670 @code{hibernate}
16671 @item handle-lid-switch
16672 @code{suspend}
16673 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
16674 @code{ignore}
16675 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
16676 @code{#f}
16677 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
16678 @code{#f}
16679 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
16680 @code{#f}
16681 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
16682 @code{#t}
16683 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
16684 @code{30}
16685 @item idle-action
16686 @code{ignore}
16687 @item idle-action-seconds
16688 @code{(* 30 60)}
16689 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
16690 @code{10}
16691 @item runtime-directory-size
16692 @code{#f}
16693 @item remove-ipc?
16694 @code{#t}
16695 @item suspend-state
16696 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
16697 @item suspend-mode
16698 @code{()}
16699 @item hibernate-state
16700 @code{("disk")}
16701 @item hibernate-mode
16702 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
16703 @item hybrid-sleep-state
16704 @code{("disk")}
16705 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
16706 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
16707 @end table
16708 @end deffn
16709
16710 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
16711 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
16712 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
16713 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
16714 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
16715 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
16716 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
16717 accountsservice web site} for more information.
16718
16719 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
16720 package to expose as a service.
16721 @end deffn
16722
16723 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
16724 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
16725 Return a service that runs the
16726 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
16727 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
16728 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
16729 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
16730 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
16731 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
16732 @end deffn
16733
16734 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
16735 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
16736 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
16737 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
16738 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
16739 @end defvr
16740
16741 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
16742 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
16743 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
16744 configuration settings.
16745
16746 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
16747 notably used by GNOME.
16748 @end defvr
16749
16750 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
16751 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
16752
16753 @table @asis
16754
16755 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
16756 Package to use for @code{upower}.
16757
16758 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
16759 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
16760
16761 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
16762 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
16763
16764 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
16765 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
16766
16767 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
16768 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
16769 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
16770
16771 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
16772 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
16773 at which the battery is considered low.
16774
16775 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
16776 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
16777 at which the battery is considered critical.
16778
16779 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
16780 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
16781 at which action will be taken.
16782
16783 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
16784 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
16785 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
16786
16787 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
16788 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
16789 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
16790
16791 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
16792 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
16793 seconds at which action will be taken.
16794
16795 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
16796 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
16797 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
16798
16799 Possible values are:
16800
16801 @itemize @bullet
16802 @item
16803 @code{'power-off}
16804
16805 @item
16806 @code{'hibernate}
16807
16808 @item
16809 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
16810 @end itemize
16811
16812 @end table
16813 @end deftp
16814
16815 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
16816 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
16817 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
16818 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
16819 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
16820 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
16821 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
16822 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
16823 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
16824 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
16825 @end deffn
16826
16827 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
16828 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
16829 service with a D-Bus
16830 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
16831 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
16832 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
16833 site} for more information.
16834 @end deffn
16835
16836 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
16837 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
16838 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
16839 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
16840 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
16841 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
16842 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
16843 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
16844 means that all users are allowed.
16845 @end deffn
16846
16847 @cindex scanner access
16848 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sane-service-type
16849 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
16850 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary udev
16851 rules.
16852 @end deffn
16853
16854 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
16855 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
16856 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
16857 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
16858 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
16859 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
16860 know the user's location.
16861 @end defvr
16862
16863 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
16864 [#:whitelist '()] @
16865 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
16866 [#:submit-data? #f]
16867 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
16868 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
16869 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
16870 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
16871 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
16872 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
16873 location databases. See
16874 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
16875 web site} for more information.
16876 @end deffn
16877
16878 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
16879 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
16880 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
16881 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
16882 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
16883 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
16884 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
16885
16886 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
16887 @end deffn
16888
16889 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
16890 This is the type of the service that adds the
16891 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
16892 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
16893
16894 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
16895 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
16896 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
16897 @end defvr
16898
16899 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
16900 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
16901
16902 @table @asis
16903 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
16904 The GNOME keyring package to use.
16905
16906 @item @code{pam-services}
16907 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
16908 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
16909 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
16910 @code{passwd}.
16911
16912 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
16913 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
16914 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
16915 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
16916 without arguments.
16917
16918 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
16919 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
16920 @end table
16921 @end deftp
16922
16923
16924 @node Sound Services
16925 @subsection Sound Services
16926
16927 @cindex sound support
16928 @cindex ALSA
16929 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
16930
16931 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
16932 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
16933 preferred ALSA output driver.
16934
16935 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
16936 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
16937 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
16938 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
16939 record as in this example:
16940
16941 @lisp
16942 (service alsa-service-type)
16943 @end lisp
16944
16945 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
16946 @end deffn
16947
16948 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
16949 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
16950
16951 @table @asis
16952 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
16953 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
16954
16955 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
16956 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
16957 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
16958
16959 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
16960 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
16961 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
16962
16963 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
16964 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
16965
16966 @end table
16967 @end deftp
16968
16969 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
16970 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
16971
16972 @example
16973 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
16974 pcm_type.jack @{
16975 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
16976 @}
16977
16978 # Routing ALSA to jack:
16979 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
16980 pcm.rawjack @{
16981 type jack
16982 playback_ports @{
16983 0 system:playback_1
16984 1 system:playback_2
16985 @}
16986
16987 capture_ports @{
16988 0 system:capture_1
16989 1 system:capture_2
16990 @}
16991 @}
16992
16993 pcm.!default @{
16994 type plug
16995 slave @{
16996 pcm "rawjack"
16997 @}
16998 @}
16999 @end example
17000
17001 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
17002 details.
17003
17004 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
17005 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
17006 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
17007 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
17008
17009 @quotation Warning
17010 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
17011 PulseAudio to honor configuraton files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
17012 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
17013 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
17014 @end quotation
17015
17016 @quotation Warning
17017 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
17018 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
17019 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
17020 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
17021 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
17022 @end quotation
17023 @end deffn
17024
17025 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
17026 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
17027
17028 @table @asis
17029 @item @var{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
17030 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
17031 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
17032 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
17033 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
17034
17035 @item @var{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
17036 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
17037 @var{client-conf}.
17038
17039 @item @var{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
17040 Script file to use as as @file{default.pa}.
17041
17042 @item @var{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
17043 Script file to use as as @file{system.pa}.
17044 @end table
17045 @end deftp
17046
17047 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
17048 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
17049 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
17050
17051 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
17052 @code{swh-plugins} package:
17053
17054 @lisp
17055 (service ladspa-service-type
17056 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
17057 @end lisp
17058
17059 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
17060 details.
17061
17062 @end deffn
17063
17064 @node Database Services
17065 @subsection Database Services
17066
17067 @cindex database
17068 @cindex SQL
17069 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
17070
17071 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
17072 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
17073 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
17074 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
17075 server.
17076
17077 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
17078 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
17079 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
17080
17081 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
17082 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
17083 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
17084 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
17085 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
17086
17087 @cindex postgis
17088 @lisp
17089 (use-package-modules databases geo)
17090
17091 (operating-system
17092 ...
17093 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
17094 ;; proper operation.
17095 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
17096 (services
17097 (cons*
17098 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
17099 %base-services)))
17100 @end lisp
17101
17102 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
17103 database in this way:
17104
17105 @example
17106 psql -U postgres
17107 > create database postgistest;
17108 > \connect postgistest;
17109 > create extension postgis;
17110 > create extension postgis_topology;
17111 @end example
17112
17113 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
17114 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
17115 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
17116 @end deffn
17117
17118 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
17119 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
17120 database server.
17121
17122 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
17123 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
17124 @end deffn
17125
17126 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
17127 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
17128
17129 @table @asis
17130 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
17131 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
17132 or @var{mysql}.
17133
17134 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
17135 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
17136
17137 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
17138 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
17139 @end table
17140 @end deftp
17141
17142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
17143 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
17144 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
17145 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
17146 @end defvr
17147
17148 @lisp
17149 (service memcached-service-type)
17150 @end lisp
17151
17152 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
17153 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
17154
17155 @table @asis
17156 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
17157 The Memcached package to use.
17158
17159 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
17160 Network interfaces on which to listen.
17161
17162 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
17163 Port on which to accept connections on,
17164
17165 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
17166 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
17167 listening on a UDP socket.
17168
17169 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
17170 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
17171 @end table
17172 @end deftp
17173
17174 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
17175 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
17176 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
17177 @end defvr
17178
17179 @lisp
17180 (service mongodb-service-type)
17181 @end lisp
17182
17183 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
17184 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
17185
17186 @table @asis
17187 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
17188 The MongoDB package to use.
17189
17190 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
17191 The configuration file for MongoDB.
17192
17193 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
17194 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
17195 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
17196 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
17197 @end table
17198 @end deftp
17199
17200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
17201 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
17202 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
17203 @end defvr
17204
17205 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
17206 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
17207
17208 @table @asis
17209 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
17210 The Redis package to use.
17211
17212 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17213 Network interface on which to listen.
17214
17215 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
17216 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
17217 listening on a TCP socket.
17218
17219 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
17220 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
17221 @end table
17222 @end deftp
17223
17224 @node Mail Services
17225 @subsection Mail Services
17226
17227 @cindex mail
17228 @cindex email
17229 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
17230 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
17231 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
17232 in the subsections below.
17233
17234 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
17235
17236 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
17237 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
17238 @end deffn
17239
17240 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
17241 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
17242 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
17243 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
17244 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
17245 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
17246 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
17247 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
17248
17249 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
17250 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
17251
17252 @lisp
17253 (dovecot-service #:config
17254 (dovecot-configuration
17255 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
17256 @end lisp
17257
17258 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17259 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17260 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17261 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
17262 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
17263 from some other system; see the end for more details.
17264
17265 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17266 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
17267 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17268 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17269 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17270 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17271 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
17272
17273 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
17274
17275 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
17276 The dovecot package.
17277 @end deftypevr
17278
17279 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
17280 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
17281 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
17282 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
17283 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
17284 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
17285 @end deftypevr
17286
17287 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
17288 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
17289 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
17290
17291 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
17292
17293 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
17294 The name of the protocol.
17295 @end deftypevr
17296
17297 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
17298 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
17299 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
17300 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
17301 @end deftypevr
17302
17303 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
17304 Space separated list of plugins to load.
17305 @end deftypevr
17306
17307 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
17308 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
17309 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
17310 Defaults to @samp{10}.
17311 @end deftypevr
17312
17313 @end deftypevr
17314
17315 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
17316 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
17317 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
17318 @samp{lmtp}.
17319
17320 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
17321
17322 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
17323 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
17324 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
17325 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
17326 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
17327 @end deftypevr
17328
17329 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
17330 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
17331 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
17332 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
17333 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17334
17335 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
17336
17337 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
17338 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
17339 the section name.
17340 @end deftypevr
17341
17342 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
17343 The access mode for the socket.
17344 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
17345 @end deftypevr
17346
17347 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
17348 The user to own the socket.
17349 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17350 @end deftypevr
17351
17352 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
17353 The group to own the socket.
17354 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17355 @end deftypevr
17356
17357
17358 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
17359
17360 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
17361 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
17362 the section name.
17363 @end deftypevr
17364
17365 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
17366 The access mode for the socket.
17367 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
17368 @end deftypevr
17369
17370 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
17371 The user to own the socket.
17372 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17373 @end deftypevr
17374
17375 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
17376 The group to own the socket.
17377 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17378 @end deftypevr
17379
17380
17381 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
17382
17383 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
17384 The protocol to listen for.
17385 @end deftypevr
17386
17387 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
17388 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
17389 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17390 @end deftypevr
17391
17392 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
17393 The port on which to listen.
17394 @end deftypevr
17395
17396 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
17397 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
17398 @samp{required}.
17399 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17400 @end deftypevr
17401
17402 @end deftypevr
17403
17404 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
17405 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
17406 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
17407 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
17408 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
17409
17410 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17411
17412 @end deftypevr
17413
17414 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
17415 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
17416 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
17417 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
17418 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17419
17420 @end deftypevr
17421
17422 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
17423 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
17424 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
17425
17426 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17427
17428 @end deftypevr
17429
17430 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
17431 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
17432 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17433 @end deftypevr
17434
17435 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
17436 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
17437 this.
17438 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
17439 @end deftypevr
17440
17441 @end deftypevr
17442
17443 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
17444 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
17445 constructor.
17446
17447 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
17448
17449 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
17450 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
17451 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17452 @end deftypevr
17453
17454 @end deftypevr
17455
17456 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
17457 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
17458 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
17459
17460 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
17461
17462 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
17463 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
17464 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
17465 @samp{static}.
17466 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
17467 @end deftypevr
17468
17469 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
17470 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
17471 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17472 @end deftypevr
17473
17474 @end deftypevr
17475
17476 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
17477 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
17478 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
17479
17480 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
17481
17482 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
17483 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
17484 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
17485 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
17486 @end deftypevr
17487
17488 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
17489 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17490 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17491 @end deftypevr
17492
17493 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
17494 Override fields from passwd.
17495 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17496 @end deftypevr
17497
17498 @end deftypevr
17499
17500 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
17501 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
17502 constructor.
17503 @end deftypevr
17504
17505 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
17506 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
17507 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
17508
17509 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
17510
17511 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
17512 Name for this namespace.
17513 @end deftypevr
17514
17515 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
17516 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
17517 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
17518 @end deftypevr
17519
17520 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
17521 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
17522 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
17523 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
17524 format.
17525 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17526 @end deftypevr
17527
17528 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
17529 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
17530 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
17531 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17532 @end deftypevr
17533
17534 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
17535 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
17536 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
17537 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17538 @end deftypevr
17539
17540 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
17541 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
17542 namespace has it.
17543 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17544 @end deftypevr
17545
17546 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
17547 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
17548 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
17549 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
17550 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
17551 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
17552 and @samp{mail/}.
17553 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17554 @end deftypevr
17555
17556 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
17557 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
17558 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
17559 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
17560 hides the namespace prefix.
17561 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17562 @end deftypevr
17563
17564 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
17565 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
17566 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
17567 as @code{#t}).
17568 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17569 @end deftypevr
17570
17571 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
17572 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
17573 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17574
17575 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
17576
17577 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
17578 Name for this mailbox.
17579 @end deftypevr
17580
17581 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
17582 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
17583 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
17584 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
17585 @end deftypevr
17586
17587 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
17588 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
17589 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
17590 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
17591 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17592 @end deftypevr
17593
17594 @end deftypevr
17595
17596 @end deftypevr
17597
17598 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
17599 Base directory where to store runtime data.
17600 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
17601 @end deftypevr
17602
17603 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
17604 Greeting message for clients.
17605 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
17606 @end deftypevr
17607
17608 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
17609 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
17610 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
17611 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
17612 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
17613 here.
17614 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17615 @end deftypevr
17616
17617 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
17618 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
17619 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17620 @end deftypevr
17621
17622 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
17623 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
17624 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
17625 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
17626 accounts).
17627 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17628 @end deftypevr
17629
17630 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
17631 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
17632 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
17633 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
17634 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
17635 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17636 @end deftypevr
17637
17638 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
17639 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
17640 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
17641 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17642 @end deftypevr
17643
17644 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
17645 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
17646 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
17647 @end deftypevr
17648
17649 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
17650 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
17651 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
17652 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
17653 @end deftypevr
17654
17655 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
17656 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
17657 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
17658 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
17659 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
17660 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
17661 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17662 @end deftypevr
17663
17664 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
17665 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
17666 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
17667 for caching to be used.
17668 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17669 @end deftypevr
17670
17671 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
17672 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
17673 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
17674 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
17675 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
17676 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
17677 authentication.
17678 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
17679 @end deftypevr
17680
17681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
17682 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
17683 0 disables caching them completely.
17684 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
17685 @end deftypevr
17686
17687 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
17688 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
17689 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
17690 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
17691 realm first.
17692 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17693 @end deftypevr
17694
17695 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
17696 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
17697 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
17698 logins.
17699 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17700 @end deftypevr
17701
17702 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
17703 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
17704 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
17705 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
17706 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
17707 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
17708 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
17709 @end deftypevr
17710
17711 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
17712 Username character translations before it's looked up from
17713 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
17714 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
17715 translated to @samp{@@}.
17716 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17717 @end deftypevr
17718
17719 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
17720 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
17721 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
17722 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
17723 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
17724 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
17725 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
17726 @end deftypevr
17727
17728 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
17729 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
17730 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
17731 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
17732 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
17733 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
17734 choice.
17735 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17736 @end deftypevr
17737
17738 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
17739 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
17740 mechanism.
17741 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
17742 @end deftypevr
17743
17744 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
17745 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
17746 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
17747 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
17748 Defaults to @samp{30}.
17749 @end deftypevr
17750
17751 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
17752 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
17753 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
17754 allow all keytab entries.
17755 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17756 @end deftypevr
17757
17758 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
17759 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
17760 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
17761 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
17762 file.
17763 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17764 @end deftypevr
17765
17766 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
17767 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
17768 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
17769 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
17770 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17771 @end deftypevr
17772
17773 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
17774 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
17775 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
17776 @end deftypevr
17777
17778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
17779 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
17780 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
17781 @end deftypevr
17782
17783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
17784 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
17785 fails.
17786 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17787 @end deftypevr
17788
17789 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
17790 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
17791 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
17792 CommonName.
17793 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17794 @end deftypevr
17795
17796 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
17797 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
17798 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
17799 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
17800 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
17801 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
17802 @end deftypevr
17803
17804 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
17805 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
17806 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
17807 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
17808 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17809 @end deftypevr
17810
17811 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
17812 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
17813 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
17814 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17815 @end deftypevr
17816
17817 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
17818 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
17819 has any connections.
17820 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
17821 @end deftypevr
17822
17823 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
17824 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
17825 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
17826 are shared within domain.
17827 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
17828 @end deftypevr
17829
17830 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
17831 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
17832 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
17833 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
17834 @end deftypevr
17835
17836 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
17837 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
17838 @samp{log-path}.
17839 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17840 @end deftypevr
17841
17842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
17843 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
17844 @samp{info-log-path}.
17845 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17846 @end deftypevr
17847
17848 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
17849 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
17850 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
17851 standard facilities are supported.
17852 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
17853 @end deftypevr
17854
17855 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
17856 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
17857 failed.
17858 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17859 @end deftypevr
17860
17861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
17862 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
17863 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
17864 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
17865 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
17866 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
17867 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
17868 @end deftypevr
17869
17870 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
17871 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
17872 SQL queries.
17873 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17874 @end deftypevr
17875
17876 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
17877 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
17878 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
17879 @samp{auth-debug}.
17880 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17881 @end deftypevr
17882
17883 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
17884 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
17885 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
17886 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17887 @end deftypevr
17888
17889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
17890 Show protocol level SSL errors.
17891 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17892 @end deftypevr
17893
17894 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
17895 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
17896 strftime(3) format.
17897 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
17898 @end deftypevr
17899
17900 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
17901 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
17902 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
17903 string.
17904 @end deftypevr
17905
17906 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
17907 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
17908 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
17909 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
17910 @end deftypevr
17911
17912 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
17913 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
17914 of possible variables you can use.
17915 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
17916 @end deftypevr
17917
17918 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
17919 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
17920 @table @code
17921 @item %$
17922 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
17923 @item %m
17924 Message-ID
17925 @item %s
17926 Subject
17927 @item %f
17928 From address
17929 @item %p
17930 Physical size
17931 @item %w
17932 Virtual size.
17933 @end table
17934 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
17935 @end deftypevr
17936
17937 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
17938 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
17939 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
17940 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
17941 Dovecot the full location.
17942
17943 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
17944 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
17945 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
17946 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
17947 @samp{mail-location} setting.
17948
17949 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
17950
17951 @table @samp
17952 @item %u
17953 username
17954 @item %n
17955 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
17956 @item %d
17957 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
17958 @item %h
17959 home director
17960 @end table
17961
17962 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
17963 @table @samp
17964 @item maildir:~/Maildir
17965 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
17966 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
17967 @end table
17968 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17969 @end deftypevr
17970
17971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
17972 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
17973 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
17974 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
17975 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17976 @end deftypevr
17977
17978 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
17979
17980 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17981 @end deftypevr
17982
17983 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
17984 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
17985 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
17986 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
17987 @file{/var/mail}.
17988 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17989 @end deftypevr
17990
17991 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
17992 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
17993 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
17994 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
17995 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
17996 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
17997 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
17998 @samp{""}.
17999 @end deftypevr
18000
18001 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
18002 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
18003 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
18004 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
18005 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
18006 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18007 @end deftypevr
18008
18009 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
18010 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
18011 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
18012 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18013 @end deftypevr
18014
18015 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
18016 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
18017 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
18018 nowadays by default.
18019 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18020 @end deftypevr
18021
18022 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
18023 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
18024 @table @code
18025 @item optimized
18026 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
18027 @item always
18028 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
18029 @item never
18030 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
18031 @end table
18032 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
18033 @end deftypevr
18034
18035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
18036 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
18037 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
18038 this isn't needed.
18039 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18040 @end deftypevr
18041
18042 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
18043 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
18044 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
18045 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18046 @end deftypevr
18047
18048 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
18049 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
18050 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
18051 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
18052 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
18053 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
18054 @end deftypevr
18055
18056 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
18057 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
18058 kB.
18059 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
18060 @end deftypevr
18061
18062 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
18063 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
18064 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
18065 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
18066 is set to 0.
18067 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18068 @end deftypevr
18069
18070 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
18071
18072 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18073 @end deftypevr
18074
18075 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
18076 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
18077 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
18078 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
18079 Defaults to @samp{1}.
18080 @end deftypevr
18081
18082 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
18083
18084 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18085 @end deftypevr
18086
18087 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
18088 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
18089 trying to create new keywords.
18090 Defaults to @samp{50}.
18091 @end deftypevr
18092
18093 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
18094 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
18095 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
18096 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
18097 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
18098 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
18099 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
18100 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
18101 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
18102 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18103 @end deftypevr
18104
18105 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
18106 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
18107 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
18108 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
18109 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
18110 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
18111 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
18112 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
18113 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18114 @end deftypevr
18115
18116 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
18117 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
18118 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
18119 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
18120 @end deftypevr
18121
18122 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
18123 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
18124 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
18125 @end deftypevr
18126
18127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
18128 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
18129 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
18130 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18131 @end deftypevr
18132
18133 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
18134 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
18135 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
18136 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
18137 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18138 @end deftypevr
18139
18140 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
18141 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
18142 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
18143 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
18144 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
18145 occur.
18146 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
18147 @end deftypevr
18148
18149 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
18150 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
18151 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
18152 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
18153 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
18154 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
18155 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18156 @end deftypevr
18157
18158 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
18159 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
18160 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
18161 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
18162 causes more disk I/O.
18163 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
18164 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
18165 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18166 @end deftypevr
18167
18168 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
18169 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
18170 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
18171 side effects.
18172 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18173 @end deftypevr
18174
18175 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
18176 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
18177 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
18178 the mail otherwise.
18179 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18180 @end deftypevr
18181
18182 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
18183 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
18184 available:
18185
18186 @table @code
18187 @item dotlock
18188 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
18189 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
18190 need write access to that directory.
18191 @item dotlock-try
18192 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
18193 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
18194 @item fcntl
18195 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
18196 @item flock
18197 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
18198 @item lockf
18199 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
18200 @end table
18201
18202 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
18203 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
18204 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
18205 them simultaneously.
18206 @end deftypevr
18207
18208 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
18209
18210 @end deftypevr
18211
18212 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
18213 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
18214 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
18215 @end deftypevr
18216
18217 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
18218 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
18219 override the lock file after this much time.
18220 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
18221 @end deftypevr
18222
18223 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
18224 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
18225 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
18226 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
18227 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
18228 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
18229 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
18230 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
18231 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
18232 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
18233 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18234 @end deftypevr
18235
18236 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
18237 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
18238 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
18239 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
18240 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18241 @end deftypevr
18242
18243 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
18244 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
18245 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
18246 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
18247 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
18248 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18249 @end deftypevr
18250
18251 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
18252 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
18253 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
18254 updated.
18255 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18256 @end deftypevr
18257
18258 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
18259 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
18260 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
18261 @end deftypevr
18262
18263 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
18264 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
18265 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
18266 disabled.
18267 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
18268 @end deftypevr
18269
18270 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
18271 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
18272 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
18273 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
18274 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18275 @end deftypevr
18276
18277 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
18278 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
18279 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
18280 don't support this for now.
18281
18282 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
18283
18284 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
18285 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18286 @end deftypevr
18287
18288 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
18289 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
18290 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
18291 externally.
18292 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
18293 @end deftypevr
18294
18295 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
18296 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
18297 @table @code
18298 @item posix
18299 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
18300 @item sis posix
18301 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
18302 @item sis-queue posix
18303 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
18304 @end table
18305 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
18306 @end deftypevr
18307
18308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
18309 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
18310 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
18311 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
18312 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
18313 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
18314 @end deftypevr
18315
18316 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
18317
18318 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18319 @end deftypevr
18320
18321 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
18322
18323 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
18324 @end deftypevr
18325
18326 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
18327 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
18328 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
18329 before they eat up everything.
18330 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
18334 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
18335 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
18336 at all.
18337 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
18338 @end deftypevr
18339
18340 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
18341 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
18342 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
18343 processes.
18344 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
18345 @end deftypevr
18346
18347 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
18348 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
18349 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
18350 @end deftypevr
18351
18352 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
18353 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
18354 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
18355 @end deftypevr
18356
18357 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
18358 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
18359 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
18360 root.
18361 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
18362 @end deftypevr
18363
18364 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
18365 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
18366 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
18367 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
18368 instead to a different.
18369 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18370 @end deftypevr
18371
18372 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
18373 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
18374 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
18375 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
18376 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
18377 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18378 @end deftypevr
18379
18380 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
18381 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
18382 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18383 @end deftypevr
18384
18385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
18386 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
18387 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
18388 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18389 @end deftypevr
18390
18391 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
18392 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
18393 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
18394 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
18395 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
18396 @end deftypevr
18397
18398 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
18399 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
18400 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
18401 @end deftypevr
18402
18403 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
18404 SSL ciphers to use.
18405 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
18406 @end deftypevr
18407
18408 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
18409 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
18410 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18411 @end deftypevr
18412
18413 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
18414 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
18415 %d expands to recipient domain.
18416 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
18417 @end deftypevr
18418
18419 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18420 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
18421 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
18422 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18423 @end deftypevr
18424
18425 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
18426 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
18427 bouncing the mail.
18428 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18429 @end deftypevr
18430
18431 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
18432 Binary to use for sending mails.
18433 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
18434 @end deftypevr
18435
18436 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
18437 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
18438 sendmail.
18439 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18440 @end deftypevr
18441
18442 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
18443 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
18444 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
18445 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
18446 @end deftypevr
18447
18448 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
18449 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
18450 variables:
18451
18452 @table @code
18453 @item %n
18454 CRLF
18455 @item %r
18456 reason
18457 @item %s
18458 original subject
18459 @item %t
18460 recipient
18461 @end table
18462 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
18463 @end deftypevr
18464
18465 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
18466 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
18467 address.
18468 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
18469 @end deftypevr
18470
18471 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
18472 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
18473 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
18474 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
18475 X-Original-To.
18476 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18477 @end deftypevr
18478
18479 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
18480 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
18481 it?.
18482 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18483 @end deftypevr
18484
18485 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
18486 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
18487 subscribed?.
18488 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18489 @end deftypevr
18490
18491 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
18492 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
18493 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
18494 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
18495 often.
18496 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
18497 @end deftypevr
18498
18499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
18500 IMAP logout format string:
18501 @table @code
18502 @item %i
18503 total number of bytes read from client
18504 @item %o
18505 total number of bytes sent to client.
18506 @end table
18507 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
18508 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
18509 @end deftypevr
18510
18511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
18512 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
18513 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
18514 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18515 @end deftypevr
18516
18517 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
18518 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
18519 is IDLEing.
18520 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
18521 @end deftypevr
18522
18523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
18524 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
18525 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
18526 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
18527 support-email.
18528 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18529 @end deftypevr
18530
18531 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
18532 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
18533 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18534 @end deftypevr
18535
18536 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
18537 Workarounds for various client bugs:
18538
18539 @table @code
18540 @item delay-newmail
18541 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
18542 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
18543 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
18544 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
18545 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
18546 "Headers Only".
18547
18548 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
18549 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
18550 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
18551 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
18552
18553 @item tb-lsub-flags
18554 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
18555 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
18556 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
18557 @end table
18558 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18559 @end deftypevr
18560
18561 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
18562 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
18563 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18564 @end deftypevr
18565
18566
18567 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
18568 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
18569 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
18570 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
18571 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
18572
18573 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
18574 and running. In that case, you can pass an
18575 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
18576 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
18577 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
18578
18579 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
18580
18581 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
18582 The dovecot package.
18583 @end deftypevr
18584
18585 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
18586 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
18587 @end deftypevr
18588
18589 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
18590 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
18591
18592 @lisp
18593 (dovecot-service #:config
18594 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
18595 (string "")))
18596 @end lisp
18597
18598 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
18599
18600 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
18601 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
18602 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
18603 as in this example:
18604
18605 @lisp
18606 (service opensmtpd-service-type
18607 (opensmtpd-configuration
18608 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
18609 @end lisp
18610 @end deffn
18611
18612 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
18613 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
18614
18615 @table @asis
18616 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
18617 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
18618
18619 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
18620 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
18621 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
18622 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
18623 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
18624
18625 @end table
18626 @end deftp
18627
18628 @subsubheading Exim Service
18629
18630 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
18631 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
18632 @cindex SMTP
18633
18634 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
18635 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
18636 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
18637 as in this example:
18638
18639 @lisp
18640 (service exim-service-type
18641 (exim-configuration
18642 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
18643 @end lisp
18644 @end deffn
18645
18646 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
18647 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
18648 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
18649
18650 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
18651 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
18652
18653 @table @asis
18654 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
18655 Package object of the Exim server.
18656
18657 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
18658 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
18659 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
18660 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
18661 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
18662 variables.
18663
18664 @end table
18665 @end deftp
18666
18667 @subsubheading Getmail service
18668
18669 @cindex IMAP
18670 @cindex POP
18671
18672 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
18673 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
18674 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
18675 @end deffn
18676
18677 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
18678
18679 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
18680 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
18681
18682 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
18683
18684 @end deftypevr
18685
18686 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
18687 The getmail package to use.
18688
18689 @end deftypevr
18690
18691 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
18692 The user to run getmail as.
18693
18694 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
18695
18696 @end deftypevr
18697
18698 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
18699 The group to run getmail as.
18700
18701 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
18702
18703 @end deftypevr
18704
18705 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
18706 The getmail directory to use.
18707
18708 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
18709
18710 @end deftypevr
18711
18712 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
18713 The getmail configuration file to use.
18714
18715 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
18716
18717 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
18718 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
18719
18720 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
18721
18722 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
18723 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
18724 and @samp{static}.
18725
18726 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
18727
18728 @end deftypevr
18729
18730 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
18731 Username to login to the mail server with.
18732
18733 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
18734
18735 @end deftypevr
18736
18737 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
18738 Username to login to the mail server with.
18739
18740 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
18741
18742 @end deftypevr
18743
18744 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
18745 Port number to connect to.
18746
18747 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18748
18749 @end deftypevr
18750
18751 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
18752 Override fields from passwd.
18753
18754 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18755
18756 @end deftypevr
18757
18758 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
18759 Override fields from passwd.
18760
18761 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18762
18763 @end deftypevr
18764
18765 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
18766 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
18767
18768 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18769
18770 @end deftypevr
18771
18772 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
18773 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
18774
18775 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18776
18777 @end deftypevr
18778
18779 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
18780 CA certificates to use.
18781
18782 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18783
18784 @end deftypevr
18785
18786 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
18787 Extra retriever parameters.
18788
18789 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18790
18791 @end deftypevr
18792
18793 @end deftypevr
18794
18795 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
18796 What to do with retrieved messages.
18797
18798 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
18799
18800 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
18801 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
18802 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
18803
18804 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
18805
18806 @end deftypevr
18807
18808 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
18809 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
18810 chosen type.
18811
18812 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18813
18814 @end deftypevr
18815
18816 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
18817 Extra destination parameters
18818
18819 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18820
18821 @end deftypevr
18822
18823 @end deftypevr
18824
18825 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
18826 Configure getmail.
18827
18828 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
18829
18830 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
18831 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
18832 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
18833 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
18834 about each of it's actions.
18835
18836 Defaults to @samp{1}.
18837
18838 @end deftypevr
18839
18840 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
18841 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
18842 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
18843
18844 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18845
18846 @end deftypevr
18847
18848 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
18849 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
18850 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
18851 be left on the server.
18852
18853 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18854
18855 @end deftypevr
18856
18857 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
18858 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
18859 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
18860 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
18861 disabled this feature.
18862
18863 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18864
18865 @end deftypevr
18866
18867 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
18868 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
18869 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
18870 disables this feature.
18871
18872 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18873
18874 @end deftypevr
18875
18876 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
18877 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
18878 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
18879
18880 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18881
18882 @end deftypevr
18883
18884 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
18885 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
18886 @samp{0} disables this feature.
18887
18888 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18889
18890 @end deftypevr
18891
18892 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
18893 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
18894
18895 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18896
18897 @end deftypevr
18898
18899 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
18900 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
18901
18902 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18903
18904 @end deftypevr
18905
18906 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
18907 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
18908 @samp{""} disables this feature.
18909
18910 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18911
18912 @end deftypevr
18913
18914 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
18915 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
18916 logger.
18917
18918 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18919
18920 @end deftypevr
18921
18922 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
18923 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
18924 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
18925 information lines.
18926
18927 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18928
18929 @end deftypevr
18930
18931 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
18932 Extra options to include.
18933
18934 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18935
18936 @end deftypevr
18937
18938 @end deftypevr
18939
18940 @end deftypevr
18941
18942 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
18943 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
18944 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
18945 extension.
18946
18947 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18948
18949 @end deftypevr
18950
18951 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
18952 Environment variables to set for getmail.
18953
18954 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18955
18956 @end deftypevr
18957
18958 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
18959
18960 @cindex email aliases
18961 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
18962
18963 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
18964 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
18965 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
18966
18967 @lisp
18968 (service mail-aliases-service-type
18969 '(("postmaster" "bob")
18970 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
18971 @end lisp
18972 @end deffn
18973
18974 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
18975 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
18976 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
18977 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
18978 where to deliver this user's mail.
18979
18980 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
18981 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
18982 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
18983 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
18984 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
18985
18986 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
18987 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
18988
18989 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
18990 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
18991 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
18992 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
18993
18994 @lisp
18995 (service imap4d-service-type
18996 (imap4d-configuration
18997 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
18998 @end lisp
18999 @end deffn
19000
19001 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
19002 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
19003
19004 @table @asis
19005 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
19006 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
19007
19008 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
19009 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
19010 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
19011 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
19012
19013 @end table
19014 @end deftp
19015
19016 @node Messaging Services
19017 @subsection Messaging Services
19018
19019 @cindex messaging
19020 @cindex jabber
19021 @cindex XMPP
19022 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
19023 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
19024
19025 @subsubheading Prosody Service
19026
19027 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
19028 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
19029 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
19030 record as in this example:
19031
19032 @lisp
19033 (service prosody-service-type
19034 (prosody-configuration
19035 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
19036 (int-components
19037 (list
19038 (int-component-configuration
19039 (hostname "conference.example.net")
19040 (plugin "muc")
19041 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
19042 (virtualhosts
19043 (list
19044 (virtualhost-configuration
19045 (domain "example.net"))))))
19046 @end lisp
19047
19048 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
19049
19050 @end deffn
19051
19052 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
19053 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
19054 Prosody to serve.
19055
19056 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
19057 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
19058
19059 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
19060 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
19061 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
19062
19063 @example
19064 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
19065 @end example
19066
19067 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19068 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19069 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19070 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
19071 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
19072
19073 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
19074 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
19075 some other system; see the end for more details.
19076
19077 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
19078 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
19079
19080 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19081 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
19082 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19083 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19084 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19085 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19086 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
19087
19088 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
19089
19090 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
19091 The Prosody package.
19092 @end deftypevr
19093
19094 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
19095 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
19096 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
19097 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
19098 @end deftypevr
19099
19100 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
19101 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
19102 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
19103 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19104 @end deftypevr
19105
19106 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
19107 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
19108 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
19109 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
19110 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
19111 @end deftypevr
19112
19113 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
19114 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
19115 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
19116 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
19117 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
19118 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19119 @end deftypevr
19120
19121 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
19122 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
19123 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
19124 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19125 @end deftypevr
19126
19127 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
19128 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
19129 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
19130 Documentation on modules can be found at:
19131 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
19132 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
19133 @end deftypevr
19134
19135 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
19136 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
19137 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
19138 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19139 @end deftypevr
19140
19141 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
19142 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
19143 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
19144 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
19145 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
19146 @end deftypevr
19147
19148 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
19149 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
19150 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
19151 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19152 @end deftypevr
19153
19154 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
19155 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
19156 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
19157 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
19158 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
19159
19160 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
19161
19162 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
19163 This determines what handshake to use.
19164 @end deftypevr
19165
19166 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
19167 Path to your private key file.
19168 @end deftypevr
19169
19170 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
19171 Path to your certificate file.
19172 @end deftypevr
19173
19174 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
19175 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
19176 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
19177 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
19178 @end deftypevr
19179
19180 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
19181 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
19182 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
19183 @end deftypevr
19184
19185 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
19186 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
19187 @code{set_verify()} flags).
19188 @end deftypevr
19189
19190 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
19191 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
19192 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
19193 LuaSec source.
19194 @end deftypevr
19195
19196 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
19197 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
19198 trusted root certificate.
19199 @end deftypevr
19200
19201 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
19202 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
19203 clients, and in what order.
19204 @end deftypevr
19205
19206 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
19207 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
19208 can create such a file with:
19209 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
19210 @end deftypevr
19211
19212 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
19213 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
19214 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
19215 @end deftypevr
19216
19217 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
19218 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
19219 @end deftypevr
19220
19221 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
19222 Password for encrypted private keys.
19223 @end deftypevr
19224
19225 @end deftypevr
19226
19227 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
19228 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
19229 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
19230 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19231 @end deftypevr
19232
19233 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
19234 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
19235 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
19236 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
19237 @end deftypevr
19238
19239 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
19240 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
19241 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
19242 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19243 @end deftypevr
19244
19245 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
19246 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
19247 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
19248 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
19249 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
19250 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19251 @end deftypevr
19252
19253 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
19254 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
19255 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
19256 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
19257 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
19258 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19259 @end deftypevr
19260
19261 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
19262 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
19263 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
19264 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
19265 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19266 @end deftypevr
19267
19268 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
19269 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
19270 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
19271 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
19272 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
19273 about using the hashed backend. See also
19274 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
19275 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
19276 @end deftypevr
19277
19278 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
19279 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
19280 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
19281 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
19282 @end deftypevr
19283
19284 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
19285 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
19286 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
19287 @end deftypevr
19288
19289 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
19290 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
19291 @end deftypevr
19292
19293 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
19294 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
19295 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
19296 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
19297 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
19298 @end deftypevr
19299
19300 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
19301 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
19302 example if you want your users to have addresses like
19303 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
19304 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
19305
19306 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
19307 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
19308 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
19309 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
19310 have just one VirtualHost entry.
19311
19312 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
19313
19314 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
19315
19316 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
19317 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
19318 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
19319 @end deftypevr
19320
19321 @end deftypevr
19322
19323 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
19324 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
19325 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
19326 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
19327 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
19328
19329 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
19330 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
19331 to use for the component.
19332
19333 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
19334 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19335
19336 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
19337
19338 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
19339 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
19340 Hostname of the component.
19341 @end deftypevr
19342
19343 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
19344 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
19345 @end deftypevr
19346
19347 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
19348 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
19349 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
19350
19351 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
19352 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
19353 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
19354
19355 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
19356
19357 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
19358
19359 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
19360 The name to return in service discovery responses.
19361 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
19362 @end deftypevr
19363
19364 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
19365 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
19366 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
19367 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
19368 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
19369 restricts to service administrators only.
19370 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19371 @end deftypevr
19372
19373 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
19374 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
19375 just joined the room.
19376 Defaults to @samp{20}.
19377 @end deftypevr
19378
19379 @end deftypevr
19380
19381 @end deftypevr
19382
19383 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
19384 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
19385 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
19386 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
19387 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19388
19389 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
19390
19391 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
19392 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
19393 Password which the component will use to log in.
19394 @end deftypevr
19395
19396 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
19397 Hostname of the component.
19398 @end deftypevr
19399
19400 @end deftypevr
19401
19402 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
19403 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
19404 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
19405 @end deftypevr
19406
19407 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
19408 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
19409 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
19410 @end deftypevr
19411
19412 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
19413 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
19414 @end deftypevr
19415
19416 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
19417 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
19418 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
19419 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
19420 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
19421 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
19422
19423 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
19424 The prosody package.
19425 @end deftypevr
19426
19427 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
19428 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
19429 @end deftypevr
19430
19431 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
19432 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
19433
19434 @lisp
19435 (service prosody-service-type
19436 (opaque-prosody-configuration
19437 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
19438 @end lisp
19439
19440 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
19441
19442 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
19443
19444 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
19445 @cindex IRC gateway
19446 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
19447 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
19448
19449 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
19450 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
19451 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
19452 below).
19453
19454 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
19455 services:
19456
19457 @lisp
19458 (service bitlbee-service-type)
19459 @end lisp
19460 @end defvr
19461
19462 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
19463 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
19464
19465 @table @asis
19466 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19467 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
19468 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
19469 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
19470
19471 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
19472 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
19473 networking interface.
19474
19475 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
19476 The BitlBee package to use.
19477
19478 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
19479 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
19480
19481 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
19482 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
19483 @end table
19484 @end deftp
19485
19486 @subsubheading Quassel Service
19487
19488 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
19489 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
19490 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
19491 central core.
19492
19493 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
19494 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
19495 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
19496 (see below).
19497 @end defvr
19498
19499 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
19500 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
19501
19502 @table @asis
19503 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
19504 The Quassel package to use.
19505
19506 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
19507 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
19508 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
19509 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
19510 @var{port}.
19511
19512 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
19513 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
19514 and Error.
19515 @end table
19516 @end deftp
19517
19518 @node Telephony Services
19519 @subsection Telephony Services
19520
19521 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
19522 @cindex VoIP server
19523 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
19524 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
19525 (VoIP) suite.
19526
19527 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
19528 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
19529 look like this:
19530
19531 @lisp
19532 (service murmur-service-type
19533 (murmur-configuration
19534 (welcome-text
19535 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
19536 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
19537 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
19538 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
19539 @end lisp
19540
19541 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
19542 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
19543
19544 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
19545 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
19546 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
19547 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
19548 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
19549 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
19550 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
19551 rights and create some channels.
19552
19553 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
19554
19555 @table @asis
19556 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
19557 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
19558
19559 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
19560 User who will run the Murmur server.
19561
19562 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
19563 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
19564
19565 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
19566 Port on which the server will listen.
19567
19568 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
19569 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
19570
19571 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
19572 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
19573
19574 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
19575 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
19576
19577 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
19578 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
19579
19580 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
19581 File name of the sqlite database.
19582 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
19583
19584 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
19585 File name of the log file.
19586 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
19587
19588 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
19589 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
19590 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
19591
19592 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
19593 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
19594
19595 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
19596 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
19597 when violating the autoban limits.
19598
19599 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
19600 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
19601 before switching over to opus audio codec.
19602
19603 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
19604 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
19605
19606 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
19607 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
19608
19609 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
19610 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
19611
19612 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
19613 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
19614
19615 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
19616 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
19617
19618 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
19619 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
19620 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
19621
19622 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
19623 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
19624 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
19625
19626 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
19627 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
19628
19629 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
19630 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
19631 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
19632 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
19633
19634 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
19635
19636 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
19637 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
19638
19639 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
19640 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
19641
19642 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
19643 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
19644 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
19645 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
19646
19647 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
19648 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
19649
19650 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
19651 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
19652
19653 @lisp
19654 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
19655 @end lisp
19656 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
19657 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
19658 @lisp
19659 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
19660 @end lisp
19661
19662 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
19663 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
19664 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
19665 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
19666 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
19667
19668 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
19669 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
19670 in SSL/TLS.
19671
19672 This option is specified using
19673 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
19674 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
19675
19676 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
19677 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
19678 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
19679 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
19680
19681 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
19682 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
19683 to connect to it.
19684
19685 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
19686 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
19687
19688 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
19689 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
19690 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
19691 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
19692
19693 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
19694
19695 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
19696 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
19697 @end table
19698 @end deftp
19699
19700 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
19701 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
19702
19703 @table @asis
19704 @item @code{name}
19705 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
19706
19707 @item @code{password}
19708 A password to identify your registration.
19709 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
19710
19711 @item @code{url}
19712 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
19713 site.
19714
19715 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
19716 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
19717 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
19718 @end table
19719 @end deftp
19720
19721
19722
19723 @node Monitoring Services
19724 @subsection Monitoring Services
19725
19726 @subsubheading Tailon Service
19727
19728 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
19729 viewing and searching log files.
19730
19731 The following example will configure the service with default values.
19732 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
19733
19734 @lisp
19735 (service tailon-service-type)
19736 @end lisp
19737
19738 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
19739 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
19740
19741 @lisp
19742 (service tailon-service-type
19743 (tailon-configuration
19744 (config-file
19745 (tailon-configuration-file
19746 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
19747 @end lisp
19748
19749
19750 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
19751 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
19752 This type has the following parameters:
19753
19754 @table @asis
19755 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
19756 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
19757 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
19758 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
19759
19760 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
19761 can be used:
19762
19763 @lisp
19764 (service tailon-service-type
19765 (tailon-configuration
19766 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
19767 @end lisp
19768
19769 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
19770 The tailon package to use.
19771
19772 @end table
19773 @end deftp
19774
19775 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
19776 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
19777 This type has the following parameters:
19778
19779 @table @asis
19780 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
19781 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
19782 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
19783 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
19784 subsection.
19785
19786 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
19787 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
19788
19789 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
19790 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
19791
19792 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
19793 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
19794
19795 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
19796 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
19797
19798 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
19799 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
19800
19801 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
19802 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
19803
19804 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
19805 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
19806
19807 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
19808 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
19809 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
19810 wrap lines.
19811
19812 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
19813 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
19814 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
19815 @code{"basic"}.
19816
19817 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
19818 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
19819 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
19820 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
19821 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
19822
19823 @lisp
19824 (tailon-configuration-file
19825 (http-auth "basic")
19826 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
19827 ("user2" . "password2"))))
19828 @end lisp
19829
19830 @end table
19831 @end deftp
19832
19833
19834 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
19835 @cindex darkstat
19836 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
19837 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
19838
19839 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
19840 This is the service type for the
19841 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
19842 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
19843 this example:
19844
19845 @lisp
19846 (service darkstat-service-type
19847 (darkstat-configuration
19848 (interface "eno1")))
19849 @end lisp
19850 @end defvar
19851
19852 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
19853 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
19854
19855 @table @asis
19856 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
19857 The darkstat package to use.
19858
19859 @item @code{interface}
19860 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
19861
19862 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
19863 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
19864
19865 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19866 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
19867
19868 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
19869 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
19870 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
19871
19872 @end table
19873 @end deftp
19874
19875 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
19876
19877 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
19878 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
19879 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
19880 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
19881 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
19882
19883 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
19884 This is the service type for the
19885 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
19886 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
19887 record as in this example:
19888
19889 @lisp
19890 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
19891 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
19892 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
19893 @end lisp
19894 @end defvar
19895
19896 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
19897 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
19898
19899 @table @asis
19900 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
19901 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
19902
19903 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
19904 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
19905
19906 @end table
19907 @end deftp
19908
19909 @subsubheading Zabbix server
19910 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
19911 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
19912 and disk space consumption:
19913
19914 @itemize
19915 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
19916 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
19917 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
19918 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
19919 @item Native high performance agents.
19920 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
19921 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
19922 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
19923 @end itemize
19924
19925 @c %start of fragment
19926
19927 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
19928
19929 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
19930 The zabbix-server package.
19931
19932 @end deftypevr
19933
19934 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
19935 User who will run the Zabbix server.
19936
19937 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19938
19939 @end deftypevr
19940
19941 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
19942 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
19943
19944 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19945
19946 @end deftypevr
19947
19948 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
19949 Database host name.
19950
19951 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
19952
19953 @end deftypevr
19954
19955 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
19956 Database name.
19957
19958 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19959
19960 @end deftypevr
19961
19962 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
19963 Database user.
19964
19965 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19966
19967 @end deftypevr
19968
19969 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
19970 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
19971 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
19972
19973 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19974
19975 @end deftypevr
19976
19977 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
19978 Database port.
19979
19980 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
19981
19982 @end deftypevr
19983
19984 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
19985 Specifies where log messages are written to:
19986
19987 @itemize @bullet
19988 @item
19989 @code{system} - syslog.
19990
19991 @item
19992 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
19993
19994 @item
19995 @code{console} - standard output.
19996
19997 @end itemize
19998
19999 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20000
20001 @end deftypevr
20002
20003 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
20004 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
20005
20006 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
20007
20008 @end deftypevr
20009
20010 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20011 Name of PID file.
20012
20013 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
20014
20015 @end deftypevr
20016
20017 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
20018 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
20019 certificate verification.
20020
20021 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
20022
20023 @end deftypevr
20024
20025 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
20026 Location of SSL client certificates.
20027
20028 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
20029
20030 @end deftypevr
20031
20032 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
20033 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
20034
20035 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20036
20037 @end deftypevr
20038
20039 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
20040 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
20041 configuration file.
20042
20043 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20044
20045 @end deftypevr
20046
20047 @c %end of fragment
20048
20049 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
20050 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
20051
20052 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
20053
20054 @c %start of fragment
20055
20056 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
20057
20058 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
20059 The zabbix-agent package.
20060
20061 @end deftypevr
20062
20063 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
20064 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
20065
20066 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
20067
20068 @end deftypevr
20069
20070 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
20071 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
20072
20073 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
20074
20075 @end deftypevr
20076
20077 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
20078 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
20079 must match hostname as configured on the server.
20080
20081 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
20082
20083 @end deftypevr
20084
20085 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
20086 Specifies where log messages are written to:
20087
20088 @itemize @bullet
20089 @item
20090 @code{system} - syslog.
20091
20092 @item
20093 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
20094
20095 @item
20096 @code{console} - standard output.
20097
20098 @end itemize
20099
20100 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20101
20102 @end deftypevr
20103
20104 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
20105 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
20106
20107 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
20108
20109 @end deftypevr
20110
20111 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20112 Name of PID file.
20113
20114 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
20115
20116 @end deftypevr
20117
20118 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
20119 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
20120 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
20121 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
20122
20123 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
20124
20125 @end deftypevr
20126
20127 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
20128 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
20129 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
20130 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
20131
20132 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
20133
20134 @end deftypevr
20135
20136 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
20137 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
20138
20139 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20140
20141 @end deftypevr
20142
20143 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
20144 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
20145 configuration file.
20146
20147 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20148
20149 @end deftypevr
20150
20151 @c %end of fragment
20152
20153 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
20154 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
20155
20156 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
20157
20158 @c %start of fragment
20159
20160 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
20161
20162 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
20163 NGINX configuration.
20164
20165 @end deftypevr
20166
20167 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
20168 Database host name.
20169
20170 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
20171
20172 @end deftypevr
20173
20174 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
20175 Database port.
20176
20177 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
20178
20179 @end deftypevr
20180
20181 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
20182 Database name.
20183
20184 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
20185
20186 @end deftypevr
20187
20188 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
20189 Database user.
20190
20191 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
20192
20193 @end deftypevr
20194
20195 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
20196 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
20197
20198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20199
20200 @end deftypevr
20201
20202 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
20203 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
20204 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
20205 to create it manually.
20206
20207 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20208
20209 @end deftypevr
20210
20211 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
20212 Zabbix server hostname.
20213
20214 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
20215
20216 @end deftypevr
20217
20218 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
20219 Zabbix server port.
20220
20221 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
20222
20223 @end deftypevr
20224
20225
20226 @c %end of fragment
20227
20228 @node Kerberos Services
20229 @subsection Kerberos Services
20230 @cindex Kerberos
20231
20232 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
20233 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
20234
20235 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
20236
20237 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
20238 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
20239 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
20240 operating system declaration.
20241 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
20242
20243 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
20244 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
20245 Other implementations have not been tested.
20246
20247 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
20248 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
20249 @end defvr
20250
20251 @noindent
20252 Here is an example of its use:
20253 @lisp
20254 (service krb5-service-type
20255 (krb5-configuration
20256 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
20257 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
20258 (realms (list
20259 (krb5-realm
20260 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
20261 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
20262 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
20263 (krb5-realm
20264 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
20265 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
20266 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
20267 @end lisp
20268
20269 @noindent
20270 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
20271 @itemize
20272 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
20273 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
20274 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
20275 specified by clients;
20276 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
20277 @end itemize
20278
20279 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
20280 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
20281 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
20282 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
20283 documentation.
20284
20285
20286 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
20287 @cindex realm, kerberos
20288 @table @asis
20289 @item @code{name}
20290 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
20291 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
20292 converted to upper case.
20293
20294 @item @code{admin-server}
20295 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
20296 running.
20297
20298 @item @code{kdc}
20299 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
20300 for the realm.
20301 @end table
20302 @end deftp
20303
20304 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
20305
20306 @table @asis
20307 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
20308 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
20309 known to be weak will be accepted.
20310
20311 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
20312 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
20313 realm for the client.
20314 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
20315 If this value is @code{#f}
20316 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
20317 such as @command{kinit}.
20318
20319 @item @code{realms}
20320 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
20321 access.
20322 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
20323 field.
20324 @end table
20325 @end deftp
20326
20327
20328 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
20329 @cindex pam-krb5
20330
20331 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
20332 management via Kerberos.
20333 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
20334 users using Kerberos.
20335
20336 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
20337 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
20338 @end defvr
20339
20340 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
20341 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
20342 This type has the following parameters:
20343 @table @asis
20344 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
20345 The pam-krb5 package to use.
20346
20347 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
20348 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
20349 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
20350 @end table
20351 @end deftp
20352
20353
20354 @node LDAP Services
20355 @subsection LDAP Services
20356 @cindex LDAP
20357 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
20358
20359 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
20360 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
20361 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
20362 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
20363 Switch} for detailed information.
20364
20365 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
20366 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
20367 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
20368
20369 @lisp
20370 (use-service-modules authentication)
20371 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
20372 ...
20373 (operating-system
20374 ...
20375 (services
20376 (cons*
20377 (service nslcd-service-type)
20378 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
20379 %base-services))
20380 (name-service-switch
20381 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
20382 (name-service (name "files"))
20383 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
20384 (name-service-switch
20385 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
20386 (password services)
20387 (shadow services)
20388 (group services)
20389 (netgroup services)
20390 (gshadow services)))))
20391 @end lisp
20392
20393 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
20394
20395 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
20396
20397 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
20398 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
20399
20400 @end deftypevr
20401
20402 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
20403 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
20404 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
20405 The default is to start 5 threads.
20406
20407 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20408
20409 @end deftypevr
20410
20411 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
20412 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
20413
20414 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
20415
20416 @end deftypevr
20417
20418 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
20419 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
20420
20421 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
20422
20423 @end deftypevr
20424
20425 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
20426 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
20427 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
20428 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
20429 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
20430 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
20431 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
20432 specified log level or higher are logged.
20433
20434 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
20435
20436 @end deftypevr
20437
20438 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
20439 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
20440 used with the following servers as fall-back.
20441
20442 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
20443
20444 @end deftypevr
20445
20446 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
20447 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
20448 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
20449
20450 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20451
20452 @end deftypevr
20453
20454 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
20455 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
20456 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
20457
20458 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20459
20460 @end deftypevr
20461
20462 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
20463 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
20464 applicable when used with binddn.
20465
20466 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20467
20468 @end deftypevr
20469
20470 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
20471 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
20472 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
20473
20474 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20475
20476 @end deftypevr
20477
20478 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
20479 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
20480 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
20481 rootpwmoddn
20482
20483 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20484
20485 @end deftypevr
20486
20487 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
20488 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
20489 authentication.
20490
20491 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20492
20493 @end deftypevr
20494
20495 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
20496 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
20497
20498 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20499
20500 @end deftypevr
20501
20502 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
20503 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
20504 authentication.
20505
20506 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20507
20508 @end deftypevr
20509
20510 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
20511 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
20512 authentication.
20513
20514 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20515
20516 @end deftypevr
20517
20518 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
20519 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
20520 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
20521 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
20522 performed or not.
20523
20524 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20525
20526 @end deftypevr
20527
20528 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
20529 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
20530
20531 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20532
20533 @end deftypevr
20534
20535 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
20536 The directory search base.
20537
20538 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
20539
20540 @end deftypevr
20541
20542 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
20543 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
20544 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
20545 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
20546
20547 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
20548
20549 @end deftypevr
20550
20551 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
20552 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
20553 to never dereference aliases.
20554
20555 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20556
20557 @end deftypevr
20558
20559 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
20560 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
20561 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
20562
20563 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20564
20565 @end deftypevr
20566
20567 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
20568 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
20569 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
20570 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
20571 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
20572
20573 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20574
20575 @end deftypevr
20576
20577 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
20578 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
20579 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
20580
20581 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20582
20583 @end deftypevr
20584
20585 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
20586 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
20587 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
20588
20589 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20590
20591 @end deftypevr
20592
20593 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
20594 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
20595 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
20596 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
20597
20598 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20599
20600 @end deftypevr
20601
20602 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
20603 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
20604 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
20605 out connections.
20606
20607 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20608
20609 @end deftypevr
20610
20611 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
20612 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
20613 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
20614 failure and the first retry.
20615
20616 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20617
20618 @end deftypevr
20619
20620 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
20621 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
20622 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
20623 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
20624
20625 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20626
20627 @end deftypevr
20628
20629 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
20630 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
20631 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
20632 SSL.
20633
20634 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20635
20636 @end deftypevr
20637
20638 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
20639 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
20640 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
20641
20642 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20643
20644 @end deftypevr
20645
20646 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
20647 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
20648 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
20649
20650 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20651
20652 @end deftypevr
20653
20654 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
20655 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
20656
20657 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20658
20659 @end deftypevr
20660
20661 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
20662 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
20663 using GnuTLS.
20664
20665 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20666
20667 @end deftypevr
20668
20669 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
20670 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
20671
20672 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20673
20674 @end deftypevr
20675
20676 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
20677 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
20678 client TLS authentication.
20679
20680 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20681
20682 @end deftypevr
20683
20684 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
20685 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
20686 authentication.
20687
20688 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20689
20690 @end deftypevr
20691
20692 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
20693 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
20694 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
20695 request paged results.
20696
20697 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20698
20699 @end deftypevr
20700
20701 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
20702 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
20703 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
20704 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
20705
20706 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20707
20708 @end deftypevr
20709
20710 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
20711 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
20712 the specified value are ignored.
20713
20714 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20715
20716 @end deftypevr
20717
20718 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
20719 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
20720 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
20721
20722 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20723
20724 @end deftypevr
20725
20726 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
20727 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
20728 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
20729
20730 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20731
20732 @end deftypevr
20733
20734 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
20735 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
20736 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
20737 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
20738 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
20739 groups.
20740
20741 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20742
20743 @end deftypevr
20744
20745 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
20746 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
20747 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
20748 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
20749 groups assigned on login.
20750
20751 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20752
20753 @end deftypevr
20754
20755 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
20756 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
20757 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
20758 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
20759 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
20760 most configurations.
20761
20762 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20763
20764 @end deftypevr
20765
20766 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
20767 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
20768 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
20769 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
20770
20771 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20772
20773 @end deftypevr
20774
20775 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
20776 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
20777 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
20778 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
20779 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
20780
20781 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20782
20783 @end deftypevr
20784
20785 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
20786 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
20787 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
20788
20789 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20790
20791 @end deftypevr
20792
20793 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
20794 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
20795 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
20796 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
20797 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
20798 It should return at least one entry.
20799
20800 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20801
20802 @end deftypevr
20803
20804 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
20805 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
20806 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
20807 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
20808
20809 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20810
20811 @end deftypevr
20812
20813 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
20814 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
20815 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
20816 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
20817 changing their password.
20818
20819 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
20820
20821 @end deftypevr
20822
20823 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
20824 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
20825
20826 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20827
20828 @end deftypevr
20829
20830 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
20831
20832
20833 @node Web Services
20834 @subsection Web Services
20835
20836 @cindex web
20837 @cindex www
20838 @cindex HTTP
20839 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
20840 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
20841
20842 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
20843
20844 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
20845 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
20846 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
20847 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
20848
20849 A simple example configuration is given below.
20850
20851 @lisp
20852 (service httpd-service-type
20853 (httpd-configuration
20854 (config
20855 (httpd-config-file
20856 (server-name "www.example.com")
20857 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
20858 @end lisp
20859
20860 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
20861 the configuration.
20862
20863 @lisp
20864 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
20865 (list
20866 (httpd-virtualhost
20867 "*:80"
20868 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
20869 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
20870 "\n")))))
20871 @end lisp
20872 @end deffn
20873
20874 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
20875 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
20876 given below.
20877
20878 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
20879 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
20880
20881 @table @asis
20882 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
20883 The httpd package to use.
20884
20885 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
20886 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
20887
20888 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
20889 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
20890 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
20891 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
20892 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
20893
20894 @end table
20895 @end deffn
20896
20897 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
20898 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
20899
20900 @table @asis
20901 @item @code{name}
20902 The name of the module.
20903
20904 @item @code{file}
20905 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
20906 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
20907 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
20908 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
20909
20910 @end table
20911 @end deffn
20912
20913 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
20914 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
20915 @end defvr
20916
20917 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
20918 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
20919
20920 @table @asis
20921 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
20922 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
20923 additional configuration.
20924
20925 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
20926 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
20927
20928 @lisp
20929 (service httpd-service-type
20930 (httpd-configuration
20931 (config
20932 (httpd-config-file
20933 (modules (cons*
20934 (httpd-module
20935 (name "proxy_module")
20936 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
20937 (httpd-module
20938 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
20939 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
20940 %default-httpd-modules))
20941 (extra-config (list "\
20942 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
20943 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
20944 </FilesMatch>"))))))
20945 (service php-fpm-service-type
20946 (php-fpm-configuration
20947 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
20948 (socket-group "httpd")))
20949 @end lisp
20950
20951 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
20952 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
20953 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
20954 taken as relative to the server root.
20955
20956 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
20957 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
20958 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
20959 itself.
20960
20961 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
20962 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
20963 @code{ServerName}.
20964
20965 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
20966 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
20967
20968 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
20969 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
20970 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
20971 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
20972 protocol to use.
20973
20974 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
20975 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
20976 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
20977 configured correctly.
20978
20979 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
20980 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
20981
20982 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20983 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
20984
20985 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20986 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
20987
20988 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
20989 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
20990 of the configuration file.
20991
20992 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
20993 list.
20994
20995 @end table
20996 @end deffn
20997
20998 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
20999 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
21000
21001 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
21002
21003 @lisp
21004 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
21005 (list
21006 (httpd-virtualhost
21007 "*:80"
21008 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
21009 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
21010 "\n")))))
21011 @end lisp
21012
21013 @table @asis
21014 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
21015 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
21016
21017 @item @code{contents}
21018 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
21019 of strings and G-expressions.
21020
21021 @end table
21022 @end deffn
21023
21024 @subsubheading NGINX
21025
21026 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
21027 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
21028 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
21029
21030 A simple example configuration is given below.
21031
21032 @lisp
21033 (service nginx-service-type
21034 (nginx-configuration
21035 (server-blocks
21036 (list (nginx-server-configuration
21037 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
21038 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
21039 @end lisp
21040
21041 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
21042 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
21043 blocks, as in this example:
21044
21045 @lisp
21046 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
21047 (list (nginx-server-configuration
21048 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
21049 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
21050 @end lisp
21051 @end deffn
21052
21053 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
21054 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
21055 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
21056 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
21057 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
21058 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
21059 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
21060 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
21061
21062 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
21063 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
21064 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
21065 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
21066
21067 @table @asis
21068 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
21069 The nginx package to use.
21070
21071 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
21072 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
21073
21074 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
21075 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
21076 files.
21077
21078 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
21079 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
21080 file, the elements should be of type
21081 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
21082
21083 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
21084 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
21085 HTTPS.
21086 @lisp
21087 (service nginx-service-type
21088 (nginx-configuration
21089 (server-blocks
21090 (list (nginx-server-configuration
21091 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
21092 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
21093 @end lisp
21094
21095 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
21096 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
21097 file, the elements should be of type
21098 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
21099
21100 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
21101 when combined with @code{locations} in the
21102 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
21103 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
21104 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
21105 requests with two servers.
21106
21107 @lisp
21108 (service
21109 nginx-service-type
21110 (nginx-configuration
21111 (server-blocks
21112 (list (nginx-server-configuration
21113 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
21114 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
21115 (locations
21116 (list
21117 (nginx-location-configuration
21118 (uri "/path1")
21119 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
21120 (upstream-blocks
21121 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
21122 (name "server-proxy")
21123 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
21124 "server2.example.com")))))))
21125 @end lisp
21126
21127 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
21128 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
21129 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
21130 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
21131 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
21132 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
21133
21134 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
21135 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
21136 nginx-configuration record.
21137
21138 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
21139 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
21140 use the size of the processors cache line.
21141
21142 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
21143 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
21144
21145 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
21146 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
21147 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
21148
21149 @lisp
21150 (modules
21151 (list
21152 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
21153 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")))
21154 @end lisp
21155
21156 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
21157 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
21158 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
21159
21160 @lisp
21161 (global-directives
21162 `((worker_processes . 16)
21163 (pcre_jit . on)
21164 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
21165 @end lisp
21166
21167 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
21168 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
21169 valued G-expression.
21170
21171 @end table
21172 @end deffn
21173
21174 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
21175 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
21176 This type has the following parameters:
21177
21178 @table @asis
21179 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
21180 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
21181 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
21182 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
21183 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
21184
21185 @lisp
21186 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
21187 @end lisp
21188
21189 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
21190 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
21191 default server for connections matching no other server.
21192
21193 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
21194 Root of the website nginx will serve.
21195
21196 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
21197 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
21198 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
21199 server block.
21200
21201 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
21202 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
21203 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
21204
21205 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
21206 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
21207 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
21208
21209 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
21210 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
21211 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
21212
21213 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
21214 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
21215 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
21216
21217 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
21218 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
21219
21220 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
21221 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
21222
21223 @end table
21224 @end deftp
21225
21226 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
21227 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
21228 block. This type has the following parameters:
21229
21230 @table @asis
21231 @item @code{name}
21232 Name for this group of servers.
21233
21234 @item @code{servers}
21235 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
21236 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
21237 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
21238 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
21239 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
21240 explicitly.
21241
21242 @end table
21243 @end deftp
21244
21245 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
21246 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
21247 block. This type has the following parameters:
21248
21249 @table @asis
21250 @item @code{uri}
21251 URI which this location block matches.
21252
21253 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
21254 @item @code{body}
21255 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
21256 many
21257 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
21258 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
21259 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
21260 http://upstream-name;")}.
21261
21262 @end table
21263 @end deftp
21264
21265 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
21266 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
21267 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
21268 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
21269 parameters:
21270
21271 @table @asis
21272 @item @code{name}
21273 Name to identify this location block.
21274
21275 @item @code{body}
21276 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
21277 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
21278 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
21279 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
21280
21281 @end table
21282 @end deftp
21283
21284 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
21285 @cindex Varnish
21286 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
21287 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
21288 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
21289 creates one request to the back-end.
21290
21291 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
21292 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
21293 @end defvr
21294
21295 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
21296 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
21297 This type has the following parameters:
21298
21299 @table @asis
21300 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
21301 The Varnish package to use.
21302
21303 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
21304 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
21305 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
21306 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
21307 directory name.
21308
21309 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
21310 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
21311
21312 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
21313 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
21314
21315 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
21316 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
21317 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
21318 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
21319 VCL syntax.
21320
21321 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
21322 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
21323 can do something along these lines:
21324
21325 @lisp
21326 (define %gnu-mirror
21327 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
21328 "vcl 4.1;
21329 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
21330
21331 (operating-system
21332 ;; @dots{}
21333 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
21334 (varnish-configuration
21335 (listen '(":80"))
21336 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
21337 %base-services)))
21338 @end lisp
21339
21340 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
21341 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
21342
21343 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
21344 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
21345 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
21346
21347 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
21348 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
21349
21350 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
21351 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
21352
21353 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
21354 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
21355
21356 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
21357 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
21358
21359 @end table
21360 @end deftp
21361
21362 @subsubheading Patchwork
21363 @cindex Patchwork
21364 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
21365 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
21366
21367 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
21368 Service type for Patchwork.
21369 @end defvr
21370
21371 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
21372 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
21373
21374 @lisp
21375 (service patchwork-service-type
21376 (patchwork-configuration
21377 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
21378 (settings-module
21379 (patchwork-settings-module
21380 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
21381 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
21382 (getmail-retriever-config
21383 (getmail-retriever-configuration
21384 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
21385 (server "imap.example.com")
21386 (port 993)
21387 (username "patchwork")
21388 (password-command
21389 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
21390 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
21391 (extra-parameters
21392 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
21393
21394 @end lisp
21395
21396 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
21397 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
21398 within the HTTPD service.
21399
21400 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
21401 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
21402 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
21403
21404 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
21405 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
21406 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
21407
21408 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
21409 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
21410 following parameters:
21411
21412 @table @asis
21413 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
21414 The Patchwork package to use.
21415
21416 @item @code{domain}
21417 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
21418 host.
21419
21420 @item @code{settings-module}
21421 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
21422 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
21423 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
21424 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
21425 store.
21426
21427 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
21428 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
21429
21430 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
21431 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
21432 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
21433 delivered to Patchwork.
21434
21435 @end table
21436 @end deftp
21437
21438 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
21439 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
21440 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
21441 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
21442 has the following parameters:
21443
21444 @table @asis
21445 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
21446 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
21447 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
21448
21449 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
21450 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
21451 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
21452
21453 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
21454 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
21455
21456 This setting relates to Django.
21457
21458 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
21459 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
21460 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
21461
21462 This is a Django setting.
21463
21464 @item @code{default-from-email}
21465 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
21466
21467 This is a Patchwork setting.
21468
21469 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
21470 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
21471 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
21472
21473 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
21474 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
21475
21476 This is a Django setting.
21477
21478 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
21479 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
21480 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
21481
21482 This is a Django setting.
21483
21484 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
21485 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
21486 messages will be shown.
21487
21488 This is a Django setting.
21489
21490 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
21491 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
21492
21493 This is a Patchwork setting.
21494
21495 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
21496 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
21497
21498 This is a Patchwork setting.
21499
21500 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
21501 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
21502
21503 This is a Patchwork setting.
21504
21505 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
21506 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
21507
21508 @end table
21509 @end deftp
21510
21511 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
21512 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
21513
21514 @table @asis
21515 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
21516 The database engine to use.
21517
21518 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
21519 The name of the database to use.
21520
21521 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
21522 The user to connect to the database as.
21523
21524 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
21525 The password to use when connecting to the database.
21526
21527 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
21528 The host to make the database connection to.
21529
21530 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
21531 The port on which to connect to the database.
21532
21533 @end table
21534 @end deftp
21535
21536 @subsubheading Mumi
21537
21538 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
21539 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
21540 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
21541 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
21542 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
21543 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
21544
21545 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
21546 This is the service type for Mumi.
21547 @end defvr
21548
21549 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
21550 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
21551 following fields:
21552
21553 @table @asis
21554 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
21555 The Mumi package to use.
21556
21557 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
21558 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
21559
21560 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
21561 The email address used as the sender for comments.
21562
21563 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
21564 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
21565 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
21566 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
21567 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
21568
21569 @end table
21570 @end deftp
21571
21572
21573 @subsubheading FastCGI
21574 @cindex fastcgi
21575 @cindex fcgiwrap
21576 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
21577 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
21578 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
21579 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
21580 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
21581 support for it in Guix.
21582
21583 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
21584 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
21585 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
21586 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
21587 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
21588 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
21589
21590 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
21591 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
21592 @end defvr
21593
21594 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
21595 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
21596 This type has the following parameters:
21597 @table @asis
21598 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
21599 The fcgiwrap package to use.
21600
21601 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
21602 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
21603 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
21604 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
21605 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
21606 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
21607
21608 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
21609 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
21610 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
21611 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
21612 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
21613 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
21614
21615 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
21616 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
21617 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
21618 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
21619 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
21620 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
21621 @end table
21622 @end deftp
21623
21624 @cindex php-fpm
21625 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
21626 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
21627
21628 These features include:
21629 @itemize @bullet
21630 @item Adaptive process spawning
21631 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
21632 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
21633 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
21634 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
21635 @item Stdout & stderr logging
21636 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
21637 @item Accelerated upload support
21638 @item Support for a "slowlog"
21639 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
21640 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
21641 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
21642 @end itemize
21643 ...@: and much more.
21644
21645 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
21646 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
21647 @end defvr
21648
21649 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
21650 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
21651 @table @asis
21652 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
21653 The php package to use.
21654 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
21655 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
21656 @table @asis
21657 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
21658 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
21659 @item @code{"port"}
21660 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
21661 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
21662 Listen on a unix socket.
21663 @end table
21664
21665 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
21666 User who will own the php worker processes.
21667 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
21668 Group of the worker processes.
21669 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
21670 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
21671 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
21672 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
21673 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
21674 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
21675 once the service has started.
21676 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
21677 Log for the php-fpm master process.
21678 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
21679 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
21680 Must be one of:
21681 @table @asis
21682 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
21683 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
21684 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
21685 @end table
21686 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
21687 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
21688 and displayed in their browsers.
21689 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
21690 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
21691 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
21692 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
21693 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
21694 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
21695 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
21696 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
21697 An optional override of the whole configuration.
21698 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
21699 @end table
21700 @end deftp
21701
21702 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
21703 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
21704 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
21705 based on it's configured limits.
21706 @table @asis
21707 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
21708 Maximum of worker processes.
21709 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
21710 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
21711 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
21712 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
21713 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
21714 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
21715 @end table
21716 @end deftp
21717
21718 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
21719 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
21720 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
21721 are created.
21722 @table @asis
21723 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
21724 Maximum of worker processes.
21725 @end table
21726 @end deftp
21727
21728 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
21729 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
21730 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
21731 requests arrive.
21732 @table @asis
21733 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
21734 Maximum of worker processes.
21735 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
21736 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
21737 @end table
21738 @end deftp
21739
21740
21741 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
21742 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
21743 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
21744 (version-major (package-version php)) @
21745 "-fpm.sock")]
21746 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
21747 @end deffn
21748
21749 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
21750 @lisp
21751 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
21752 (service php-fpm-service-type)
21753 (service nginx-service-type
21754 (nginx-server-configuration
21755 (server-name '("example.com"))
21756 (root "/srv/http/")
21757 (locations
21758 (list (nginx-php-location)))
21759 (listen '("80"))
21760 (ssl-certificate #f)
21761 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
21762 %base-services))
21763 @end lisp
21764
21765 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
21766 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
21767 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
21768 the hash of a user's email address.
21769
21770 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
21771 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
21772 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
21773 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
21774 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
21775 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
21776 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
21777 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
21778 @end deffn
21779
21780 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
21781 @lisp
21782 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
21783 #:configuration
21784 (nginx-server-configuration
21785 (server-name '("example.com"))))
21786 ...
21787 %base-services))
21788 @end lisp
21789
21790 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
21791
21792 @cindex hpcguix-web
21793 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
21794 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
21795 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
21796 clusters.
21797
21798 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
21799 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
21800 @end defvr
21801
21802 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
21803 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
21804
21805 @table @asis
21806 @item @code{specs}
21807 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
21808 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
21809
21810 @table @asis
21811 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
21812 The page title prefix.
21813
21814 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
21815 The @command{guix} command.
21816
21817 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
21818 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
21819
21820 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
21821 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
21822
21823 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
21824 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
21825
21826 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
21827 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
21828
21829 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
21830 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
21831 the latest instances of the given channels.
21832 @end table
21833
21834 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
21835 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
21836 complete example}.
21837
21838 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
21839 The hpcguix-web package to use.
21840 @end table
21841 @end deftp
21842
21843 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
21844
21845 @lisp
21846 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
21847 (hpcguix-web-configuration
21848 (specs
21849 #~(define site-config
21850 (hpcweb-configuration
21851 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
21852 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
21853 @end lisp
21854
21855 @quotation Note
21856 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
21857 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
21858 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
21859 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
21860
21861 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
21862 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
21863 more information on X.509 certificates.
21864 @end quotation
21865
21866 @node Certificate Services
21867 @subsection Certificate Services
21868
21869 @cindex Web
21870 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
21871 @cindex Let's Encrypt
21872 @cindex TLS certificates
21873 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
21874 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
21875 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
21876 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
21877 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
21878 authenticity.
21879
21880 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
21881 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
21882 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
21883 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
21884 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
21885 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
21886 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
21887 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
21888 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
21889 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
21890 signature.
21891
21892 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
21893 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
21894 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
21895 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
21896 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
21897 with different permissions).
21898
21899 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
21900 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
21901 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
21902 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
21903 some reason.
21904
21905 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
21906 can be found there:
21907 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
21908
21909 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
21910 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
21911 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
21912
21913 @lisp
21914 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
21915 (program-file
21916 "nginx-deploy-hook"
21917 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
21918 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
21919
21920 (service certbot-service-type
21921 (certbot-configuration
21922 (email "foo@@example.net")
21923 (certificates
21924 (list
21925 (certificate-configuration
21926 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
21927 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
21928 (certificate-configuration
21929 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
21930 @end lisp
21931
21932 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
21933 @end defvr
21934
21935 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
21936 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
21937 This type has the following parameters:
21938
21939 @table @asis
21940 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
21941 The certbot package to use.
21942
21943 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
21944 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
21945 files.
21946
21947 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
21948 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
21949 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
21950 and several @code{domains}.
21951
21952 @item @code{email}
21953 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
21954 account notifications.
21955
21956 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
21957 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
21958 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
21959
21960 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
21961 Size of the RSA key.
21962
21963 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
21964 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
21965 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
21966 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
21967 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
21968 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
21969 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
21970 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
21971 these nginx configuration data types.
21972
21973 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
21974 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
21975 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
21976
21977 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
21978 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
21979 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
21980
21981 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
21982 @end table
21983 @end deftp
21984
21985 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
21986 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
21987 This type has the following parameters:
21988
21989 @table @asis
21990 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
21991 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
21992 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
21993 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
21994
21995 Its default is the first provided domain.
21996
21997 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
21998 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
21999 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
22000
22001 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
22002 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
22003 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
22004 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
22005 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
22006 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
22007 requesting machine.
22008
22009 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
22010 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
22011 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
22012 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
22013 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
22014 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
22015
22016 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
22017 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
22018 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
22019 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
22020 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
22021 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
22022
22023 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
22024 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
22025 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
22026 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
22027 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
22028 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
22029 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
22030 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
22031
22032 @end table
22033 @end deftp
22034
22035 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
22036 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
22037 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
22038 @node DNS Services
22039 @subsection DNS Services
22040 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
22041 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
22042
22043 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
22044 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
22045 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
22046 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
22047 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
22048 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
22049
22050 @subsubheading Knot Service
22051
22052 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
22053 and one slave, is:
22054
22055 @lisp
22056 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
22057 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
22058 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
22059 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
22060 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
22061
22062 (define master-zone
22063 (knot-zone-configuration
22064 (domain "example.org")
22065 (zone (zone-file
22066 (origin "example.org")
22067 (entries example.org.zone)))))
22068
22069 (define slave-zone
22070 (knot-zone-configuration
22071 (domain "plop.org")
22072 (dnssec-policy "default")
22073 (master (list "plop-master"))))
22074
22075 (define plop-master
22076 (knot-remote-configuration
22077 (id "plop-master")
22078 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
22079
22080 (operating-system
22081 ;; ...
22082 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
22083 (knot-configuration
22084 (remotes (list plop-master))
22085 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
22086 ;; ...
22087 %base-services)))
22088 @end lisp
22089
22090 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
22091 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
22092
22093 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
22094 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
22095 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
22096 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
22097 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
22098 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
22099 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
22100
22101 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
22102 @end deffn
22103
22104 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
22105 Data type representing a key.
22106 This type has the following parameters:
22107
22108 @table @asis
22109 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
22110 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
22111 be unique and must not be empty.
22112
22113 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
22114 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
22115 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
22116 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
22117
22118 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
22119 The secret key itself.
22120
22121 @end table
22122 @end deftp
22123
22124 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
22125 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
22126 This type has the following parameters:
22127
22128 @table @asis
22129 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
22130 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
22131 unique and must not be empty.
22132
22133 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
22134 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
22135 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
22136 address match is not required.
22137
22138 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
22139 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
22140 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
22141 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
22142
22143 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
22144 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
22145 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
22146 and @code{'update}.
22147
22148 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
22149 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
22150 false, listed actions are allowed.
22151
22152 @end table
22153 @end deftp
22154
22155 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
22156 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
22157 This type has the following parameters:
22158
22159 @table @asis
22160 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
22161 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
22162 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
22163 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
22164 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
22165 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
22166
22167 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
22168 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
22169
22170 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
22171 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
22172 partially @code{"CH"}.
22173
22174 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
22175 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
22176 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
22177 defined.
22178
22179 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
22180 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
22181 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
22182 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
22183
22184 @end table
22185 @end deftp
22186
22187 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
22188 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
22189 This type has the following parameters:
22190
22191 @table @asis
22192 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
22193 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
22194 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
22195 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
22196 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
22197 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
22198 field of the @code{zone-file}.
22199
22200 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
22201 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
22202
22203 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
22204 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
22205 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
22206 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
22207 to an IP address in the list of entries.
22208
22209 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
22210 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
22211 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
22212
22213 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
22214 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
22215 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
22216 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
22217
22218 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
22219 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
22220 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
22221 @code{(string->duration)}.
22222
22223 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
22224 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
22225 to do so a first time.
22226
22227 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
22228 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
22229 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
22230 and check again that it still exists.
22231
22232 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
22233 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
22234 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
22235
22236 @end table
22237 @end deftp
22238
22239 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
22240 Data type representing a remote configuration.
22241 This type has the following parameters:
22242
22243 @table @asis
22244 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
22245 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
22246 be unique and must not be empty.
22247
22248 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
22249 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
22250 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
22251 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
22252
22253 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
22254 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
22255 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
22256 The default is to choose at random.
22257
22258 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
22259 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
22260 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
22261
22262 @end table
22263 @end deftp
22264
22265 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
22266 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
22267 This type has the following parameters:
22268
22269 @table @asis
22270 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
22271 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
22272
22273 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
22274 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
22275
22276 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
22277 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
22278 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
22279 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
22280
22281 @end table
22282 @end deftp
22283
22284 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
22285 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
22286 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
22287 use keys that you generate.
22288
22289 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
22290 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
22291 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
22292 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
22293 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
22294 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
22295
22296 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
22297 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
22298 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
22299 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
22300 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
22301
22302 This type has the following parameters:
22303
22304 @table @asis
22305 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
22306 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
22307
22308 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
22309 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
22310 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
22311 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
22312 was setup by this service).
22313
22314 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
22315 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
22316
22317 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
22318 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
22319
22320 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
22321 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
22322
22323 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
22324 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
22325 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
22326
22327 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
22328 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
22329 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
22330
22331 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
22332 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
22333 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
22334
22335 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
22336 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
22337
22338 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
22339 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
22340 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
22341
22342 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
22343 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
22344
22345 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
22346 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
22347
22348 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
22349 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
22350
22351 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
22352 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
22353
22354 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
22355 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
22356 name before hashing.
22357
22358 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
22359 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
22360
22361 @end table
22362 @end deftp
22363
22364 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
22365 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
22366 This type has the following parameters:
22367
22368 @table @asis
22369 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
22370 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
22371
22372 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
22373 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
22374 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
22375
22376 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
22377 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
22378 must contain a zone-file record.
22379
22380 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
22381 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
22382 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
22383
22384 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
22385 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
22386 masters.
22387
22388 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
22389 A list of slave remote identifiers.
22390
22391 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
22392 A list of acl identifiers.
22393
22394 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
22395 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
22396
22397 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
22398 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
22399
22400 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
22401 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
22402 synchronization.
22403
22404 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
22405 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
22406 are:
22407
22408 @itemize
22409 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
22410 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
22411 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
22412 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
22413 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
22414 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
22415 automatically.
22416 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
22417 @end itemize
22418
22419 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
22420 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
22421 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
22422 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
22423 default value from Knot is used.
22424
22425 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
22426 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
22427 so the default value from Knot is used.
22428
22429 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
22430 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
22431 default value from Knot is used.
22432
22433 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
22434 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
22435 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
22436 value from Knot is used.
22437
22438 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
22439 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
22440 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
22441 on this zone.
22442
22443 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
22444 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
22445
22446 @end table
22447 @end deftp
22448
22449 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
22450 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
22451 This type has the following parameters:
22452
22453 @table @asis
22454 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
22455 The Knot package.
22456
22457 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
22458 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
22459
22460 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
22461 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
22462 included at the top of the configuration file.
22463
22464 @cindex secrets, Knot service
22465 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
22466 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
22467 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
22468 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
22469 to the @code{includes} list.
22470
22471 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
22472 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
22473 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
22474 tsig key:
22475
22476 @example
22477 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
22478 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
22479 @end example
22480
22481 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
22482 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
22483 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
22484 to that key.
22485
22486 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
22487
22488 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
22489 An ip address on which to listen.
22490
22491 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
22492 An ip address on which to listen.
22493
22494 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
22495 A port on which to listen.
22496
22497 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
22498 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
22499
22500 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
22501 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
22502
22503 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
22504 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
22505
22506 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
22507 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
22508
22509 @end table
22510 @end deftp
22511
22512 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
22513
22514 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
22515 This this the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
22516 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
22517
22518 @lisp
22519 (service knot-resolver-service-type
22520 (knot-resolver-configuration
22521 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
22522 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
22523 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
22524 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
22525 cache.size = 100 * MB
22526 "))))
22527 @end lisp
22528
22529 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
22530 @end deffn
22531
22532 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
22533 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
22534
22535 @table @asis
22536 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
22537 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
22538
22539 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
22540 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
22541 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
22542
22543 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
22544 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
22545
22546 @end table
22547 @end deftp
22548
22549
22550 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
22551
22552 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
22553 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
22554 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
22555
22556 @lisp
22557 (service dnsmasq-service-type
22558 (dnsmasq-configuration
22559 (no-resolv? #t)
22560 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
22561 @end lisp
22562 @end deffn
22563
22564 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
22565 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
22566
22567 @table @asis
22568 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
22569 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
22570
22571 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
22572 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
22573
22574 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
22575 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
22576 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
22577
22578 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
22579 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
22580 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
22581
22582 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
22583 Listen on the given IP addresses.
22584
22585 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
22586 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
22587
22588 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
22589 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
22590
22591 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
22592 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
22593
22594 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
22595 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
22596 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
22597 replied to with the specified IP address.
22598
22599 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
22600
22601 @lisp
22602 (service dnsmasq-service-type
22603 (dnsmasq-configuration
22604 (addresses
22605 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
22606 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
22607 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
22608 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
22609 @end lisp
22610
22611 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
22612
22613 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
22614 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
22615 disables caching.
22616
22617 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
22618 When false, disable negative caching.
22619
22620 @end table
22621 @end deftp
22622
22623 @subsubheading ddclient Service
22624
22625 @cindex ddclient
22626 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
22627 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
22628 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
22629
22630 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
22631 configuration:
22632
22633 @lisp
22634 (service ddclient-service-type)
22635 @end lisp
22636
22637 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
22638 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
22639 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
22640 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
22641 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
22642 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
22643 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
22644
22645 @c %start of fragment
22646
22647 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
22648
22649 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
22650 The ddclient package.
22651
22652 @end deftypevr
22653
22654 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
22655 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
22656
22657 Defaults to @samp{300}.
22658
22659 @end deftypevr
22660
22661 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
22662 Use syslog for the output.
22663
22664 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22665
22666 @end deftypevr
22667
22668 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
22669 Mail to user.
22670
22671 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
22672
22673 @end deftypevr
22674
22675 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
22676 Mail failed update to user.
22677
22678 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
22679
22680 @end deftypevr
22681
22682 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
22683 The ddclient PID file.
22684
22685 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
22686
22687 @end deftypevr
22688
22689 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
22690 Enable SSL support.
22691
22692 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22693
22694 @end deftypevr
22695
22696 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
22697 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
22698 program.
22699
22700 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
22701
22702 @end deftypevr
22703
22704 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
22705 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
22706
22707 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
22708
22709 @end deftypevr
22710
22711 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
22712 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
22713 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
22714 create it manually.
22715
22716 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
22717
22718 @end deftypevr
22719
22720 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
22721 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
22722
22723 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22724
22725 @end deftypevr
22726
22727
22728 @c %end of fragment
22729
22730
22731 @node VPN Services
22732 @subsection VPN Services
22733 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
22734 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
22735
22736 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
22737 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
22738 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
22739 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
22740
22741 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
22742 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
22743
22744 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
22745 @end deffn
22746
22747 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
22748 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
22749
22750 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
22751
22752 Both can be run simultaneously.
22753 @end deffn
22754
22755 @c %automatically generated documentation
22756
22757 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
22758
22759 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
22760 The OpenVPN package.
22761
22762 @end deftypevr
22763
22764 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22765 The OpenVPN pid file.
22766
22767 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
22768
22769 @end deftypevr
22770
22771 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
22772 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
22773 servers.
22774
22775 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
22776
22777 @end deftypevr
22778
22779 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
22780 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
22781
22782 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
22783
22784 @end deftypevr
22785
22786 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
22787 The certificate authority to check connections against.
22788
22789 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
22790
22791 @end deftypevr
22792
22793 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
22794 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
22795 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
22796
22797 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
22798
22799 @end deftypevr
22800
22801 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
22802 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
22803 certificate is @code{cert}.
22804
22805 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
22806
22807 @end deftypevr
22808
22809 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
22810 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
22811
22812 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22813
22814 @end deftypevr
22815
22816 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
22817 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
22818
22819 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22820
22821 @end deftypevr
22822
22823 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
22824 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
22825 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
22826
22827 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22828
22829 @end deftypevr
22830
22831 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
22832 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
22833 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
22834
22835 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22836 @end deftypevr
22837
22838 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
22839 Verbosity level.
22840
22841 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22842
22843 @end deftypevr
22844
22845 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
22846 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
22847 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
22848
22849 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22850
22851 @end deftypevr
22852
22853 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
22854 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
22855 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
22856 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
22857
22858 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
22859 @end deftypevr
22860
22861 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
22862 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
22863
22864 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22865
22866 @end deftypevr
22867
22868 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
22869 Bind to a specific local port number.
22870
22871 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22872
22873 @end deftypevr
22874
22875 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
22876 Retry resolving server address.
22877
22878 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22879
22880 @end deftypevr
22881
22882 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
22883 A list of remote servers to connect to.
22884
22885 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22886
22887 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
22888
22889 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
22890 Server name.
22891
22892 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
22893
22894 @end deftypevr
22895
22896 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
22897 Port number the server listens to.
22898
22899 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
22900
22901 @end deftypevr
22902
22903 @end deftypevr
22904 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
22905
22906 @c %automatically generated documentation
22907
22908 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
22909
22910 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
22911 The OpenVPN package.
22912
22913 @end deftypevr
22914
22915 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22916 The OpenVPN pid file.
22917
22918 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
22919
22920 @end deftypevr
22921
22922 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
22923 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
22924 servers.
22925
22926 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
22927
22928 @end deftypevr
22929
22930 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
22931 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
22932
22933 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
22934
22935 @end deftypevr
22936
22937 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
22938 The certificate authority to check connections against.
22939
22940 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
22941
22942 @end deftypevr
22943
22944 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
22945 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
22946 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
22947
22948 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
22949
22950 @end deftypevr
22951
22952 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
22953 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
22954 certificate is @code{cert}.
22955
22956 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
22957
22958 @end deftypevr
22959
22960 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
22961 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
22962
22963 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22964
22965 @end deftypevr
22966
22967 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
22968 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
22969
22970 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22971
22972 @end deftypevr
22973
22974 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
22975 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
22976 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
22977
22978 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22979
22980 @end deftypevr
22981
22982 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
22983 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
22984 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
22985
22986 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22987 @end deftypevr
22988
22989 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
22990 Verbosity level.
22991
22992 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22993
22994 @end deftypevr
22995
22996 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
22997 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
22998 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
22999
23000 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23001
23002 @end deftypevr
23003
23004 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
23005 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
23006
23007 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
23008
23009 @end deftypevr
23010
23011 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
23012 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
23013
23014 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
23015
23016 @end deftypevr
23017
23018 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
23019 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
23020
23021 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23022
23023 @end deftypevr
23024
23025 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
23026 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
23027
23028 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
23029
23030 @end deftypevr
23031
23032 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
23033 The file that records client IPs.
23034
23035 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
23036
23037 @end deftypevr
23038
23039 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
23040 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
23041
23042 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23043
23044 @end deftypevr
23045
23046 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
23047 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
23048
23049 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23050
23051 @end deftypevr
23052
23053 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
23054 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
23055 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
23056 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
23057 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
23058 down.
23059
23060 @end deftypevr
23061
23062 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
23063 The maximum number of clients.
23064
23065 Defaults to @samp{100}.
23066
23067 @end deftypevr
23068
23069 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
23070 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
23071 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
23072
23073 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
23074
23075 @end deftypevr
23076
23077 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
23078 The list of configuration for some clients.
23079
23080 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23081
23082 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
23083
23084 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
23085 Client name.
23086
23087 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
23088
23089 @end deftypevr
23090
23091 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
23092 Client own network
23093
23094 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23095
23096 @end deftypevr
23097
23098 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
23099 Client VPN IP.
23100
23101 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23102
23103 @end deftypevr
23104
23105 @end deftypevr
23106
23107
23108 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
23109
23110
23111 @node Network File System
23112 @subsection Network File System
23113 @cindex NFS
23114
23115 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
23116 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
23117 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
23118
23119 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
23120 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
23121 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
23122
23123 @subsubheading NFS Service
23124 @cindex NFS, server
23125
23126 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
23127 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
23128 the locations that NFS expects.
23129
23130 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
23131 A service type for a complete NFS server.
23132 @end defvr
23133
23134 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
23135 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
23136 of its subsystems.
23137
23138 It has the following parameters:
23139 @table @asis
23140 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
23141 The nfs-utils package to use.
23142
23143 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
23144 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
23145 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
23146
23147 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
23148 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
23149 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
23150 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
23151 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
23152
23153 @lisp
23154 (nfs-configuration
23155 (exports
23156 '(("/export"
23157 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
23158 @end lisp
23159
23160 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
23161 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
23162
23163 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
23164 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
23165
23166 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
23167 The rpcbind package to use.
23168
23169 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
23170 The local NFSv4 domain name.
23171
23172 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
23173 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
23174
23175 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
23176 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
23177
23178 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
23179 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
23180
23181 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
23182 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
23183
23184 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
23185 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
23186
23187 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
23188 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
23189 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
23190 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
23191 @end table
23192 @end deftp
23193
23194 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
23195 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
23196
23197 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
23198 @cindex rpcbind
23199
23200 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
23201 universal addresses.
23202 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
23203 started when a dependent service starts.
23204
23205 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
23206 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
23207 @end defvr
23208
23209
23210 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
23211 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
23212 This type has the following parameters:
23213 @table @asis
23214 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
23215 The rpcbind package to use.
23216
23217 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
23218 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
23219 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
23220 instance.
23221 @end table
23222 @end deftp
23223
23224
23225 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
23226 @cindex pipefs
23227 @cindex rpc_pipefs
23228
23229 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
23230 between the kernel and user space programs.
23231
23232 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
23233 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
23234 @end defvr
23235
23236 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
23237 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
23238 This type has the following parameters:
23239 @table @asis
23240 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
23241 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
23242 @end table
23243 @end deftp
23244
23245
23246 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
23247 @cindex GSSD
23248 @cindex GSS
23249 @cindex global security system
23250
23251 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
23252 based protocols.
23253 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
23254 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
23255 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
23256
23257 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
23258 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
23259 @end defvr
23260
23261 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
23262 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
23263 This type has the following parameters:
23264 @table @asis
23265 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
23266 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
23267
23268 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
23269 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
23270
23271 @end table
23272 @end deftp
23273
23274
23275 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
23276 @cindex idmapd
23277 @cindex name mapper
23278
23279 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
23280 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
23281
23282 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
23283 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
23284 @end defvr
23285
23286 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
23287 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
23288 This type has the following parameters:
23289 @table @asis
23290 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
23291 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
23292
23293 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
23294 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
23295
23296 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
23297 The local NFSv4 domain name.
23298 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
23299 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
23300
23301 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
23302 The verbosity level of the daemon.
23303
23304 @end table
23305 @end deftp
23306
23307 @node Continuous Integration
23308 @subsection Continuous Integration
23309
23310 @cindex continuous integration
23311 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
23312 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
23313 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
23314
23315 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
23316
23317 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
23318 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
23319 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
23320 @end defvr
23321
23322 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
23323 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
23324 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
23325 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
23326 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
23327
23328 @lisp
23329 (define %cuirass-specs
23330 #~(list
23331 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
23332 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
23333 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
23334 (#:proc-input . "guix")
23335 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
23336 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
23337 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
23338 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
23339 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
23340 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
23341 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
23342 (#:load-path . ".")
23343 (#:branch . "master")
23344 (#:no-compile? . #t))
23345 ((#:name . "config")
23346 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
23347 (#:load-path . ".")
23348 (#:branch . "master")
23349 (#:no-compile? . #t))
23350 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
23351 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
23352 (#:load-path . ".")
23353 (#:branch . "master")
23354 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
23355
23356 (service cuirass-service-type
23357 (cuirass-configuration
23358 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
23359 @end lisp
23360
23361 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
23362 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
23363 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
23364
23365 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
23366 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
23367
23368 @table @asis
23369 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
23370 Location of the log file.
23371
23372 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
23373 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
23374
23375 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
23376 Location of the repository cache.
23377
23378 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
23379 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
23380
23381 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
23382 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
23383
23384 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
23385 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
23386 Cuirass jobs.
23387
23388 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
23389 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
23390 added specifications.
23391
23392 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
23393 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
23394 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
23395 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
23396
23397 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
23398 Port number used by the HTTP server.
23399
23400 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
23401 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
23402 accept connections from localhost.
23403
23404 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
23405 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
23406 where a specification is an association list
23407 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
23408 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
23409 above.
23410
23411 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
23412 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
23413 from source.
23414
23415 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
23416 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
23417
23418 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
23419 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
23420 packages locally.
23421
23422 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23423 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
23424
23425 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
23426 The Cuirass package to use.
23427 @end table
23428 @end deftp
23429
23430 @node Power Management Services
23431 @subsection Power Management Services
23432
23433 @cindex tlp
23434 @cindex power management with TLP
23435 @subsubheading TLP daemon
23436
23437 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
23438 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
23439
23440 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
23441 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
23442 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
23443 source is detected. More information can be found at
23444 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
23445
23446 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
23447 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
23448 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
23449 write:
23450 @lisp
23451 (service tlp-service-type)
23452 @end lisp
23453 @end deffn
23454
23455 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
23456 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
23457
23458 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
23459 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
23460 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
23461 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
23462 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
23463
23464 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
23465 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
23466 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
23467 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
23468 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
23469 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
23470 @c the churn as TLP updates.
23471
23472 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
23473
23474 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
23475 The TLP package.
23476
23477 @end deftypevr
23478
23479 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
23480 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
23481
23482 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23483
23484 @end deftypevr
23485
23486 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
23487 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
23488 and BAT.
23489
23490 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
23491
23492 @end deftypevr
23493
23494 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
23495 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
23496 before syncing on AC.
23497
23498 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23499
23500 @end deftypevr
23501
23502 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
23503 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
23504
23505 Defaults to @samp{2}.
23506
23507 @end deftypevr
23508
23509 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
23510 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
23511
23512 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23513
23514 @end deftypevr
23515
23516 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
23517 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
23518
23519 Defaults to @samp{60}.
23520
23521 @end deftypevr
23522
23523 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
23524 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
23525 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
23526 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
23527
23528 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23529
23530 @end deftypevr
23531
23532 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
23533 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
23534
23535 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23536
23537 @end deftypevr
23538
23539 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
23540 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
23541
23542 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23543
23544 @end deftypevr
23545
23546 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
23547 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
23548
23549 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23550
23551 @end deftypevr
23552
23553 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
23554 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
23555
23556 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23557
23558 @end deftypevr
23559
23560 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
23561 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
23562
23563 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23564
23565 @end deftypevr
23566
23567 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
23568 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
23569 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
23570
23571 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23572
23573 @end deftypevr
23574
23575 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
23576 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
23577 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
23578
23579 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23580
23581 @end deftypevr
23582
23583 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
23584 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
23585
23586 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23587
23588 @end deftypevr
23589
23590 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
23591 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
23592
23593 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23594
23595 @end deftypevr
23596
23597 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
23598 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
23599
23600 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23601
23602 @end deftypevr
23603
23604 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
23605 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
23606
23607 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23608
23609 @end deftypevr
23610
23611 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
23612 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
23613 used under light load conditions.
23614
23615 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23616
23617 @end deftypevr
23618
23619 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
23620 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
23621
23622 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23623
23624 @end deftypevr
23625
23626 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
23627 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
23628
23629 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23630
23631 @end deftypevr
23632
23633 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
23634 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
23635 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
23636
23637 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23638
23639 @end deftypevr
23640
23641 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
23642 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
23643 performance, normal, powersave.
23644
23645 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
23646
23647 @end deftypevr
23648
23649 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
23650 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
23651
23652 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
23653
23654 @end deftypevr
23655
23656 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
23657 Hard disk devices.
23658
23659 @end deftypevr
23660
23661 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
23662 Hard disk advanced power management level.
23663
23664 @end deftypevr
23665
23666 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
23667 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
23668
23669 @end deftypevr
23670
23671 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
23672 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
23673 declared hard disk.
23674
23675 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23676
23677 @end deftypevr
23678
23679 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
23680 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
23681
23682 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23683
23684 @end deftypevr
23685
23686 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
23687 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
23688 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
23689 noop.
23690
23691 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23692
23693 @end deftypevr
23694
23695 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
23696 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
23697 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
23698
23699 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
23700
23701 @end deftypevr
23702
23703 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
23704 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
23705
23706 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
23707
23708 @end deftypevr
23709
23710 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
23711 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
23712
23713 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23714
23715 @end deftypevr
23716
23717 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
23718 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
23719 mode.
23720
23721 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23722
23723 @end deftypevr
23724
23725 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
23726 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
23727
23728 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23729
23730 @end deftypevr
23731
23732 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
23733 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
23734
23735 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23736
23737 @end deftypevr
23738
23739 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
23740 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
23741 default, performance, powersave.
23742
23743 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
23744
23745 @end deftypevr
23746
23747 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
23748 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
23749
23750 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
23751
23752 @end deftypevr
23753
23754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
23755 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
23756 auto, default.
23757
23758 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
23759
23760 @end deftypevr
23761
23762 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
23763 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
23764
23765 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
23766
23767 @end deftypevr
23768
23769 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
23770 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
23771 performance.
23772
23773 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
23774
23775 @end deftypevr
23776
23777 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
23778 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
23779
23780 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
23781
23782 @end deftypevr
23783
23784 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
23785 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
23786
23787 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
23788
23789 @end deftypevr
23790
23791 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
23792 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
23793
23794 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
23795
23796 @end deftypevr
23797
23798 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
23799 Wifi power saving mode.
23800
23801 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23802
23803 @end deftypevr
23804
23805 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
23806 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
23807
23808 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23809
23810 @end deftypevr
23811
23812 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
23813 Disable wake on LAN.
23814
23815 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23816
23817 @end deftypevr
23818
23819 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
23820 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
23821 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
23822
23823 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23824
23825 @end deftypevr
23826
23827 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
23828 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
23829
23830 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23831
23832 @end deftypevr
23833
23834 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
23835 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
23836
23837 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23838
23839 @end deftypevr
23840
23841 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
23842 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
23843 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
23844 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
23845
23846 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23847
23848 @end deftypevr
23849
23850 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
23851 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
23852
23853 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
23854
23855 @end deftypevr
23856
23857 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
23858 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
23859 and auto.
23860
23861 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
23862
23863 @end deftypevr
23864
23865 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
23866 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
23867
23868 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
23869
23870 @end deftypevr
23871
23872 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
23873 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
23874 ones.
23875
23876 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23877
23878 @end deftypevr
23879
23880 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
23881 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
23882
23883 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23884
23885 @end deftypevr
23886
23887 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
23888 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
23889 Power Management.
23890
23891 @end deftypevr
23892
23893 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
23894 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
23895
23896 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23897
23898 @end deftypevr
23899
23900 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
23901 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
23902
23903 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23904
23905 @end deftypevr
23906
23907 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
23908 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
23909
23910 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23911
23912 @end deftypevr
23913
23914 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
23915 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
23916 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
23917
23918 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23919
23920 @end deftypevr
23921
23922 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
23923 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
23924
23925 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23926
23927 @end deftypevr
23928
23929 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
23930 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
23931 shutdown on system startup.
23932
23933 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23934
23935 @end deftypevr
23936
23937 @cindex thermald
23938 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
23939 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
23940
23941 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
23942 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
23943
23944 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
23945 This is the service type for
23946 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
23947 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
23948 of processors and preventing overheating.
23949 @end defvr
23950
23951 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
23952 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
23953
23954 @table @asis
23955 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
23956 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
23957
23958 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
23959 Package object of thermald.
23960
23961 @end table
23962 @end deftp
23963
23964 @node Audio Services
23965 @subsection Audio Services
23966
23967 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
23968 (the Music Player Daemon).
23969
23970 @cindex mpd
23971 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
23972
23973 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
23974 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
23975 of clients.
23976
23977 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
23978 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
23979
23980 @lisp
23981 (service mpd-service-type
23982 (mpd-configuration
23983 (user "bob")
23984 (port "6666")))
23985 @end lisp
23986
23987 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
23988 The service type for @command{mpd}
23989 @end defvr
23990
23991 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
23992 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
23993
23994 @table @asis
23995 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
23996 The user to run mpd as.
23997
23998 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
23999 The directory to scan for music files.
24000
24001 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
24002 The directory to store playlists.
24003
24004 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
24005 The location of the music database.
24006
24007 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
24008 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
24009
24010 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
24011 The location of the sticker database.
24012
24013 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
24014 The port to run mpd on.
24015
24016 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
24017 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
24018 an absolute path can be specified here.
24019
24020 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
24021 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
24022
24023 @end table
24024 @end deftp
24025
24026 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
24027 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
24028
24029 @table @asis
24030 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
24031 The name of the audio output.
24032
24033 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
24034 The type of audio output.
24035
24036 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
24037 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
24038 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
24039 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
24040 state is restored.
24041
24042 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
24043 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
24044 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
24045 @code{httpd} output plugin.
24046
24047 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
24048 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
24049 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
24050 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
24051
24052 @item @code{mixer-type}
24053 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
24054 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
24055 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
24056 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
24057 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
24058
24059 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()"})
24060 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
24061 the audio output configuration.
24062
24063 @end table
24064 @end deftp
24065
24066 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
24067 an HTTP audio streaming output.
24068
24069 @lisp
24070 (service mpd-service-type
24071 (mpd-configuration
24072 (outputs
24073 (list (mpd-output
24074 (name "streaming")
24075 (type "httpd")
24076 (mixer-type 'null)
24077 (extra-options
24078 `((encoder . "vorbis")
24079 (port . "8080"))))))))
24080 @end lisp
24081
24082
24083 @node Virtualization Services
24084 @subsection Virtualization services
24085
24086 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
24087 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
24088 services.
24089
24090 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
24091 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
24092 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
24093 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
24094
24095 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
24096 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
24097 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
24098
24099 @lisp
24100 (service libvirt-service-type
24101 (libvirt-configuration
24102 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
24103 (tls-port "16555")))
24104 @end lisp
24105 @end deffn
24106
24107 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
24108 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
24109
24110 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
24111 Libvirt package.
24112
24113 @end deftypevr
24114
24115 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
24116 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
24117 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
24118
24119 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
24120 this capability.
24121
24122 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24123
24124 @end deftypevr
24125
24126 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
24127 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
24128 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
24129
24130 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
24131 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
24132 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
24133
24134 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24135
24136 @end deftypevr
24137
24138 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
24139 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
24140 service name
24141
24142 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
24143
24144 @end deftypevr
24145
24146 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
24147 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
24148 or service name
24149
24150 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
24151
24152 @end deftypevr
24153
24154 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
24155 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
24156
24157 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
24158
24159 @end deftypevr
24160
24161 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
24162 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
24163
24164 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
24165 Avahi daemon.
24166
24167 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24168
24169 @end deftypevr
24170
24171 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
24172 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
24173 broadcast network.
24174
24175 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
24176
24177 @end deftypevr
24178
24179 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
24180 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
24181 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
24182 becoming root.
24183
24184 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
24185
24186 @end deftypevr
24187
24188 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
24189 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
24190 VM status only.
24191
24192 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
24193
24194 @end deftypevr
24195
24196 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
24197 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
24198 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
24199 everyone (eg, 0777)
24200
24201 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
24202
24203 @end deftypevr
24204
24205 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
24206 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
24207 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
24208 the access to.
24209
24210 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
24211
24212 @end deftypevr
24213
24214 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
24215 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
24216
24217 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
24218
24219 @end deftypevr
24220
24221 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
24222 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
24223 permissions allow anyone to connect
24224
24225 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
24226
24227 @end deftypevr
24228
24229 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
24230 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
24231 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
24232 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
24233
24234 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
24235
24236 @end deftypevr
24237
24238 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
24239 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
24240 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
24241 scenario.
24242
24243 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
24244
24245 @end deftypevr
24246
24247 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
24248 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
24249 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
24250 by certificates.
24251
24252 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
24253 by using 'sasl' for this option
24254
24255 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
24256
24257 @end deftypevr
24258
24259 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
24260 API access control scheme.
24261
24262 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
24263 drivers can place restrictions on this.
24264
24265 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24266
24267 @end deftypevr
24268
24269 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
24270 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
24271 loaded.
24272
24273 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24274
24275 @end deftypevr
24276
24277 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
24278 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
24279 loaded.
24280
24281 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24282
24283 @end deftypevr
24284
24285 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
24286 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
24287 is loaded.
24288
24289 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24290
24291 @end deftypevr
24292
24293 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
24294 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
24295 CRL is loaded.
24296
24297 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24298
24299 @end deftypevr
24300
24301 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
24302 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
24303
24304 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
24305 certificates.
24306
24307 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24308
24309 @end deftypevr
24310
24311 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
24312 Disable verification of client certificates.
24313
24314 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
24315 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
24316 rejected.
24317
24318 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24319
24320 @end deftypevr
24321
24322 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
24323 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
24324
24325 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24326
24327 @end deftypevr
24328
24329 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
24330 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
24331 the SASL authentication mechanism.
24332
24333 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24334
24335 @end deftypevr
24336
24337 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
24338 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
24339 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
24340 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
24341
24342 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
24343
24344 @end deftypevr
24345
24346 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
24347 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
24348 sockets combined.
24349
24350 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
24351
24352 @end deftypevr
24353
24354 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
24355 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
24356 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
24357 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
24358
24359 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
24360
24361 @end deftypevr
24362
24363 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
24364 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
24365 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
24366
24367 Defaults to @samp{20}.
24368
24369 @end deftypevr
24370
24371 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
24372 Number of workers to start up initially.
24373
24374 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24375
24376 @end deftypevr
24377
24378 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
24379 Maximum number of worker threads.
24380
24381 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
24382 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
24383 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
24384
24385 Defaults to @samp{20}.
24386
24387 @end deftypevr
24388
24389 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
24390 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
24391 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
24392 executed in this pool.
24393
24394 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24395
24396 @end deftypevr
24397
24398 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
24399 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
24400
24401 Defaults to @samp{20}.
24402
24403 @end deftypevr
24404
24405 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
24406 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
24407 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
24408 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
24409
24410 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24411
24412 @end deftypevr
24413
24414 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
24415 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
24416
24417 Defaults to @samp{1}.
24418
24419 @end deftypevr
24420
24421 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
24422 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
24423
24424 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24425
24426 @end deftypevr
24427
24428 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
24429 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
24430
24431 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24432
24433 @end deftypevr
24434
24435 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
24436 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
24437
24438 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24439
24440 @end deftypevr
24441
24442 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
24443 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
24444
24445 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24446
24447 @end deftypevr
24448
24449 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
24450 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
24451
24452 Defaults to @samp{3}.
24453
24454 @end deftypevr
24455
24456 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
24457 Logging filters.
24458
24459 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
24460 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
24461
24462 @itemize @bullet
24463 @item
24464 x:name
24465
24466 @item
24467 x:+name
24468
24469 @end itemize
24470
24471 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
24472 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
24473 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
24474 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
24475 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
24476 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
24477 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
24478 logged:
24479
24480 @itemize @bullet
24481 @item
24482 1: DEBUG
24483
24484 @item
24485 2: INFO
24486
24487 @item
24488 3: WARNING
24489
24490 @item
24491 4: ERROR
24492
24493 @end itemize
24494
24495 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
24496 need to be separated by spaces.
24497
24498 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
24499
24500 @end deftypevr
24501
24502 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
24503 Logging outputs.
24504
24505 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
24506 for an output can be:
24507
24508 @table @code
24509 @item x:stderr
24510 output goes to stderr
24511
24512 @item x:syslog:name
24513 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
24514
24515 @item x:file:file_path
24516 output to a file, with the given filepath
24517
24518 @item x:journald
24519 output to journald logging system
24520
24521 @end table
24522
24523 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
24524
24525 @itemize @bullet
24526 @item
24527 1: DEBUG
24528
24529 @item
24530 2: INFO
24531
24532 @item
24533 3: WARNING
24534
24535 @item
24536 4: ERROR
24537
24538 @end itemize
24539
24540 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
24541 spaces.
24542
24543 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
24544
24545 @end deftypevr
24546
24547 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
24548 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
24549
24550 @itemize @bullet
24551 @item
24552 0: disable all auditing
24553
24554 @item
24555 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
24556
24557 @item
24558 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
24559
24560 @end itemize
24561
24562 Defaults to @samp{1}.
24563
24564 @end deftypevr
24565
24566 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
24567 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
24568
24569 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24570
24571 @end deftypevr
24572
24573 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
24574 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
24575
24576 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24577
24578 @end deftypevr
24579
24580 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
24581 Source to read host UUID.
24582
24583 @itemize @bullet
24584 @item
24585 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
24586
24587 @item
24588 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
24589
24590 @end itemize
24591
24592 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
24593 be generated.
24594
24595 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
24596
24597 @end deftypevr
24598
24599 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
24600 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
24601 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
24602 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
24603 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
24604
24605 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24606
24607 @end deftypevr
24608
24609 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
24610 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
24611 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
24612 broken.
24613
24614 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
24615 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
24616 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
24617 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
24618 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
24619 keepalive messages.
24620
24621 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24622
24623 @end deftypevr
24624
24625 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
24626 Same as above but for admin interface.
24627
24628 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24629
24630 @end deftypevr
24631
24632 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
24633 Same as above but for admin interface.
24634
24635 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24636
24637 @end deftypevr
24638
24639 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
24640 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
24641
24642 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
24643 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
24644 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
24645
24646 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24647
24648 @end deftypevr
24649
24650 @c %end of autogenerated docs
24651
24652 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
24653 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
24654 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
24655
24656 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
24657 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
24658 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
24659 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
24660 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
24661
24662 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
24663 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
24664 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
24665
24666 @lisp
24667 (service virtlog-service-type
24668 (virtlog-configuration
24669 (max-clients 1000)))
24670 @end lisp
24671 @end deffn
24672
24673 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
24674 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
24675
24676 Defaults to @samp{3}.
24677
24678 @end deftypevr
24679
24680 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
24681 Logging filters.
24682
24683 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
24684 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
24685
24686 @itemize @bullet
24687 @item
24688 x:name
24689
24690 @item
24691 x:+name
24692
24693 @end itemize
24694
24695 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
24696 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
24697 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
24698 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
24699 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
24700 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
24701 where matching messages should be logged:
24702
24703 @itemize @bullet
24704 @item
24705 1: DEBUG
24706
24707 @item
24708 2: INFO
24709
24710 @item
24711 3: WARNING
24712
24713 @item
24714 4: ERROR
24715
24716 @end itemize
24717
24718 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
24719 need to be separated by spaces.
24720
24721 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
24722
24723 @end deftypevr
24724
24725 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
24726 Logging outputs.
24727
24728 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
24729 for an output can be:
24730
24731 @table @code
24732 @item x:stderr
24733 output goes to stderr
24734
24735 @item x:syslog:name
24736 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
24737
24738 @item x:file:file_path
24739 output to a file, with the given filepath
24740
24741 @item x:journald
24742 output to journald logging system
24743
24744 @end table
24745
24746 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
24747
24748 @itemize @bullet
24749 @item
24750 1: DEBUG
24751
24752 @item
24753 2: INFO
24754
24755 @item
24756 3: WARNING
24757
24758 @item
24759 4: ERROR
24760
24761 @end itemize
24762
24763 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
24764 spaces.
24765
24766 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
24767
24768 @end deftypevr
24769
24770 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
24771 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
24772 sockets combined.
24773
24774 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
24775
24776 @end deftypevr
24777
24778 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
24779 Maximum file size before rolling over.
24780
24781 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
24782
24783 @end deftypevr
24784
24785 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
24786 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
24787
24788 Defaults to @samp{3}
24789
24790 @end deftypevr
24791
24792 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
24793
24794 @cindex emulation
24795 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
24796 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
24797 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
24798 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
24799 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
24800 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
24801
24802 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
24803 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
24804 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
24805 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
24806 emulated:
24807
24808 @lisp
24809 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
24810 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
24811 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
24812 @end lisp
24813
24814 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
24815 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
24816 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
24817 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
24818 @end defvr
24819
24820 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
24821 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
24822
24823 @table @asis
24824 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
24825 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
24826 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
24827
24828 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
24829 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
24830 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
24831 @option{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
24832 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
24833 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
24834
24835 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
24836 service:
24837
24838 @lisp
24839 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
24840 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
24841 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
24842 (guix-support? #t)))
24843 @end lisp
24844
24845 You can run:
24846
24847 @example
24848 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
24849 @end example
24850
24851 @noindent
24852 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
24853 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
24854 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
24855 access to!
24856
24857 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
24858 The QEMU package to use.
24859 @end table
24860 @end deftp
24861
24862 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
24863 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
24864 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
24865 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
24866 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
24867 @end deffn
24868
24869 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
24870 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
24871 @end deffn
24872
24873 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
24874 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
24875 @end deffn
24876
24877
24878 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
24879
24880 @cindex @code{hurd}
24881 @cindex the Hurd
24882
24883 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
24884 virtual machine (VM), a so-called ``Childhurd''. The virtual machine is
24885 a Shepherd service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm}
24886 and @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
24887
24888 @example
24889 herd start hurd-vm
24890 herd stop childhurd
24891 @end example
24892
24893 The given GNU/Hurd operating system configuration is cross-compiled.
24894
24895 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
24896 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
24897 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
24898 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
24899 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
24900 options for running it.
24901
24902 For example:
24903
24904 @lisp
24905 (service hurd-vm-service-type
24906 (hurd-vm-configuration
24907 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
24908 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
24909 @end lisp
24910
24911 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
24912 extra memory.
24913 @end defvr
24914
24915 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
24916 The data type representing the configuration for
24917 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
24918
24919 @table @asis
24920 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
24921 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
24922 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
24923 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
24924
24925 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
24926 The QEMU package to use.
24927
24928 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
24929 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
24930 configuration.
24931
24932 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
24933 The size of the disk image.
24934
24935 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
24936 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
24937
24938 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
24939 The extra options for running QEMU.
24940
24941 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
24942 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
24943 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
24944 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
24945
24946 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
24947 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
24948
24949 By default, it produces
24950
24951 @lisp
24952 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
24953 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
24954 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:<ssh-port>-:2222\
24955 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:<vnc-port>-:5900")
24956 @end lisp
24957 with forwarded ports
24958 @example
24959 <ssh-port>: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
24960 <vnc-port>: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
24961 @end example
24962
24963 @end table
24964 @end deftp
24965
24966 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
24967 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
24968 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
24969 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
24970
24971 @lisp
24972 (service hurd-vm-service-type
24973 (hurd-vm-configuration
24974 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
24975 (options '("--hda"))))
24976 @end lisp
24977
24978 @node Version Control Services
24979 @subsection Version Control Services
24980
24981 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
24982 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
24983 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
24984 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
24985 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
24986 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
24987 @code{cgit-service-type}.
24988
24989 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
24990
24991 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
24992 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
24993
24994 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
24995 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
24996 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
24997 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
24998 @file{/srv/git}.
24999
25000 @end deffn
25001
25002 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
25003 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
25004
25005 @table @asis
25006 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
25007 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
25008
25009 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
25010 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
25011 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
25012
25013 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
25014 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
25015 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
25016 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
25017 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
25018 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
25019
25020 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
25021 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
25022 specified with empty string, requests to
25023 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
25024 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
25025 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
25026 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
25027 directory of user @code{alice}.
25028
25029 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
25030 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
25031 all.
25032
25033 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
25034 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
25035
25036 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
25037 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
25038
25039 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
25040 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
25041 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
25042
25043 @end table
25044 @end deftp
25045
25046 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
25047 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
25048 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
25049 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
25050 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
25051 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
25052 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
25053 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
25054 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
25055 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
25056
25057 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
25058 over HTTP.
25059
25060 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
25061 Data type representing the configuration for a future
25062 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
25063 trough @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
25064
25065 @table @asis
25066 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
25067 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
25068
25069 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
25070 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
25071
25072 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
25073 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
25074 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
25075
25076 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
25077 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
25078 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
25079 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
25080 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
25081
25082 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
25083 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
25084 Services}.
25085 @end table
25086 @end deftp
25087
25088 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
25089 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
25090 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
25091 server.
25092
25093 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
25094 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
25095 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
25096 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
25097 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
25098
25099 @lisp
25100 (service nginx-service-type
25101 (nginx-configuration
25102 (server-blocks
25103 (list
25104 (nginx-server-configuration
25105 (listen '("443 ssl"))
25106 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
25107 (ssl-certificate
25108 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
25109 (ssl-certificate-key
25110 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
25111 (locations
25112 (list
25113 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
25114 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
25115 @end lisp
25116
25117 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
25118 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
25119 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
25120 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
25121 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
25122 @end deffn
25123
25124 @subsubheading Cgit Service
25125
25126 @cindex Cgit service
25127 @cindex Git, web interface
25128 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
25129 repositories written in C.
25130
25131 The following example will configure the service with default values.
25132 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
25133
25134 @lisp
25135 (service cgit-service-type)
25136 @end lisp
25137
25138 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
25139 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
25140
25141 @c %start of fragment
25142
25143 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
25144
25145 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
25146 The CGIT package.
25147
25148 @end deftypevr
25149
25150 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
25151 NGINX configuration.
25152
25153 @end deftypevr
25154
25155 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
25156 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
25157 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
25158
25159 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25160
25161 @end deftypevr
25162
25163 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
25164 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
25165 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
25166
25167 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25168
25169 @end deftypevr
25170
25171 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
25172 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
25173 access.
25174
25175 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25176
25177 @end deftypevr
25178
25179 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
25180 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
25181 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
25182
25183 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
25184
25185 @end deftypevr
25186
25187 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
25188 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
25189
25190 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
25191
25192 @end deftypevr
25193
25194 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
25195 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25196 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
25197
25198 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
25199
25200 @end deftypevr
25201
25202 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
25203 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25204 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
25205
25206 Defaults to @samp{5}.
25207
25208 @end deftypevr
25209
25210 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
25211 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25212 version of the repository summary page.
25213
25214 Defaults to @samp{5}.
25215
25216 @end deftypevr
25217
25218 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
25219 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25220 version of the repository index page.
25221
25222 Defaults to @samp{5}.
25223
25224 @end deftypevr
25225
25226 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
25227 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
25228 scanning a path for Git repositories.
25229
25230 Defaults to @samp{15}.
25231
25232 @end deftypevr
25233
25234 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
25235 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25236 version of the repository about page.
25237
25238 Defaults to @samp{15}.
25239
25240 @end deftypevr
25241
25242 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
25243 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
25244 version of snapshots.
25245
25246 Defaults to @samp{5}.
25247
25248 @end deftypevr
25249
25250 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
25251 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
25252 caching is disabled.
25253
25254 Defaults to @samp{0}.
25255
25256 @end deftypevr
25257
25258 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
25259 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
25260
25261 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25262
25263 @end deftypevr
25264
25265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
25266 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
25267 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
25268
25269 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25270
25271 @end deftypevr
25272
25273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
25274 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
25275
25276 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25277
25278 @end deftypevr
25279
25280 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
25281 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
25282
25283 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25284
25285 @end deftypevr
25286
25287 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
25288 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
25289 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
25290 ordering.
25291
25292 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
25293
25294 @end deftypevr
25295
25296 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
25297 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
25298
25299 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
25300
25301 @end deftypevr
25302
25303 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
25304 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
25305 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
25306 places throughout the cgit interface.
25307
25308 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25309
25310 @end deftypevr
25311
25312 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
25313 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
25314 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
25315
25316 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25317
25318 @end deftypevr
25319
25320 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
25321 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
25322 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
25323 repository log page.
25324
25325 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25326
25327 @end deftypevr
25328
25329 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
25330 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
25331 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
25332
25333 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25334
25335 @end deftypevr
25336
25337 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
25338 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
25339 log view.
25340
25341 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25342
25343 @end deftypevr
25344
25345 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
25346 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
25347 clones.
25348
25349 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25350
25351 @end deftypevr
25352
25353 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
25354 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
25355 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
25356
25357 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25358
25359 @end deftypevr
25360
25361 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
25362 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
25363 each repo in the repository index.
25364
25365 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25366
25367 @end deftypevr
25368
25369 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
25370 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
25371 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
25372
25373 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25374
25375 @end deftypevr
25376
25377 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
25378 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
25379 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
25380
25381 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25382
25383 @end deftypevr
25384
25385 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
25386 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
25387 branches in the summary and refs views.
25388
25389 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25390
25391 @end deftypevr
25392
25393 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
25394 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
25395 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
25396 commit view.
25397
25398 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25399
25400 @end deftypevr
25401
25402 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
25403 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
25404 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
25405 commit view.
25406
25407 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25408
25409 @end deftypevr
25410
25411 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
25412 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
25413 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
25414
25415 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25416
25417 @end deftypevr
25418
25419 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
25420 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
25421 set any repo specific settings.
25422
25423 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25424
25425 @end deftypevr
25426
25427 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
25428 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
25429
25430 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
25431
25432 @end deftypevr
25433
25434 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
25435 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25436 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
25437 "generated by..."@: message).
25438
25439 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25440
25441 @end deftypevr
25442
25443 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
25444 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25445 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
25446
25447 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25448
25449 @end deftypevr
25450
25451 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
25452 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25453 verbatim at the top of all pages.
25454
25455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25456
25457 @end deftypevr
25458
25459 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
25460 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
25461 file is parsed.
25462
25463 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25464
25465 @end deftypevr
25466
25467 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
25468 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25469 verbatim above the repository index.
25470
25471 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25472
25473 @end deftypevr
25474
25475 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
25476 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25477 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
25478
25479 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25480
25481 @end deftypevr
25482
25483 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
25484 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
25485 in the servers timezone.
25486
25487 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25488
25489 @end deftypevr
25490
25491 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
25492 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
25493 on all cgit pages.
25494
25495 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
25496
25497 @end deftypevr
25498
25499 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
25500 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
25501
25502 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25503
25504 @end deftypevr
25505
25506 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
25507 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
25508 page.
25509
25510 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25511
25512 @end deftypevr
25513
25514 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
25515 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
25516
25517 Defaults to @samp{10}.
25518
25519 @end deftypevr
25520
25521 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
25522 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
25523
25524 Defaults to @samp{50}.
25525
25526 @end deftypevr
25527
25528 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
25529 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
25530
25531 Defaults to @samp{80}.
25532
25533 @end deftypevr
25534
25535 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
25536 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
25537 page.
25538
25539 Defaults to @samp{50}.
25540
25541 @end deftypevr
25542
25543 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
25544 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
25545 on the repository index page.
25546
25547 Defaults to @samp{80}.
25548
25549 @end deftypevr
25550
25551 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
25552 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
25553
25554 Defaults to @samp{0}.
25555
25556 @end deftypevr
25557
25558 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
25559 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
25560 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
25561
25562 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25563
25564 @end deftypevr
25565
25566 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
25567 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
25568
25569 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
25570 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
25571 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
25572
25573 @end deftypevr
25574
25575 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
25576 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
25577
25578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25579
25580 @end deftypevr
25581
25582 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
25583 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
25584 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
25585
25586 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25587
25588 @end deftypevr
25589
25590 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
25591 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
25592
25593 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25594
25595 @end deftypevr
25596
25597 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
25598 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
25599 disabled.
25600
25601 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25602
25603 @end deftypevr
25604
25605 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
25606 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
25607 header on all pages.
25608
25609 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25610
25611 @end deftypevr
25612
25613 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
25614 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
25615 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
25616 all subdirectories will be loaded.
25617
25618 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25619
25620 @end deftypevr
25621
25622 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
25623 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
25624
25625 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25626
25627 @end deftypevr
25628
25629 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
25630 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
25631 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
25632 removed for the URL and name.
25633
25634 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25635
25636 @end deftypevr
25637
25638 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
25639 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
25640
25641 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
25642
25643 @end deftypevr
25644
25645 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
25646 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
25647
25648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25649
25650 @end deftypevr
25651
25652 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
25653 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
25654
25655 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
25656
25657 @end deftypevr
25658
25659 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
25660 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
25661
25662 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
25663
25664 @end deftypevr
25665
25666 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
25667 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
25668 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
25669
25670 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25671
25672 @end deftypevr
25673
25674 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
25675 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
25676
25677 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25678
25679 @end deftypevr
25680
25681 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
25682 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
25683 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
25684 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
25685 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
25686 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
25687
25688 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25689
25690 @end deftypevr
25691
25692 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
25693 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
25694 generates links for.
25695
25696 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25697
25698 @end deftypevr
25699
25700 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
25701 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
25702 @code{scan-path}).
25703
25704 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
25705
25706 @end deftypevr
25707
25708 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
25709 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
25710 after this option will inherit the current section name.
25711
25712 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25713
25714 @end deftypevr
25715
25716 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
25717 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
25718 repository listing by name.
25719
25720 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25721
25722 @end deftypevr
25723
25724 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
25725 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
25726 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
25727
25728 Defaults to @samp{0}.
25729
25730 @end deftypevr
25731
25732 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
25733 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
25734 default.
25735
25736 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25737
25738 @end deftypevr
25739
25740 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
25741 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
25742 the tree view.
25743
25744 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25745
25746 @end deftypevr
25747
25748 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
25749 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
25750 view.
25751
25752 Defaults to @samp{10}.
25753
25754 @end deftypevr
25755
25756 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
25757 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
25758 ``summary'' view.
25759
25760 Defaults to @samp{10}.
25761
25762 @end deftypevr
25763
25764 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
25765 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
25766 view.
25767
25768 Defaults to @samp{10}.
25769
25770 @end deftypevr
25771
25772 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
25773 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
25774 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
25775
25776 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25777
25778 @end deftypevr
25779
25780 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
25781 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
25782
25783 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
25784
25785 @end deftypevr
25786
25787 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
25788 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
25789
25790 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25791
25792 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
25793
25794 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
25795 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
25796 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
25797
25798 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25799
25800 @end deftypevr
25801
25802 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
25803 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
25804
25805 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25806
25807 @end deftypevr
25808
25809 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
25810 The relative URL used to access the repository.
25811
25812 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25813
25814 @end deftypevr
25815
25816 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
25817 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
25818
25819 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25820
25821 @end deftypevr
25822
25823 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
25824 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
25825 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
25826
25827 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25828
25829 @end deftypevr
25830
25831 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
25832 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
25833
25834 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25835
25836 @end deftypevr
25837
25838 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
25839 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
25840
25841 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25842
25843 @end deftypevr
25844
25845 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
25846 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
25847 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
25848 ordering.
25849
25850 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25851
25852 @end deftypevr
25853
25854 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
25855 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
25856 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
25857 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
25858 there is no suitable HEAD.
25859
25860 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25861
25862 @end deftypevr
25863
25864 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
25865 The value to show as repository description.
25866
25867 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25868
25869 @end deftypevr
25870
25871 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
25872 The value to show as repository homepage.
25873
25874 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25875
25876 @end deftypevr
25877
25878 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
25879 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
25880
25881 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25882
25883 @end deftypevr
25884
25885 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
25886 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
25887 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
25888
25889 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25890
25891 @end deftypevr
25892
25893 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
25894 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
25895 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
25896
25897 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25898
25899 @end deftypevr
25900
25901 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
25902 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
25903 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
25904
25905 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25906
25907 @end deftypevr
25908
25909 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
25910 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
25911 branches in the summary and refs views.
25912
25913 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25914
25915 @end deftypevr
25916
25917 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
25918 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
25919 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
25920
25921 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25922
25923 @end deftypevr
25924
25925 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
25926 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
25927 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
25928
25929 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25930
25931 @end deftypevr
25932
25933 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
25934 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
25935 repository index.
25936
25937 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25938
25939 @end deftypevr
25940
25941 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
25942 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
25943
25944 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25945
25946 @end deftypevr
25947
25948 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
25949 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
25950 on this repo’s pages.
25951
25952 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25953
25954 @end deftypevr
25955
25956 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
25957 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
25958
25959 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25960
25961 @end deftypevr
25962
25963 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
25964 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
25965
25966 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25967
25968 @end deftypevr
25969
25970 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
25971 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
25972 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
25973 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
25974
25975 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25976
25977 @end deftypevr
25978
25979 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
25980 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
25981 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
25982 listing.
25983
25984 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25985
25986 @end deftypevr
25987
25988 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
25989 Override the default maximum statistics period.
25990
25991 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25992
25993 @end deftypevr
25994
25995 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
25996 The value to show as repository name.
25997
25998 Defaults to @samp{""}.
25999
26000 @end deftypevr
26001
26002 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
26003 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
26004
26005 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26006
26007 @end deftypevr
26008
26009 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
26010 An absolute path to the repository directory.
26011
26012 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26013
26014 @end deftypevr
26015
26016 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
26017 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
26018 the ``About'' page for this repo.
26019
26020 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26021
26022 @end deftypevr
26023
26024 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
26025 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
26026 after this option will inherit the current section name.
26027
26028 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26029
26030 @end deftypevr
26031
26032 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
26033 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
26034
26035 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26036
26037 @end deftypevr
26038
26039 @end deftypevr
26040
26041 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
26042 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
26043
26044 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26045
26046 @end deftypevr
26047
26048
26049 @c %end of fragment
26050
26051 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
26052 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
26053 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
26054 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
26055
26056 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
26057
26058 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
26059 The cgit package.
26060 @end deftypevr
26061
26062 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
26063 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
26064 @end deftypevr
26065
26066 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
26067 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
26068
26069 @lisp
26070 (service cgit-service-type
26071 (opaque-cgit-configuration
26072 (cgitrc "")))
26073 @end lisp
26074
26075 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
26076
26077 @cindex Gitolite service
26078 @cindex Git, hosting
26079 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
26080 repositories on a central server.
26081
26082 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
26083 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
26084
26085 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
26086 user, and the provided SSH public key.
26087
26088 @lisp
26089 (service gitolite-service-type
26090 (gitolite-configuration
26091 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
26092 "yourname.pub"
26093 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
26094 @end lisp
26095
26096 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
26097 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
26098 following command to clone the admin repository.
26099
26100 @example
26101 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
26102 @end example
26103
26104 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
26105 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
26106 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
26107 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
26108
26109 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
26110 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
26111
26112 @table @asis
26113 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
26114 Gitolite package to use.
26115
26116 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
26117 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
26118 Gitolite over SSH.
26119
26120 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
26121 Group to use for Gitolite.
26122
26123 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
26124 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
26125
26126 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
26127 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
26128 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
26129
26130 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
26131 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
26132 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
26133 within the gitolite-admin repository.
26134
26135 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
26136
26137 @lisp
26138 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
26139 @end lisp
26140
26141 @end table
26142 @end deftp
26143
26144 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
26145 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
26146
26147 @table @asis
26148 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
26149 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
26150 contents.
26151
26152 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
26153 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
26154 like cgit or gitweb.
26155
26156 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
26157 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config} keyword. This
26158 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
26159
26160 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
26161 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
26162
26163 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
26164 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
26165
26166 @end table
26167 @end deftp
26168
26169
26170 @node Game Services
26171 @subsection Game Services
26172
26173 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
26174 @cindex wesnothd
26175 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
26176 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
26177 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
26178
26179 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
26180 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
26181 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
26182 configuration, instantiate it as:
26183
26184 @lisp
26185 (service wesnothd-service-type)
26186 @end lisp
26187 @end defvar
26188
26189 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
26190 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
26191
26192 @table @asis
26193 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
26194 The wesnoth server package to use.
26195
26196 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
26197 The port to bind the server to.
26198 @end table
26199 @end deftp
26200
26201
26202 @node PAM Mount Service
26203 @subsection PAM Mount Service
26204 @cindex pam-mount
26205
26206 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
26207 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
26208 volume format supported by the system.
26209
26210 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
26211 Service type for PAM Mount support.
26212 @end defvar
26213
26214 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
26215 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
26216
26217 It takes the following parameters:
26218
26219 @table @asis
26220 @item @code{rules}
26221 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
26222 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
26223
26224 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
26225 Guile Reference Manual}), and the the default ones don't mount anything
26226 for anyone at login:
26227
26228 @lisp
26229 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
26230 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
26231 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
26232 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
26233 "allow_root" "allow_other")
26234 ","))))
26235 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
26236 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
26237 (hup "0")
26238 (term "no")
26239 (kill "no")))
26240 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
26241 (remove "true"))))
26242 @end lisp
26243
26244 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
26245 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
26246 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
26247 the partition where he stores his data:
26248
26249 @lisp
26250 (define pam-mount-rules
26251 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
26252 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
26253 (fstype "crypt")
26254 (path "/dev/sda2")
26255 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
26256 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
26257 (fstype "auto")
26258 (path "/dev/sdb3")
26259 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
26260 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
26261 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
26262 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
26263 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
26264 "allow_root" "allow_other")
26265 ","))))
26266 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
26267 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
26268 (hup "0")
26269 (term "no")
26270 (kill "no")))
26271 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
26272 (remove "true")))))
26273
26274 (service pam-mount-service-type
26275 (pam-mount-configuration
26276 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
26277 @end lisp
26278
26279 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
26280 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
26281 @end table
26282 @end deftp
26283
26284
26285 @node Guix Services
26286 @subsection Guix Services
26287
26288 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
26289 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
26290 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
26291 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
26292
26293 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
26294 interface.
26295
26296 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
26297 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
26298 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
26299 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
26300 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
26301 @end defvar
26302
26303 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
26304 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
26305
26306 @table @asis
26307 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
26308 The Guix Data Service package to use.
26309
26310 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
26311 The system user to run the service as.
26312
26313 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
26314 The system group to run the service as.
26315
26316 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
26317 The port to bind the web service to.
26318
26319 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
26320 The host to bind the web service to.
26321
26322 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
26323 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
26324 configured to listen to.
26325
26326 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
26327 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
26328 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
26329 list.
26330
26331 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
26332 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
26333
26334 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
26335 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
26336
26337 @end table
26338 @end deftp
26339
26340 @node Linux Services
26341 @subsection Linux Services
26342
26343 @cindex oom
26344 @cindex out of memory killer
26345 @cindex earlyoom
26346 @cindex early out of memory daemon
26347 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
26348
26349 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
26350 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
26351 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
26352 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
26353 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
26354
26355 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
26356 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
26357 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
26358 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
26359 with:
26360
26361 @lisp
26362 (service earlyoom-service-type)
26363 @end lisp
26364 @end deffn
26365
26366 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
26367 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
26368
26369 @table @asis
26370 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
26371 The Earlyoom package to use.
26372
26373 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
26374 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
26375
26376 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
26377 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
26378
26379 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
26380 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
26381 that should be preferably killed.
26382
26383 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
26384 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
26385 that should @emph{not} be killed.
26386
26387 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
26388 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
26389 disabled by default.
26390
26391 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
26392 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
26393 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj}.
26394
26395 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
26396 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
26397 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
26398
26399 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
26400 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
26401 notifications.
26402 @end table
26403 @end deftp
26404
26405 @cindex modprobe
26406 @cindex kernel module loader
26407 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
26408
26409 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
26410 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
26411 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
26412 @code{ddcci}.
26413
26414 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
26415 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
26416 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
26417 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
26418 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
26419 parameters, can be done as follow:
26420
26421 @lisp
26422 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
26423 (use-package-modules linux)
26424 (use-service-modules linux)
26425
26426 (define ddcci-config
26427 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
26428 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
26429
26430 (operating-system
26431 ...
26432 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
26433 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
26434 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
26435 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
26436 ,ddcci-config)))
26437 %base-services))
26438 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
26439 @end lisp
26440 @end deffn
26441
26442 @node Hurd Services
26443 @subsection Hurd Services
26444
26445 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
26446 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
26447
26448 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
26449 @end defvr
26450
26451 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
26452 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
26453 hurd-console-service.
26454
26455 @table @asis
26456 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
26457 The Hurd package to use.
26458 @end table
26459 @end deftp
26460
26461 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
26462 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
26463
26464 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
26465 @end defvr
26466
26467 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
26468 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
26469 hurd-getty-service.
26470
26471 @table @asis
26472 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
26473 The Hurd package to use.
26474
26475 @item @code{tty}
26476 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
26477
26478 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
26479 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
26480
26481 @end table
26482 @end deftp
26483
26484 @node Miscellaneous Services
26485 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
26486
26487 @cindex fingerprint
26488 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
26489
26490 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
26491 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
26492
26493 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
26494 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
26495 reading capability.
26496
26497 @lisp
26498 (service fprintd-service-type)
26499 @end lisp
26500 @end defvr
26501
26502 @cindex sysctl
26503 @subsubheading System Control Service
26504
26505 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
26506 parameters at boot.
26507
26508 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
26509 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
26510 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
26511 instantiated as:
26512
26513 @lisp
26514 (service sysctl-service-type
26515 (sysctl-configuration
26516 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
26517 @end lisp
26518 @end defvr
26519
26520 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
26521 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
26522
26523 @table @asis
26524 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
26525 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
26526
26527 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
26528 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
26529 @end table
26530 @end deftp
26531
26532 @cindex pcscd
26533 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
26534
26535 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
26536 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
26537 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
26538 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
26539 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
26540
26541 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
26542 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
26543 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
26544 configuration, instantiate it as:
26545
26546 @lisp
26547 (service pcscd-service-type)
26548 @end lisp
26549 @end defvr
26550
26551 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
26552 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
26553
26554 @table @asis
26555 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
26556 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
26557 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
26558 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
26559 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
26560 @end table
26561 @end deftp
26562
26563 @cindex lirc
26564 @subsubheading Lirc Service
26565
26566 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
26567
26568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
26569 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
26570 [#:extra-options '()]
26571 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
26572 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
26573
26574 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
26575 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
26576 for details.
26577
26578 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
26579 passed to @command{lircd}.
26580 @end deffn
26581
26582 @cindex spice
26583 @subsubheading Spice Service
26584
26585 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
26586
26587 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
26588 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
26589 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
26590 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
26591 @end deffn
26592
26593 @cindex inputattach
26594 @subsubheading inputattach Service
26595
26596 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
26597 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
26598 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
26599 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
26600 Xorg display server.
26601
26602 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
26603 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
26604 dispatches events from it.
26605 @end deffn
26606
26607 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
26608 @table @asis
26609 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
26610 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
26611 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
26612
26613 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
26614 The device file to connect to the device.
26615
26616 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
26617 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
26618 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
26619
26620 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
26621 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
26622 @end table
26623 @end deftp
26624
26625 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
26626 @cindex dictionary
26627 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
26628
26629 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
26630 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
26631 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26632 @end defvr
26633
26634 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
26635 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
26636 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26637
26638 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
26639 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
26640 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
26641
26642 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
26643 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
26644 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26645 @end deffn
26646
26647 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
26648 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
26649
26650 @table @asis
26651 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
26652 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
26653
26654 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
26655 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
26656 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
26657 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26658
26659 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
26660 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
26661
26662 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
26663 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
26664 @end table
26665 @end deftp
26666
26667 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
26668 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
26669
26670 @table @asis
26671 @item @code{name}
26672 Name of the handler (module instance).
26673
26674 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
26675 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
26676 the module has the same name as the handler.
26677 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26678
26679 @item @code{options}
26680 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
26681 @end table
26682 @end deftp
26683
26684 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
26685 Data type representing a dictionary database.
26686
26687 @table @asis
26688 @item @code{name}
26689 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
26690
26691 @item @code{handler}
26692 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
26693 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26694
26695 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
26696 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
26697 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
26698
26699 @item @code{options}
26700 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
26701 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
26702 @end table
26703 @end deftp
26704
26705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
26706 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
26707 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
26708 @end defvr
26709
26710 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
26711
26712 @lisp
26713 (dicod-service #:config
26714 (dicod-configuration
26715 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
26716 (name "wordnet")
26717 (module "dictorg")
26718 (options
26719 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
26720 (databases (list (dicod-database
26721 (name "wordnet")
26722 (complex? #t)
26723 (handler "wordnet")
26724 (options '("database=wn")))
26725 %dicod-database:gcide))))
26726 @end lisp
26727
26728 @cindex Docker
26729 @subsubheading Docker Service
26730
26731 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
26732
26733 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
26734
26735 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
26736 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
26737 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
26738
26739 @end defvr
26740
26741 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
26742 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
26743
26744 @table @asis
26745
26746 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
26747 The Docker package to use.
26748
26749 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
26750 The Containerd package to use.
26751
26752 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
26753 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
26754
26755 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#f})
26756 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
26757
26758 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
26759 Enable or disable debug output.
26760
26761 @end table
26762 @end deftp
26763
26764 @cindex Audit
26765 @subsubheading Auditd Service
26766
26767 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
26768
26769 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
26770
26771 This is the type of the service that runs
26772 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
26773 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
26774
26775 Examples of things that can be tracked:
26776
26777 @enumerate
26778 @item
26779 File accesses
26780 @item
26781 System calls
26782 @item
26783 Invoked commands
26784 @item
26785 Failed login attempts
26786 @item
26787 Firewall filtering
26788 @item
26789 Network access
26790 @end enumerate
26791
26792 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
26793 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
26794 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
26795 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
26796 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
26797 to view a report of all recorded events.
26798 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
26799
26800 @end defvr
26801
26802 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
26803 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
26804
26805 @table @asis
26806
26807 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
26808 The audit package to use.
26809
26810 @end table
26811 @end deftp
26812
26813 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
26814 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
26815 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
26816 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
26817 service is the Singularity package to use.
26818
26819 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
26820 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
26821 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
26822 @end defvr
26823
26824 @cindex rshiny
26825 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
26826
26827 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
26828
26829 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
26830
26831 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
26832 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @code{R_LIBS_USER} environment
26833 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
26834
26835 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
26836 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
26837
26838 @table @asis
26839
26840 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
26841 The package to use.
26842
26843 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
26844 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
26845 run when the service is run.
26846
26847 The common way to create this file is as follows:
26848
26849 @lisp
26850 @dots{}
26851 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
26852 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
26853 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
26854 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
26855 "/bin/Rscript")))
26856 @dots{}
26857 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
26858 (call-with-output-file app
26859 (lambda (port)
26860 (format port
26861 "#!~a
26862 library(shiny)
26863 setwd(\"~a\")
26864 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
26865 Rbin targetdir)))
26866 @dots{}
26867 @end lisp
26868
26869 @end table
26870 @end deftp
26871 @end defvr
26872
26873 @cindex Nix
26874 @subsubheading Nix service
26875
26876 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
26877
26878 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
26879
26880 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
26881 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
26882 how to use it:
26883
26884 @lisp
26885 (use-modules (gnu))
26886 (use-service-modules nix)
26887 (use-package-modules package-management)
26888
26889 (operating-system
26890 ;; @dots{}
26891 (packages (append (list nix)
26892 %base-packages))
26893
26894 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
26895 %base-services)))
26896 @end lisp
26897
26898 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
26899
26900 @itemize
26901 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
26902 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
26903
26904 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
26905 @end itemize
26906
26907 @example
26908 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
26909 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
26910 @end example
26911
26912 @end defvr
26913
26914 @node Setuid Programs
26915 @section Setuid Programs
26916
26917 @cindex setuid programs
26918 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
26919 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
26920 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
26921 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
26922 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
26923 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
26924 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
26925 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
26926 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
26927
26928 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
26929 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
26930 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
26931 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
26932 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
26933 should be setuid root.
26934
26935 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
26936 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
26937 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
26938 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
26939 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
26940
26941 @example
26942 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
26943 @end example
26944
26945 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
26946 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
26947
26948 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
26949 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
26950
26951 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
26952 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
26953 @end defvr
26954
26955 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
26956 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
26957 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
26958 store.
26959
26960 @node X.509 Certificates
26961 @section X.509 Certificates
26962
26963 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
26964 @cindex X.509 certificates
26965 @cindex TLS
26966 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
26967 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
26968 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
26969 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
26970 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
26971 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
26972
26973 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
26974 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
26975 out-of-the-box.
26976
26977 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
26978 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
26979 certificates can be found.
26980
26981 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
26982 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
26983 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
26984 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
26985 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
26986 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
26987
26988 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
26989 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
26990 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
26991 to the certificates installed globally.
26992
26993 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
26994 can also install their own certificate package in
26995 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
26996 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
26997 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
26998 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
26999 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
27000 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
27001 would typically run something like:
27002
27003 @example
27004 guix install nss-certs
27005 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
27006 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
27007 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
27008 @end example
27009
27010 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
27011 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
27012 something like this:
27013
27014 @example
27015 guix install nss-certs
27016 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
27017 @end example
27018
27019 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
27020 variable in the relevant documentation.
27021
27022
27023 @node Name Service Switch
27024 @section Name Service Switch
27025
27026 @cindex name service switch
27027 @cindex NSS
27028 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
27029 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
27030 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
27031 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
27032 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
27033 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
27034 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
27035 C Library Reference Manual}).
27036
27037 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
27038 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
27039 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
27040 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
27041 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
27042 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
27043
27044 @cindex nss-mdns
27045 @cindex .local, host name lookup
27046 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
27047 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
27048 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
27049 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
27050
27051 @lisp
27052 (name-service-switch
27053 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
27054
27055 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
27056 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
27057 (name-service
27058 (name "mdns_minimal")
27059
27060 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
27061 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
27062 ;; no need to try the next methods.
27063 (reaction (lookup-specification
27064 (not-found => return))))
27065
27066 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
27067 (name-service
27068 (name "dns"))
27069
27070 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
27071 (name-service
27072 (name "mdns")))))
27073 @end lisp
27074
27075 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
27076 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
27077 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
27078
27079 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
27080 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
27081 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
27082 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
27083 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
27084 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
27085 @code{nscd-service}}).
27086
27087 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
27088 configurations.
27089
27090 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
27091 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
27092 @code{name-service-switch} object.
27093 @end defvr
27094
27095 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
27096 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
27097 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
27098 @end defvr
27099
27100 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
27101 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
27102 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
27103 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
27104 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
27105 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
27106 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
27107 run @command{guix system}.
27108
27109 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
27110
27111 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
27112 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
27113 system databases.
27114
27115 @table @code
27116 @item aliases
27117 @itemx ethers
27118 @itemx group
27119 @itemx gshadow
27120 @itemx hosts
27121 @itemx initgroups
27122 @itemx netgroup
27123 @itemx networks
27124 @itemx password
27125 @itemx public-key
27126 @itemx rpc
27127 @itemx services
27128 @itemx shadow
27129 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
27130 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
27131 @end table
27132 @end deftp
27133
27134 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
27135
27136 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
27137 associated lookup action.
27138
27139 @table @code
27140 @item name
27141 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
27142 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
27143
27144 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
27145 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
27146 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
27147 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
27148
27149 @item reaction
27150 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
27151 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
27152 Reference Manual}). For example:
27153
27154 @lisp
27155 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
27156 (success => return))
27157 @end lisp
27158 @end table
27159 @end deftp
27160
27161 @node Initial RAM Disk
27162 @section Initial RAM Disk
27163
27164 @cindex initrd
27165 @cindex initial RAM disk
27166 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
27167 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
27168 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
27169 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
27170 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
27171
27172 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
27173 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
27174 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
27175 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
27176 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
27177 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
27178 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
27179 file system, you would write:
27180
27181 @lisp
27182 (operating-system
27183 ;; @dots{}
27184 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
27185 @end lisp
27186
27187 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
27188 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
27189 @end defvr
27190
27191 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
27192 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
27193 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
27194 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
27195 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
27196 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
27197
27198 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
27199 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
27200 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
27201 system declaration like this:
27202
27203 @lisp
27204 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
27205 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
27206 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
27207 (apply base-initrd file-systems
27208 #:qemu-networking? #t
27209 rest)))
27210 @end lisp
27211
27212 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
27213 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
27214 volatile root file system.
27215
27216 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
27217 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
27218 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
27219 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
27220 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
27221 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
27222
27223 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
27224 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
27225 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
27226 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
27227
27228 @table @code
27229 @item --load=@var{boot}
27230 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
27231 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
27232
27233 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
27234 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
27235 initialization system.
27236
27237 @item --root=@var{root}
27238 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
27239 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
27240 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
27241 operating system declaration is used.
27242
27243 @item --system=@var{system}
27244 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
27245 @var{system}.
27246
27247 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
27248 @cindex module, black-listing
27249 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
27250 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
27251 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
27252 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
27253 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
27254
27255 @item --repl
27256 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
27257 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
27258 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
27259 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
27260 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
27261
27262 @end table
27263
27264 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
27265 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
27266 here is how to use it and customize it further.
27267
27268 @cindex initrd
27269 @cindex initial RAM disk
27270 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
27271 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
27272 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
27273 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
27274 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
27275 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
27276 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
27277 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
27278 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
27279 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
27280 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
27281 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
27282 the root file system.
27283
27284 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
27285 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
27286 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
27287 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
27288 intended keyboard layout.
27289
27290 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
27291 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
27292 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
27293
27294 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
27295 to it are lost.
27296 @end deffn
27297
27298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
27299 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
27300 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
27301 [#:linux-modules '()]
27302 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
27303 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
27304 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
27305 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
27306 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
27307
27308 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
27309 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
27310 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
27311 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
27312 intended keyboard layout.
27313
27314 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
27315
27316 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
27317 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
27318 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
27319 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
27320 @end deffn
27321
27322 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
27323 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
27324 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
27325 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
27326 program to run in that initrd.
27327
27328 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
27329 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
27330 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
27331 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
27332 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
27333 automatically copied to the initrd.
27334 @end deffn
27335
27336 @node Bootloader Configuration
27337 @section Bootloader Configuration
27338
27339 @cindex bootloader
27340 @cindex boot loader
27341
27342 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
27343 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
27344 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
27345 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
27346 installed.
27347
27348 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
27349 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
27350 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
27351 field.
27352
27353 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
27354 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
27355
27356 @table @asis
27357
27358 @item @code{bootloader}
27359 @cindex EFI, bootloader
27360 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
27361 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
27362 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
27363 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
27364 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
27365
27366 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
27367 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
27368 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
27369 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
27370 when you boot it on your system.
27371
27372 @vindex grub-bootloader
27373 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
27374 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
27375
27376 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
27377 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
27378 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
27379 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
27380 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
27381 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
27382
27383 @item @code{target}
27384 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
27385 bootloader.
27386
27387 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
27388 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
27389 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
27390 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
27391 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
27392 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
27393
27394 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
27395 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
27396 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
27397 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
27398
27399 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
27400 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
27401 current system.
27402
27403 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
27404 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
27405 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
27406
27407 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
27408 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
27409 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
27410 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
27411
27412 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
27413 Layout}).
27414
27415 @quotation Note
27416 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
27417 @code{grub-efi}.
27418 @end quotation
27419
27420 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
27421 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
27422 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
27423 for GRUB.
27424
27425 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
27426 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
27427 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
27428 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
27429 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
27430 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
27431 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
27432
27433 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
27434 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
27435 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
27436 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
27437 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
27438 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
27439 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
27440 manual}).
27441
27442 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
27443 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
27444 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
27445 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
27446
27447 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
27448 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
27449 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
27450 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
27451 @end table
27452
27453 @end deftp
27454
27455 @cindex dual boot
27456 @cindex boot menu
27457 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
27458 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
27459 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
27460 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
27461 along these lines:
27462
27463 @lisp
27464 (menu-entry
27465 (label "The Other Distro")
27466 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
27467 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
27468 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
27469 @end lisp
27470
27471 Details below.
27472
27473 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
27474 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
27475
27476 @table @asis
27477
27478 @item @code{label}
27479 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
27480
27481 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
27482 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
27483
27484 @lisp
27485 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
27486 @end lisp
27487
27488 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
27489 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
27490 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
27491
27492 @example
27493 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
27494 @end example
27495
27496 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
27497 field is ignored entirely.
27498
27499 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
27500 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
27501 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
27502
27503 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
27504 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
27505 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
27506
27507 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
27508 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
27509 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
27510
27511 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
27512 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
27513 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
27514 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
27515 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
27516
27517 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
27518 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
27519 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
27520 For example:
27521
27522 @lisp
27523 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
27524 @end lisp
27525
27526 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
27527 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
27528
27529 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
27530 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
27531
27532 @lisp
27533 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
27534 @dots{})
27535 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
27536 @dots{}))
27537 @end lisp
27538
27539 @end table
27540 @end deftp
27541
27542 @cindex HDPI
27543 @cindex HiDPI
27544 @cindex resolution
27545 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
27546 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
27547 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
27548
27549 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
27550 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
27551
27552 @table @asis
27553 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
27554 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings, see
27555 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
27556 @end table
27557 @end deftp
27558
27559 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
27560 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
27561 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
27562 record.
27563
27564 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
27565 logos.
27566 @end deffn
27567
27568 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
27569 like
27570
27571 @lisp
27572 (bootloader
27573 (bootloader-configuration
27574 ;; @dots{}
27575 (theme (grub-theme
27576 (inherit (grub-theme))
27577 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
27578 @end lisp
27579
27580 @node Invoking guix system
27581 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
27582
27583 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
27584 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
27585 system} command. The synopsis is:
27586
27587 @example
27588 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
27589 @end example
27590
27591 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
27592 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
27593 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
27594 supported:
27595
27596 @table @code
27597 @item search
27598 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
27599 expressions, sorted by relevance:
27600
27601 @cindex HDPI
27602 @cindex HiDPI
27603 @cindex resolution
27604 @example
27605 $ guix system search console
27606 name: console-fonts
27607 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
27608 extends: shepherd-root
27609 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
27610 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
27611 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
27612 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
27613 +
27614 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
27615 + ("tty2" . (file-append
27616 + font-tamzen
27617 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
27618 + ("tty3" . (file-append
27619 + font-terminus
27620 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
27621 relevance: 9
27622
27623 name: mingetty
27624 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
27625 extends: shepherd-root
27626 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
27627 relevance: 2
27628
27629 name: login
27630 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
27631 extends: pam
27632 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
27633 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
27634 relevance: 2
27635
27636 @dots{}
27637 @end example
27638
27639 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
27640 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
27641 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
27642
27643 @item reconfigure
27644 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
27645 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
27646 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
27647 systems already running Guix System.}.
27648
27649 @quotation Note
27650 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
27651 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
27652 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
27653 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
27654 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
27655 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
27656 @end quotation
27657
27658 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
27659 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
27660 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
27661 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
27662 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
27663 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
27664
27665 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
27666 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
27667 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
27668 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
27669 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
27670
27671 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
27672 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
27673 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
27674 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
27675
27676 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
27677 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
27678 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
27679 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
27680 @var{file} itself, when available. This information is useful should
27681 you later want to inspect how this particular generation was built.
27682
27683 In fact, assuming @var{file} is self-contained, you can later rebuild
27684 generation @var{n} of your operating system with:
27685
27686 @example
27687 guix time-machine \
27688 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
27689 system reconfigure \
27690 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
27691 @end example
27692
27693 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
27694 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
27695 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
27696 information on provenance tracking.
27697
27698 @item switch-generation
27699 @cindex generations
27700 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
27701 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
27702 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
27703 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
27704 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
27705 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
27706 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
27707
27708 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
27709 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
27710 configuration file.
27711
27712 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
27713 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
27714 generation 7:
27715
27716 @example
27717 guix system switch-generation 7
27718 @end example
27719
27720 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
27721 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
27722 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
27723 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
27724 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
27725 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
27726
27727 @example
27728 guix system switch-generation -- -1
27729 @end example
27730
27731 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
27732 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
27733 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
27734 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
27735 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
27736 like activating and deactivating services.
27737
27738 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
27739
27740 @item roll-back
27741 @cindex rolling back
27742 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
27743 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
27744 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
27745 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
27746
27747 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
27748 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
27749 generation.
27750
27751 @item delete-generations
27752 @cindex deleting system generations
27753 @cindex saving space
27754 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
27755 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
27756 collector'').
27757
27758 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
27759 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
27760 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
27761
27762 @example
27763 guix system delete-generations
27764 @end example
27765
27766 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
27767 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
27768
27769 @example
27770 guix system delete-generations 2m
27771 @end example
27772
27773 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
27774 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
27775 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
27776
27777 @item build
27778 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
27779 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
27780 This action does not actually install anything.
27781
27782 @item init
27783 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
27784 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
27785 installations of Guix System. For instance:
27786
27787 @example
27788 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
27789 @end example
27790
27791 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
27792 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
27793 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
27794 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
27795 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
27796
27797 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
27798 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
27799 passed.
27800
27801 @item vm
27802 @cindex virtual machine
27803 @cindex VM
27804 @anchor{guix system vm}
27805 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
27806 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
27807
27808 @quotation Note
27809 The @code{vm} action and others below
27810 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
27811 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
27812 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
27813 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
27814 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
27815 @end quotation
27816
27817 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
27818 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
27819 emulated machine:
27820
27821 @example
27822 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
27823 @end example
27824
27825 The VM shares its store with the host system.
27826
27827 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
27828 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
27829 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
27830 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
27831
27832 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
27833 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
27834 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
27835
27836 @example
27837 guix system vm my-config.scm \
27838 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
27839 @end example
27840
27841 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
27842 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
27843 store of the host can then be mounted.
27844
27845 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
27846 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
27847 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
27848 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
27849 size of the image.
27850
27851 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
27852 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
27853 @item vm-image
27854 @itemx disk-image
27855 @itemx docker-image
27856 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
27857 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
27858 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
27859 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
27860 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
27861 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
27862 @code{docker-image}.
27863
27864 You can specify the root file system type by using the
27865 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
27866
27867 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
27868 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
27869 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
27870
27871 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
27872 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
27873 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
27874 using the following command:
27875
27876 @example
27877 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
27878 @end example
27879
27880 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
27881 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
27882 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
27883 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
27884 Docker container using commands like the following:
27885
27886 @example
27887 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
27888 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
27889 docker start $container_id
27890 @end example
27891
27892 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
27893 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
27894 start any services you have defined in the operating system
27895 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
27896 using @command{docker exec}:
27897
27898 @example
27899 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
27900 @end example
27901
27902 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
27903 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
27904 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
27905 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
27906 @code{docker create}.
27907
27908 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
27909 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
27910 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
27911
27912 @item container
27913 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
27914 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
27915 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
27916 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
27917 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
27918 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
27919
27920 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
27921 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
27922 system.
27923
27924 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
27925 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
27926 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
27927
27928 @example
27929 guix system container my-config.scm \
27930 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
27931 @end example
27932
27933 @quotation Note
27934 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
27935 @end quotation
27936
27937 @end table
27938
27939 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
27940 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
27941 following:
27942
27943 @table @option
27944 @item --expression=@var{expr}
27945 @itemx -e @var{expr}
27946 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
27947 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
27948 operating system.
27949 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
27950 Installation Image}).
27951
27952 @item --system=@var{system}
27953 @itemx -s @var{system}
27954 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
27955 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
27956
27957 @item --derivation
27958 @itemx -d
27959 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
27960 building anything.
27961
27962 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
27963 @item --save-provenance
27964 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
27965 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
27966 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
27967 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
27968 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
27969 can run:
27970
27971 @example
27972 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
27973 @end example
27974
27975 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
27976 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
27977 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
27978 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
27979 of the image.
27980
27981 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
27982 @itemx -t @var{type}
27983 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
27984 @var{type} on the image.
27985
27986 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
27987
27988 @cindex ISO-9660 format
27989 @cindex CD image format
27990 @cindex DVD image format
27991 @option{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
27992 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
27993
27994 @item --image-size=@var{size}
27995 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
27996 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
27997 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
27998 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
27999
28000 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
28001 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
28002 @var{file}.
28003
28004 @item --network
28005 @itemx -N
28006 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
28007 that is, do not create a network namespace.
28008
28009 @item --root=@var{file}
28010 @itemx -r @var{file}
28011 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
28012 collector root.
28013
28014 @item --skip-checks
28015 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
28016
28017 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
28018 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
28019 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
28020 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
28021 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
28022 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
28023
28024 @cindex on-error
28025 @cindex on-error strategy
28026 @cindex error strategy
28027 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
28028 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
28029 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
28030
28031 @table @code
28032 @item nothing-special
28033 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
28034
28035 @item backtrace
28036 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
28037
28038 @item debug
28039 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
28040 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
28041 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
28042 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
28043 a list of available debugging commands.
28044 @end table
28045 @end table
28046
28047 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
28048 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
28049 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
28050 bootloader boot menu:
28051
28052 @table @code
28053
28054 @item describe
28055 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
28056 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
28057
28058 @item list-generations
28059 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
28060 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
28061 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
28062 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
28063
28064 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
28065 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
28066 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
28067 generations that are up to 10 days old:
28068
28069 @example
28070 $ guix system list-generations 10d
28071 @end example
28072
28073 @end table
28074
28075 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
28076 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
28077 each other:
28078
28079 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
28080 @table @code
28081
28082 @item extension-graph
28083 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
28084 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
28085 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
28086 extensions).
28087
28088 The command:
28089
28090 @example
28091 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
28092 @end example
28093
28094 shows the extension relations among services.
28095
28096 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
28097 @item shepherd-graph
28098 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
28099 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
28100 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
28101 example graph.
28102
28103 @end table
28104
28105 @node Invoking guix deploy
28106 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
28107
28108 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
28109 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
28110 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
28111 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
28112 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
28113 once as a logical ``deployment''.
28114
28115 @quotation Note
28116 The functionality described in this section is still under development
28117 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
28118 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
28119 @end quotation
28120
28121 @example
28122 guix deploy @var{file}
28123 @end example
28124
28125 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
28126 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
28127
28128 @lisp
28129 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
28130 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
28131 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
28132 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
28133 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
28134
28135 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
28136 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
28137
28138 (define %system
28139 (operating-system
28140 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
28141 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
28142 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
28143 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
28144 (target "/dev/vda")
28145 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
28146 (file-systems (cons (file-system
28147 (mount-point "/")
28148 (device "/dev/vda1")
28149 (type "ext4"))
28150 %base-file-systems))
28151 (services
28152 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
28153 (service openssh-service-type
28154 (openssh-configuration
28155 (permit-root-login #t)
28156 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
28157 %base-services))))
28158
28159 (list (machine
28160 (operating-system %system)
28161 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
28162 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
28163 (host-name "localhost")
28164 (system "x86_64-linux")
28165 (user "alice")
28166 (identity "./id_rsa")
28167 (port 2222)))))
28168 @end lisp
28169
28170 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
28171 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
28172 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
28173 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
28174 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
28175 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
28176 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
28177 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
28178 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
28179 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
28180 @var{environment} type would be used.
28181
28182 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
28183 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
28184 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
28185
28186 @example
28187 # guix archive --generate-key
28188 @end example
28189
28190 @noindent
28191 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
28192 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
28193
28194 @example
28195 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
28196 @end example
28197
28198 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
28199 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
28200 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
28201 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
28202 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
28203 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
28204 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
28205 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
28206 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
28207
28208 @lisp
28209 (use-modules ...
28210 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
28211
28212 (define %user "username")
28213
28214 (operating-system
28215 ...
28216 (sudoers-file
28217 (plain-file "sudoers"
28218 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
28219 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
28220 %user)))))
28221
28222 @end lisp
28223
28224 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
28225 consult @command{man sudoers}.
28226
28227 @deftp {Data Type} machine
28228 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
28229 deployment.
28230
28231 @table @asis
28232 @item @code{operating-system}
28233 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
28234
28235 @item @code{environment}
28236 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
28237
28238 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
28239 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
28240 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
28241 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
28242 however, an error will be thrown.
28243 @end table
28244 @end deftp
28245
28246 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
28247 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
28248 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
28249
28250 @table @asis
28251 @item @code{host-name}
28252 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
28253 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
28254 @item @code{system}
28255 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
28256 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
28257 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
28258 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
28259 keyring.
28260 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
28261 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
28262 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
28263 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
28264 remote host.
28265
28266 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
28267 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
28268
28269 @example
28270 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
28271 @end example
28272
28273 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
28274 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
28275 client does.
28276
28277 @end table
28278 @end deftp
28279
28280 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
28281 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
28282 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
28283
28284 @table @asis
28285 @item @code{ssh-key}
28286 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
28287 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
28288 @item @code{tags}
28289 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
28290 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
28291 @item @code{region}
28292 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
28293 @item @code{size}
28294 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
28295 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
28296 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
28297 @end table
28298 @end deftp
28299
28300 @node Running Guix in a VM
28301 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
28302
28303 @cindex virtual machine
28304 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
28305 distributed at
28306 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
28307 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
28308 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
28309 as QEMU (see below for details).
28310
28311 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
28312 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
28313 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
28314 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
28315 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
28316 Configuration System}).
28317
28318 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
28319 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
28320 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
28321 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
28322
28323 @cindex QEMU
28324 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
28325 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
28326 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
28327 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
28328 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
28329 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
28330
28331 @example
28332 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
28333 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
28334 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
28335 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
28336 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
28337 @end example
28338
28339 Here is what each of these options means:
28340
28341 @table @code
28342 @item qemu-system-x86_64
28343 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
28344 host.
28345
28346 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
28347 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
28348 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
28349 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
28350 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
28351 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
28352 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
28353 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
28354
28355 @item -enable-kvm
28356 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
28357 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
28358 faster.
28359
28360 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
28361 @item -m 1024
28362 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
28363 which may be insufficient for some operations.
28364
28365 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
28366 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
28367 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
28368 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
28369 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
28370
28371 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
28372 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
28373 the ``myhd'' drive.
28374 @end table
28375
28376 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
28377 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
28378 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
28379 to your system definition and start the VM using
28380 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
28381 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
28382 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
28383 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
28384
28385 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
28386
28387 @cindex SSH
28388 @cindex SSH server
28389 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
28390 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
28391 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
28392 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
28393
28394 @example
28395 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
28396 @end example
28397
28398 To connect to the VM you can run
28399
28400 @example
28401 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
28402 @end example
28403
28404 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
28405 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
28406 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
28407 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
28408 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
28409
28410 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
28411
28412 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
28413 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
28414 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
28415 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
28416
28417 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
28418 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
28419
28420 @example
28421 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
28422 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
28423 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
28424 name=com.redhat.spice.0
28425 @end example
28426
28427 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
28428 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
28429
28430 @node Defining Services
28431 @section Defining Services
28432
28433 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
28434 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
28435 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
28436
28437 @menu
28438 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
28439 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
28440 * Service Reference:: API reference.
28441 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
28442 @end menu
28443
28444 @node Service Composition
28445 @subsection Service Composition
28446
28447 @cindex services
28448 @cindex daemons
28449 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
28450 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
28451 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
28452 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
28453 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
28454 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
28455 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
28456 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
28457 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
28458 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
28459 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
28460 of the system.
28461
28462 @cindex service extensions
28463 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
28464 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
28465 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
28466 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
28467 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
28468 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
28469 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
28470 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
28471 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
28472 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
28473 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
28474
28475 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
28476 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
28477 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
28478
28479 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
28480
28481 @cindex system service
28482 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
28483 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
28484 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
28485 to learn about the other service types shown here.
28486 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
28487 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
28488 particular operating system definition.
28489
28490 @cindex service types
28491 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
28492 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
28493 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
28494 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
28495 different parameters.
28496
28497 The following section describes the programming interface for service
28498 types and services.
28499
28500 @node Service Types and Services
28501 @subsection Service Types and Services
28502
28503 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
28504 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
28505 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
28506
28507 @lisp
28508 (define guix-service-type
28509 (service-type
28510 (name 'guix)
28511 (extensions
28512 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
28513 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
28514 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
28515 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
28516 @end lisp
28517
28518 @noindent
28519 It defines three things:
28520
28521 @enumerate
28522 @item
28523 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
28524
28525 @item
28526 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
28527 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
28528 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
28529
28530 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
28531 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
28532
28533 @item
28534 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
28535 @end enumerate
28536
28537 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
28538
28539 @table @code
28540 @item shepherd-root-service-type
28541 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
28542 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
28543 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
28544 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
28545
28546 @item account-service-type
28547 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
28548 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
28549 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
28550 guix-daemon}).
28551
28552 @item activation-service-type
28553 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
28554 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
28555 booted.
28556 @end table
28557
28558 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
28559
28560 @lisp
28561 (service guix-service-type
28562 (guix-configuration
28563 (build-accounts 5)
28564 (use-substitutes? #f)))
28565 @end lisp
28566
28567 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
28568 the parameters of this specific service instance.
28569 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
28570 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
28571 value is omitted, the default value specified by
28572 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
28573
28574 @lisp
28575 (service guix-service-type)
28576 @end lisp
28577
28578 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
28579 services but is not extensible itself.
28580
28581 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
28582
28583 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
28584
28585 @lisp
28586 (define udev-service-type
28587 (service-type (name 'udev)
28588 (extensions
28589 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
28590 udev-shepherd-service)))
28591
28592 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
28593 (extend (lambda (config rules)
28594 (match config
28595 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
28596 (udev-configuration
28597 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
28598 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
28599 @end lisp
28600
28601 This is the service type for the
28602 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
28603 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
28604 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
28605
28606 @table @code
28607 @item compose
28608 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
28609 services of this type.
28610
28611 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
28612 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
28613
28614 @item extend
28615 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
28616 the composition of the extensions.
28617
28618 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
28619 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
28620 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
28621 list of contributed rules.
28622
28623 @item description
28624 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
28625 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
28626 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
28627 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
28628 @end table
28629
28630 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
28631 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
28632 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
28633
28634 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
28635 interface for services.
28636
28637 @node Service Reference
28638 @subsection Service Reference
28639
28640 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
28641 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
28642 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
28643 @code{(gnu services)} module.
28644
28645 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
28646 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
28647 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
28648 this particular service instance.
28649
28650 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
28651 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
28652 raised.
28653
28654 For instance, this:
28655
28656 @lisp
28657 (service openssh-service-type)
28658 @end lisp
28659
28660 @noindent
28661 is equivalent to this:
28662
28663 @lisp
28664 (service openssh-service-type
28665 (openssh-configuration))
28666 @end lisp
28667
28668 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
28669 with the default configuration.
28670 @end deffn
28671
28672 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
28673 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
28674 @end deffn
28675
28676 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
28677 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
28678 @end deffn
28679
28680 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
28681 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
28682 parameters.
28683 @end deffn
28684
28685 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
28686
28687 @lisp
28688 (define s
28689 (service nginx-service-type
28690 (nginx-configuration
28691 (nginx nginx)
28692 (log-directory log-directory)
28693 (run-directory run-directory)
28694 (file config-file))))
28695
28696 (service? s)
28697 @result{} #t
28698
28699 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
28700 @result{} #t
28701 @end lisp
28702
28703 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
28704 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
28705 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
28706 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
28707 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
28708 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
28709 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
28710 common pattern.
28711
28712 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
28713 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
28714
28715 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
28716 clauses. Each clause has the form:
28717
28718 @example
28719 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
28720 @end example
28721
28722 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
28723 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
28724 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
28725 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
28726 @var{type}.
28727
28728 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
28729 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
28730 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
28731 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
28732 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
28733 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
28734
28735 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
28736
28737 @end deffn
28738
28739 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
28740 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
28741 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
28742 @code{operating-system} declaration.
28743
28744 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
28745 @cindex service type
28746 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
28747 and Services}).
28748
28749 @table @asis
28750 @item @code{name}
28751 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
28752
28753 @item @code{extensions}
28754 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
28755
28756 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
28757 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
28758 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
28759 services.
28760
28761 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
28762 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
28763 extensions. It may return any single value.
28764
28765 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
28766 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
28767
28768 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
28769 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
28770 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
28771 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
28772 parameter value for the service instance.
28773 @end table
28774
28775 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
28776 @end deftp
28777
28778 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
28779 @var{compute}
28780 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
28781 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
28782 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
28783 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
28784 @end deffn
28785
28786 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
28787 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
28788 @end deffn
28789
28790 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
28791 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
28792 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
28793 provides a shorthand for this.
28794
28795 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
28796 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
28797 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
28798 service is an instance.
28799
28800 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
28801 an additional job:
28802
28803 @lisp
28804 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
28805 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
28806 @end lisp
28807 @end deffn
28808
28809 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
28810 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
28811 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
28812 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
28813 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
28814 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
28815 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
28816
28817 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
28818 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
28819 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
28820 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
28821 @end deffn
28822
28823 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
28824 service types, some of which are listed below.
28825
28826 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
28827 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
28828 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
28829 @end defvr
28830
28831 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
28832 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
28833 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
28834 @end defvr
28835
28836 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
28837 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
28838 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
28839 passing it name/file tuples such as:
28840
28841 @lisp
28842 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
28843 @end lisp
28844
28845 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
28846 pointing to the given file.
28847 @end defvr
28848
28849 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
28850 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
28851 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
28852 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
28853 @end defvr
28854
28855 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
28856 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
28857 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
28858 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
28859 @end defvr
28860
28861 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
28862 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
28863 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
28864 in the system itself. It creates several files under
28865 @file{/run/current-system}:
28866
28867 @table @file
28868 @item channels.scm
28869 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
28870 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
28871 to build the system, if that information was available
28872 (@pxref{Channels}).
28873
28874 @item configuration.scm
28875 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
28876 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
28877 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
28878 received on the command line.
28879
28880 @item provenance
28881 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
28882 format that is more readily processable.
28883 @end table
28884
28885 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
28886 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
28887
28888 @quotation Caveats
28889 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
28890 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
28891 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
28892 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
28893 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
28894 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
28895
28896 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
28897 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
28898 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
28899 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
28900 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
28901 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
28902 comparison less trivial.
28903 @end quotation
28904
28905 This service is automatically added to your operating system
28906 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
28907 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
28908 @end defvr
28909
28910 @node Shepherd Services
28911 @subsection Shepherd Services
28912
28913 @cindex shepherd services
28914 @cindex PID 1
28915 @cindex init system
28916 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
28917 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
28918 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
28919 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
28920 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
28921
28922 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
28923 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
28924 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
28925 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
28926 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
28927
28928 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
28929
28930 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
28931 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
28932 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
28933
28934 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
28935 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
28936 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
28937
28938 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
28939 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
28940
28941 @table @asis
28942 @item @code{provision}
28943 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
28944
28945 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
28946 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
28947 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
28948 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
28949
28950 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
28951 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
28952
28953 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
28954 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
28955 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
28956 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
28957 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
28958
28959 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
28960 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
28961 underlying process dies.
28962
28963 @item @code{start}
28964 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
28965 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
28966 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
28967 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
28968 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
28969 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
28970
28971 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
28972 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
28973 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
28974 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
28975 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
28976 @command{herd} sub-commands:
28977
28978 @example
28979 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
28980 @end example
28981
28982 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
28983 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
28984 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
28985
28986 @item @code{documentation}
28987 A documentation string, as shown when running:
28988
28989 @example
28990 herd doc @var{service-name}
28991 @end example
28992
28993 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
28994 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
28995
28996 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
28997 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
28998 @code{stop} are evaluated.
28999
29000 @end table
29001 @end deftp
29002
29003 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
29004 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
29005 Shepherd service (see above).
29006
29007 @table @code
29008 @item name
29009 Symbol naming the action.
29010
29011 @item documentation
29012 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
29013
29014 @example
29015 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
29016 @end example
29017
29018 @item procedure
29019 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
29020 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
29021 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
29022 @end table
29023
29024 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
29025 greets the user:
29026
29027 @lisp
29028 (shepherd-action
29029 (name 'say-hello)
29030 (documentation "Say hi!")
29031 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
29032 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
29033 args)
29034 #t)))
29035 @end lisp
29036
29037 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
29038
29039 @example
29040 # herd say-hello example
29041 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
29042 # herd say-hello example a b c
29043 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
29044 @end example
29045
29046 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
29047 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
29048 info on actions.
29049 @end deftp
29050
29051 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
29052 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
29053
29054 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
29055 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
29056 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
29057 @end defvr
29058
29059 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
29060 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
29061 @end defvr
29062
29063
29064 @node Documentation
29065 @chapter Documentation
29066
29067 @cindex documentation, searching for
29068 @cindex searching for documentation
29069 @cindex Info, documentation format
29070 @cindex man pages
29071 @cindex manual pages
29072 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
29073 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
29074 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
29075 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
29076 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
29077 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
29078
29079 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
29080 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
29081 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
29082
29083 @example
29084 $ info -k TLS
29085 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
29086 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
29087 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
29088 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
29089 @dots{}
29090 @end example
29091
29092 @noindent
29093 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
29094
29095 @example
29096 $ man -k TLS
29097 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
29098 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
29099 @dots {}
29100 @end example
29101
29102 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
29103 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
29104 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
29105 respected.
29106
29107 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
29108 running, say:
29109
29110 @example
29111 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
29112 @end example
29113
29114 @noindent
29115 or:
29116
29117 @example
29118 $ man certtool
29119 @end example
29120
29121 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
29122 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
29123 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
29124 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
29125 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
29126 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
29127
29128 @node Installing Debugging Files
29129 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
29130
29131 @cindex debugging files
29132 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
29133 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
29134 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
29135 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
29136 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
29137
29138 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
29139 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
29140 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
29141 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
29142 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
29143 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
29144 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
29145
29146 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
29147 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
29148 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
29149 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
29150 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
29151 with GDB}).
29152
29153 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
29154 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
29155 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
29156 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
29157 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
29158 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
29159 Guile:
29160
29161 @example
29162 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
29163 @end example
29164
29165 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
29166 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
29167 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
29168 GDB}):
29169
29170 @example
29171 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
29172 @end example
29173
29174 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
29175 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
29176
29177 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
29178 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
29179 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
29180 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
29181 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
29182 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
29183
29184 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
29185 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
29186 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
29187 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
29188 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
29189 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
29190 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
29191 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
29192
29193
29194 @node Security Updates
29195 @chapter Security Updates
29196
29197 @cindex security updates
29198 @cindex security vulnerabilities
29199 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
29200 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
29201 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
29202 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
29203 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
29204 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
29205 distribution:
29206
29207 @smallexample
29208 $ guix lint -c cve
29209 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
29210 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
29211 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
29212 @dots{}
29213 @end smallexample
29214
29215 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
29216
29217 Guix follows a functional
29218 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
29219 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
29220 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
29221 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
29222 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
29223 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
29224 desired.
29225
29226 @cindex grafts
29227 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
29228 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
29229 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
29230 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
29231 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
29232 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
29233 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
29234
29235 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
29236 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
29237 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
29238 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
29239 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
29240 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
29241
29242 @lisp
29243 (define bash
29244 (package
29245 (name "bash")
29246 ;; @dots{}
29247 (replacement bash-fixed)))
29248 @end lisp
29249
29250 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
29251 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
29252 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
29253 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
29254 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
29255 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
29256 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
29257 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
29258
29259 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
29260 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
29261 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
29262 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
29263 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
29264 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
29265 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
29266
29267 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
29268 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
29269 Thus, the command:
29270
29271 @example
29272 guix build bash --no-grafts
29273 @end example
29274
29275 @noindent
29276 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
29277
29278 @example
29279 guix build bash
29280 @end example
29281
29282 @noindent
29283 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
29284 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
29285
29286 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
29287 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
29288
29289 @example
29290 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
29291 @end example
29292
29293 @noindent
29294 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
29295 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
29296
29297 @example
29298 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
29299 @end example
29300
29301 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
29302 @command{lsof} command:
29303
29304 @example
29305 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
29306 @end example
29307
29308
29309 @node Bootstrapping
29310 @chapter Bootstrapping
29311
29312 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
29313
29314 @cindex bootstrapping
29315
29316 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
29317 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
29318 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
29319 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
29320 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
29321 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
29322 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
29323 a ``regular user''.
29324
29325 @cindex bootstrap binaries
29326 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
29327 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
29328 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
29329 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
29330 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
29331 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
29332 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
29333 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
29334 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
29335
29336 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
29337 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
29338 Binaries}).
29339
29340 @menu
29341 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
29342 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
29343 @end menu
29344
29345 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
29346 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
29347
29348 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
29349 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
29350 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
29351 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
29352 ``taken for granted.''
29353
29354 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
29355 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
29356 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
29357 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
29358 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
29359
29360 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
29361 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
29362 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
29363 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
29364
29365 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
29366 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
29367 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
29368 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
29369 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
29370
29371 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
29372 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
29373 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
29374 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
29375
29376 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
29377 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
29378 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
29379 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
29380 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
29381 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
29382 removed are now built from source.
29383
29384 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possibly by adding
29385 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
29386 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
29387 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
29388 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
29389 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
29390 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
29391 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
29392 hopefully be reduced again.
29393
29394 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
29395 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
29396 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
29397
29398 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
29399 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
29400
29401 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
29402 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
29403 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
29404 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
29405 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
29406 to get Guile running.}.
29407
29408 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
29409 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
29410
29411 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
29412 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
29413 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
29414 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
29415
29416 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
29417 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
29418 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
29419
29420 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
29421 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
29422
29423 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
29424 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
29425 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
29426
29427 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
29428 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
29429 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
29430 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
29431
29432 @example
29433 guix graph -t derivation \
29434 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
29435 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
29436 @end example
29437
29438 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
29439
29440 @example
29441 guix graph -t derivation \
29442 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
29443 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
29444 @end example
29445
29446 At this level of detail, things are
29447 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
29448 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
29449 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
29450 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
29451 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
29452 (@pxref{The Store}).
29453
29454 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
29455 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
29456 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
29457 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
29458 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
29459 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
29460 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
29461 tarball to be unpacked.
29462
29463 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
29464 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
29465 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
29466 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
29467 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
29468 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
29469 in the store, using the original layout. The
29470 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
29471 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
29472 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
29473 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
29474
29475 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
29476 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
29477 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
29478 point we have a working C tool chain.
29479
29480 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
29481
29482 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
29483 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
29484 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
29485 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
29486 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
29487 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
29488 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
29489
29490 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
29491 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
29492 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
29493 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
29494 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
29495 package from source. The command:
29496
29497 @example
29498 guix graph -t bag \
29499 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
29500 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
29501 @end example
29502
29503 @noindent
29504 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
29505 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
29506 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
29507 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
29508
29509 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
29510
29511 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
29512 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
29513 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
29514 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
29515 built.
29516
29517 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
29518 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
29519 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
29520 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
29521
29522 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
29523 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
29524 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
29525 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
29526 Coreutils, etc.
29527
29528 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
29529 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
29530 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
29531 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
29532 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
29533
29534
29535 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
29536
29537 @cindex bootstrap binaries
29538 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
29539 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
29540 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
29541 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
29542
29543 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
29544 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
29545 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
29546 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
29547 command-line tools):
29548
29549 @example
29550 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
29551 @end example
29552
29553 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
29554 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
29555 this section.
29556
29557 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
29558 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
29559 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
29560 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
29561 know.
29562
29563 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
29564
29565 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
29566 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
29567 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
29568 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
29569 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
29570 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
29571
29572 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
29573 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
29574 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
29575 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
29576 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
29577
29578 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
29579 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
29580 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
29581 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
29582 a simple and auditable assembler.
29583
29584 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
29585 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
29586 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
29587 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
29588 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
29589 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
29590 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
29591 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
29592
29593 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
29594 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
29595
29596 @node Porting
29597 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
29598
29599 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
29600 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
29601 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
29602 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
29603 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
29604 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
29605 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
29606
29607 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
29608 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
29609 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
29610 one:
29611
29612 @example
29613 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
29614 @end example
29615
29616 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
29617 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
29618 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
29619 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
29620 taught about the new platform.
29621
29622 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
29623 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
29624 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
29625 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
29626 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
29627 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
29628 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
29629 as well.
29630
29631 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
29632 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
29633 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
29634 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
29635 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
29636 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
29637 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
29638 reason.
29639
29640 @c *********************************************************************
29641 @include contributing.texi
29642
29643 @c *********************************************************************
29644 @node Acknowledgments
29645 @chapter Acknowledgments
29646
29647 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
29648 which was designed and
29649 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
29650 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
29651 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
29652 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
29653 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
29654
29655 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
29656 an inspiration for Guix.
29657
29658 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
29659 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
29660 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
29661 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
29662 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
29663
29664
29665 @c *********************************************************************
29666 @node GNU Free Documentation License
29667 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
29668 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
29669 @include fdl-1.3.texi
29670
29671 @c *********************************************************************
29672 @node Concept Index
29673 @unnumbered Concept Index
29674 @printindex cp
29675
29676 @node Programming Index
29677 @unnumbered Programming Index
29678 @syncodeindex tp fn
29679 @syncodeindex vr fn
29680 @printindex fn
29681
29682 @bye
29683
29684 @c Local Variables:
29685 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
29686 @c End: